SECTION 00850 DRAWING LIST PART I- GENERAL 1.1 SCHEDULE The project work shall be done in accordance with and in conformity to the drawings listed in the following tabulation. DRAWING NO. C0.0 C0.1 C1.1 C1.2 C2.1 C3.1 C4.1 C5.1 C5.2 C6.1 C7.1 C7.2 C7.3 C7.4 C7.5 C7.6 C7.7 C7.8 E0.1 TITLES COVER SHEET GENERAL OF NOTES, SYMBOLS AND ABBREVIATIONS PLAT OF SURVEY DEMOLITION PLAN SITE LAYOUT PLAN GRADING PLAN UTILITY PLAN PAVING PLAN SECTIONS AND DETAILS EROSION CONTROL PLAN DETAILS DETAILS DETAILS DETAILS DETAILS DETAILS DETAILS OPERATION AND MAINTENANCE PLAN ELECTRICAL PLAN L0.1 R1.0 R2.0 LANDSCAPE PLAN SOIL MANAGEMENT PLAN REMEDIATION PLAN The said drawing are signed accompany the agreement and are made a part hereof. The specifications and drawings are intended to be correlative and complementary. All work appearing upon the drawings and omitted in the specifications or mentioned in the specifications and omitted from the drawings, shall be executed in the accordance with the true intent and meaning of said specifications and drawings, as determined by the authorized representative of the Park District, the same as though said work were contained and described in each. Special drawings and details with respect to any item of the work will be furnished within a reasonable time in response to a written request by the Contractor provided such drawings are necessary to the proper and expeditious performance of the contract. This does not cover drawings to be furnished by the Contractor. END OF SECTION 00850 Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA DRAWING LIST 00850-1 SECTION 01005 SPECIAL LANDSCAPE PROVISIONS PART I-GENERAL 1.1 SUMMARY A. Contractor shall furnish all materials as specified work, labor, service, and equipment required to perform the work specified hereinafter complete and ready for use, as listed in this article and as covered by the following. "General Conditions" "Specifications and "Proposal". B. Contractor shall include, as a part of the work under the contract, for the work involved herein, t h e movement and transportation of his own equipment and C. D. E. supplies to and from the site of the work. The work in general includes, but is not limited to: Contractor purchasing from approved nurseries, plant material of various sizes and quantities, as stated in the proposal to be delivered and planted at the project site. Approved nurseries will be from weather zone SB or colder as indicated by the USDA Zone Hardiness map issued in 1990. The work includes trees, shrubs, ground cover, and other planting related work per the plan and specifications. All work by the contractor shall confirm to the highest horticultural standards and practice. The Landscape Contractor will purchase high quality and healthy plant material to ensure that superior design intentions and cultural requirements are met. Shade, ornamental and evergreens trees shall be of specimen quality, symmetrically branched, with central leaders. Exceptions to central leaders will be on certain ornamental and shade trees approved by the Chicago Park District Forester. The Contractor is expected to plant trees, at the proper depth, with straight trunks and proper pruning methods without damage to trees or surrounding areas. Park District landscape Architect and Inspector will monitor planting to ensure compliance. Work by others; the Contractor shall note that there might be work scheduled under other contracts at some of the parks which may be in force during the contract period. The contractor for the work hereunder shall fully cooperate in all respects with other Contractors and Park District personnel. 1.2 WORK AND MATERIALS FURNISHED BY CONTRACTOR A. B. The Contractor shall purchase per plants, shade, ornamental and evergreen trees, shrubs, vines, groundcover, perennials, bulbs, and sod from approved nurseries as specified in the proposal. The Contractor shall be responsible for any loss or damages to plant material from approved nurseries from the time they are picked up until the final acceptance of the work. Any loss or damage during this period shall be replaced by the Contractor as directed by the Project Manager at no additional cost to the Park District. 1.3 LOCATION 1358 W. Monroe St., Chicago, IL Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA SPECIAL LANDSCAPE PROVISIONS 01005 – 1 1.4 ACCESS TO SITE A. B. Equipment material and supplies may be transported to site of the work across Park District property, at such points and under such regulations as the Park District may impose in regard to protection of structures, landscaping, pavement, curbs, sidewalks, utilities, fences and all other equipment located on or near the site of the work. No driving, parking or storage of vehicles, equipment, or material in any soft surface, except as absolutely required to transport and install the plant material and subject to the approval of the Project Manager. This includes all designated lawn areas or area of exposed earth. 1.5 REMOVAL OF EQUIPMENT A. Upon receiving in writing from the Project Manager that the work has been completed, the Contractor shall immediately begin to remove his equipment and surplus materials from the premise within seven days. Should he fail to do so, the Contractor agrees that the Park District may, at its discretion, remove said equipment to such locations as it may elect and that the cost of such removal will be deducted from the amount then due Contractor, and should it become necessary to store equipment, a further deduction will be made for rental of such storage space. The amount of said rental will be decided by the Park District. 1.6 WATER FOR CONSTRUCTION AND DRINKING PURPOSES A. B. Water for construction and drinking purposes may be obtained from the existing lawn hydrants or water lines of the Park District, if available, and will be supplied to the Contractor without charge except that the water shall be conveyed to the point of use from such hydrants or lines by the Contractor at his own expense. Where the Contractor desires to tap into the water lines at points where hydrants are not provided, he shall do so at his own expense and only with the permission of the Park District. The use of the hydrants for obtaining water for planting and maintenance purposes will be permitted, providing the Contractor obtains the necessary permits from the City of Chicago at the Contractor’s own expense. 1.7 CONTRACTOR'S SHELTER AND STORAGE OF MATERIALS A. Contractor shall provide such shelter and accessories as are necessary for his forces to handle the work most advantageously. He shall provide adequate shelter for the protection of all materials liable to damage by exposure and shall be responsible for all loss and damage to materials and equipment in connection with his work. 1.8 SANITATION A. In addition to requirement of Article XIV-6 Sanitation in the General Conditions, Contractor shall furnish if necessary, small and maintain an enclosed chemical type, temporary toilet during the contract period and shall remove such facilities at the termination of contract. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA SPECIAL LANDSCAPE PROVISIONS 01005 – 2 1.9 PROTECTION OF TREES In addition to all protective equipment herein stated and in accordance to Article XIV-F-6 Protection of Trees in the General Conditions, Contractor shall adequately and completely protect all existing trees and their roots, except where specific notice is given in writing by the Park District Forester, within the entire area affected by this contract from all forms of damage and removal. Methods of protection shall be at the Contractor’s option, subject to the Park District Forester's approval. Contractor will be charged the sum of$250.00 per caliper inch of truck diameter, measured one foot above adjacent ground line, if trees are removed or destroyed. Also, if trees are damaged or harmed in any way by the operations of the Contractor under the contract a charge of $100.00 per square inch of surface area damaged and harmed will be changed. In case of damaged trees, the Project Manager will have the final decision as to the square inch area for which the Contractor will be charged and if each tree is damaged to the extent where total replacement is necessary. Driving, parking and storage of materials shall not be allowed within the drip line of trees and shrubs. A. B. C. 1.10 SAMPLE A. Soil and mulch samples and sources of plant material shall be submitted to Project Manager. Chicago Park District, 541 N. Fairbanks. Chicago, IL 60611 for approval. Samples to be submitted for each source or as requested by the Project Manager. 1.11 OPERATIONS AFFECTING EXISTING CONDITIONS A. Operations affecting existing conditions shall be conducted with care not to damage condition that is to remain in place. All existing condition damaged by the Contractor's operations shall be rectified promptly without additional cost to the Park District, using material of type, size, thickness and finished corresponding to those of adjacent similar conditions. This includes all utilities adjacent to work area. 1.12 EQUIPMENT AND HOISTING A. Contractor shall have adequate equipment and use great care in the hoisting and handling of materials and equipment so as not to damage existing walks, drives, and facilities that are to remain. All damage shall he repaired or replaced by the Contractor, as required and approved by the Project Manager, at no additional cost to the Park District. 1.13 PROTECTION OF UNDERGROUND SERVICE AND UTILITIES A. B. In addition to the requirements of Article XIV-A-4 (Protection of Utilities), Contractor shall also notify the Chicago Park District Project Manager, in advance of any excavation on Park District property. The work shall be performed with every precaution to avoid any damage to the existing underground service lines and utility structures if such are encountered. Contractor shall be held responsible for and make good all damages to underground utilities that may result directly or indirectly from his operations. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA SPECIAL LANDSCAPE PROVISIONS 01005 – 3 PART II- SPECIFIC PROJECT REQUIREMENTS 2.1 SUMMARY OF SPECIFIC REQUIREMENTS A. The Contractor shall provide the following maintenance tasks in addition to the installation of plant material. 2.2 REMOVAL OF WEEDS AND INVASIVE PLANT MATERIAL A. B. Remove all weeds and invasive plant material. All debris is to be removed from Park District property and disposed of properly. Weed removal should be included in the installation cost provided by contractor for new plant material. The contractor shall weed groundcover, vines, and bulb areas every 7 to 14 days beginning May 1st, and concluding on October 1st, for the duration of the maintenance period. C. D. All trees mulch rings, shrubs, groundcover, perennials, vines and bulb beda shall be kept weed free. Weeds shall be removed by pulling at base of each plant and include removal of the roots. Contractor shall only use chemical for removal of weeds and invasive with prior approval of the Project Manager. Contractor shall notify the Project Manager 24 hours in advance of any use of such chemicals. 2.3 PRUNING AND DEAD HEADING A. B. C. D. E. F. G. H. I. Prune trees and shrubs, and dead-head perennials and bulbs as needed throughout the maintenance period. Pruning includes groundcover All plant material shall be inspected while performing other m a i n t e n a n c e duties to determine the need for pruning. Pruning should be completed at least once each year to accordance with these specifications. All tree pruning shall be performed by certified tree workers under the direction a n d supervision of an LSA certified arborist. All trees shall be pruned in accordance with industry standards, in order to stimulate tight, natural growth. Contractor shall prune all dead, broken, or diseased branches, structural defects, such as bad crotches, crossing or rubbing branches, growth o f a second leader, or sucker growth at the tree base. Pruning should develop the natural form of each individual plant to assure the effect intended by the Landscape Architect. All cuts be clean and done with properly sharpened tools. In general, tools to be used should conform to accepted horticultural practices. The use of hedge trimming shears shall be prohibited except for trimming specified hedges. When cuts are made on diseased trees, tools should be disinfected with alcohol. Cuts shall be made back to a bud, branch, or main trunk. Collar cuts shall be made at tree trunks. The removal of dead branches of flowering p e r e n n i a l s and bulbs shall take place during routine maintenance. Routine maintenance to be done every 7-14 days as needed, beginning May 1, and concluding October 1. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA SPECIAL LANDSCAPE PROVISIONS 01005 – 4 2.4 GROUNDCOVER, VINES, P E R E N N I A L S , AND BULBS A. Contractor is to provide and maintain groundcover, vines, perennials, and bulbs as Required. B. Summary: 1. Contractor shall furnish all materials, work, labor, service and equipment required to perform the work specified, as listed in the article and as covered by the following ''General Conditions", "Specifications", "Proposal" and as shown on the drawings. 2. Contractor shall include, as part of the work under the contract for the work involved herein, t h e movement and transportation of his own equipment, supplies and plant material as listed on the plan to and from the site of work. 3. The work in general includes but is not limited to furnishing and installing plant material preparation of beds including weeding use of a pre-emergent herbicide in tree rings, perennials, shrub beds, supplying soil supplements such as sand and peat moss, and rototilling planting, fertilization and application of herbicide/pesticide to soil after planting, mulching, repair of damaged lawn areas, weeding and other maintenance to beds as specified and all other related work. 2.5 SUPPLY AND INSTALLATION OF MULCH A. B. C. D. E. Contractor is to supply and install shredded hardwood bark mulch as needed to supplement loss, around trees, and in shrub and groundcover, perennial, vines and bulb beds. A sample of mulch shall be submitted t o the Project Manager for approval. The contractor shall place a 3" layer of approved mulch material around shade trees, with a 6 foot diameter concentric circle, complete with saucer at the outer edge. Care should be taken to avoid placing mulch directly in contact with the tree truck. Shrub beds shall be filled with a 3" layer of approved mulch in their entirety. Groundcover, vine, perennial, and bulb beds, receive a 2" layer of approved mulch. Care shall be taken not to bury leaf stems or vines under mulch material. END OF SECTION 01005 Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA SPECIAL LANDSCAPE PROVISIONS 01005 – 5 SECTION 01010 SUMMARY OF WORK PART I- GENERAL 1.1 Related Documents A. Drawings and general provisions of the Contract, including General Conditions a n d other Division 1 Specification Sections, apply to this section. 1.2 Work Covered by Contract Documents A. The work consists of construction of artificial turf soccer fields. B. 1. Project Location: Park No. 569 1358 W. Monroe St. Chicago, IL 2. Owner: Chicago Park District 541 N. Fairbanks Chicago, IL 60611 Contract Documents were prepared for the project by: Delta Engineering Group, LLC 111 W. Jackson Blvd., Suite 910 Chicago, IL 60604 C. 1.3 The scope of work includes the following: 1. Environmental remediation including offsite disposal of contaminated material and backfill with aggregate. 2. Removal of chain link fence, existing driveways, sidewalks and curbs & gutters 3. Capping of existing water supply lines 4. Supply and installation of ornamental fence, fence posts and gates 5. Supply and installation of artificial turf, trees, concrete curbs, concrete pavements, pea gravel, outcroppings, benches, shade structures, storm sewers including catch basins, inlets and cleanouts, water lines including shut off boxes, lawn hydrants and drinking fountain, Storm Sewer and Water tie-ins to City system, Electrical work including walkway light poles, handholes and lighting controller with meter socket, ComEd connection. 6. Site work for constructing sidewalks and ramps outside the property limits includes installation of warning tiles and other miscellaneous work identified in the drawings and specifications. Contractor Use of Premises A. Use of the Site: Limit use of the premises to work in areas indicated. Confine operations to areas within contract limits indicated and in accordance with the Landscape Architect's instructions. Do not disturb portions of the site beyond the areas in which the Work i s indicated. Any damage to the surrounding areas including areas used for construction entrances will be the responsibility of the contractor to replace. B. CPD Improvement Sign 1. A temporary improvement sign provided by the Chicago Park District shall be installed by the Contractor at the site in a location selected by the Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA 01010-1 SUMMARY Engineer. It is required that the improvement sign be maintained in good condition by the Contractor until the development activities are complete. B. 2. The sign will be constructed of one 96-inch w i d e by 48-inch h i g h , Y,-inch thick exterior grade "A” face MDO Plywood panels. 3. To obtain the sign, please contact the Chicago Park District at the phone number listed below, identify the name of the park and type of project improvement and make arrangements to pick up the sign. Chicago Park District Trades Garfield Service Yard 3737 W. Kinzie Ave. Chicago, I L 60624 Phone: 312-746-5561 4. At the conclusion of the project, the Contractor is responsible for returning the improvement sign to the Chicago Park District. 911 Signs 1. Four "911" signs (one for each side of the temporary construction fencing) shall be installed by the Contractor at the project site in locations selected by the Engineer. It is required that the 911 signs be maintained in good condition by the Contractor until the development activities are complete. 2. Signs shall be attached to the temporary chain link fencing using plastic ties. 3. To obtain the signs, please contact: Chicago Park District Trades Garfield Service Yard 3737 W. Kinzie Ave. Chicago, I L 60624 Phone: 312-746-5561 4. At the conclusion of the project, the Contractor is responsible for returning the 911 signs to the Chicago Park District. END O F SECTION 01010 Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA 01010-2 SUMMARY SECTION 01400 QUALITY CONTROL SERVICES PART I- GENERAL 1.1 SUMMARY A. This Section specifies administrative and procedural requirements for quality control services. B. Quality control services include inspections and tests and related actions including reports, performed by independent agencies, governing authorities, and the Contractor. C. Inspection and testing services are required to verify compliance with requirements specified or indicated. These services do not relieve the Contractor of responsibility for compliance with Contract Document requirements. D. Requirements of this Section relate to customized fabrication and installation procedures, not production of standard products. 1. Specific quality control requirements for individual construction activities are specified in the Sections that specify those activities. Those requirements, including inspections and tests, cover production of standard products as well as customized fabrication and installation procedures. 2. Inspections, test and related actions specified are not intended to limit the Contractors quality control procedures that facilitate compliance with Contract Document requirements. 3. Requirements f o r the Contractor to provide quality control services required by the Owner, or authorities having jurisdiction are not limited by provisions of this Section. 1.2 RELATED DOCUMENTS A. Drawings and general provisions of Contract, including General and Supplementary Conditions and all other Divisions of the Project Manual, apply to this Section. 1.3 RESPONSIBILITIES A. The Contractor shall provide inspections, tests and similar quality control services, specified in individual Specification Sections and required by governing authorities, except where they are specifically indicated to be the Owner's responsibility, or are provided by another identified entity; these services include those specified to be performed by an independent agency and not by the Contractor. Costs for these services shall be included in the Contract Sum. 1. The Owner will select and the Contractor shall employ and pay an independent agency, to perform specified quality control services. a. Where the Owner has engaged a testing agency or other entity for testing and inspection of a part of the Work, and the Contractor is also required to engage an entity for the same or related element, the Contractor shall not employ the entity engaged by the Owner, unless otherwise agreed in writing with the Owner. 2. Re-testing: The Contractor is responsible for re-testing where results of required inspections, tests or similar services prove unsatisfactory and do not indicate compliance with Contract Document requirements, regardless of whether the original test was the Contractor's responsibility. a, Cost of re-testing construction revised or replaced by the Contractor is the Contractor's responsibility, where required tests were performed on original construction. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA QUALITY CONTROL 01400-1 3. B. C. 1.4 Associated Services: The Contractor shall cooperate with agencies performing required inspections, tests and similar services and provide reasonable auxiliary services as requested. Notify the agency sufficiently in advance of operations to permit assignment of personnel. Auxiliary services required include but are not limited to: a. Providing access to the Work and furnishing incidental labor and facilities necessary to facilitate inspections and tests. b. Taking adequate quantities of representative samples of materials that require testing or assisting the agency in taking samples. c. Providing facilities for storage and curing of test samples, and delivery of samples to testing laboratories. d. Providing the agency with a preliminary design mix proposed for use for materials mixes that require control by the testing agency. e. Security and protection of samples and test equipment at the Project site. Duties of the Testing Agency: The independent testing agency engaged to perform inspections, sampling and testing of materials and construction specified in individual Specification Sections shall cooperate with the Owner and Contractor in performance of its duties, and shall performed by qualified personnel to perform required inspections and tests. 1. The agency shall notify the Owner and Contractor promptly of irregularities or deficiencies observed in the Work during performance of its services. 2. The agency is not authorized to release, revoke, alter or enlarge requirements of the Contract Documents, or approve or accept any portion of the Work. 3. The agency shall not perform any duties of the Contractor. Coordination: The Contractor and each agency engaged to perform inspections, tests and similar services shall coordinate the sequence of activities to accommodate required services with a minimum of delay. In addition the Contractor and each agency shall coordinate activities to avoid the necessity of removing and replacing construction to accommodate inspections and tests. 1. The Contractor is responsible for scheduling times for inspections, tests, taking samples and similar activities. SUBMITTALS A. The independent testing agency shall submit a certified written report of each inspection, test or similar service, to the Owner, in duplicate, and a copy to the Contractor. 1. Submit additional copies of each written report directly to the governing authority, when the authority so directs. 2. Report Data: Written reports of each inspection, test or similar service shall include, but not be limited to: a. Date of issue. b. Project title and number. c. Name, address and telephone number of testing agency. d. Dates and locations of samples and tests or inspections. e. Names of individuals making the inspection or test. £ Designation of the Work and test method. g. Identification of product and Specification Section. h. Complete inspection or test data. i. Test results and an interpretations of test results. j. Ambient conditions at the time of sample-taking and testing. k. Comments or professional opinion as to whether inspected or tested work complies with Contract Document requirements. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA QUALITY CONTROL 01400-2 l. m. Name and signature of laboratory inspector. Recommendations on re-testing. 1.5 QUALITY ASSURANCE A. Qualification for Service Agencies: Engage inspection and testing service · agencies, including independent testing laboratories, which are prequalified as complying with "Recommended Requirements for Independent Laboratory Qualification" by the American Council of Independent Laboratories, and which specialize in the types of inspections and tests to be performed. 1. Each independent inspection and testing agency engaged on the Project shall be authorized by authorities having jurisdiction to operate in the State of Illinois. B. Meet basic requirements of ASTM E329 “Standard Specification for Agencies Engaged in Construction Inspection, Testing, or Special Inspection." C. Submit copy of report of inspection of facilities made by Materials Reference Laboratory of National Bureau of Standards during most recent tour of inspection; with memorandum of remedies of all deficiencies reported by inspection. D. Testing Equipment: 1. Calibrated at maximum 12-month intervals by devices of accuracy traceable to either: a. National Bureau of Standards b. Accepted values of natural physical constants. 2. Submit copy of certificate of calibration, made by accredited calibration agency. 1.6 LABORATORY DUTIES: LIMITS OF AUTHORITY A. Cooperate with Owner and Contractor; provide qualified personnel promptly on notice. B. Perfom1 specified inspections, sampling and testing of materials and construction methods. 1. Comply with specified Standards: ASTM, other recognized authorities, and as specified. 2. Ascertain compliance with Contract requirements. C. Promptly notify Owner and Contractor of irregularities or deficiencies of work which are observed during performance of services. D. Promptly submit 5 copies of reports of inspections and tests to Owner including: 1. Date issued 2. Project title and number 3. Testing Laboratory name and address 4. Name and signature of Inspector 5. Date of inspection and sampling 6. Record of temperature and weather 7. Date of test 8. Identification of product and Specification Section 9. Location in project 10. Type of inspection or test 11. Observations regarding compliance with Contract Documents E. Perform additional services as required by Owner. F. Laboratory is not authorized to: 1. Release, revoke, alter or enlarge on, Contract requirements. 2. Approve or accept any portion of work. 3. Perform any duties of the Contractor. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA QUALITY CONTROL 01400-3 1.7 A. CONTRACTOR'S RESPONSIBILITIES Cooperate with Laboratory personnel, provide access to work, to manufacturer's operations. B. Provide Laboratory, preliminary representative samples of materials for testing, in required quantities. C. Furnish copies of mill test reports. D. Furnish labor and facilities: 1. To provide access to work to be tested. 2. To obtain and handle samples at site. 3. To facilitate inspections and tests. 4. For Laboratory's exclusive use for storage and curing of test samples. E. Notify Laboratory sufficiently in advance of operations to allow for personnel assignment of test scheduling. F. Employ, and pay for, services of a qualified Independent Testing Laboratory to perform inspections, sampling and testing where required. PART II- PRODUCTS (Not Applicable) PART III- EXECUTION 3.1 REP AIR AND PROTECTION A. General: Upon completion of inspection, testing, sample-taking and similar services, repair damaged construction and restore substrates and finishes to eliminate deficiencies, including deficiencies in visual qualities of exposed finishes. Comply with Contract Document requirements for “Cutting and Patching." B. Protect construction exposed by or for quality control services, and protect repaired construction. C. Repair and protection is the Contractor's responsibility, regardless of the assignment of responsibility for inspection, testing or similar services. END OF SECTION 01400 Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA QUALITY CONTROL 01400-4 SECTION 01500 TEMPORARY FACILITIES PART 1 - GENERAL 1.1 SUMMARY A. This section specifies administrative and procedural requirements for temporary services and facilities, including utilities, construction and support facilities, and security and protection. A. Contractor shall be solely responsible for adequacy of temporary facilities, including design and engineering thereof. B. Temporary utility services required but not limited to: C. D. 1. Water service and distribution. 2. Temporary electric power and light. 3. Telephone Service. 4. Storm and sanitary sewer. Construction and support facilities required include but are not limited to: 1. Temporary heat. 2. Temporary roadway paving and/or steel plates. 3. Field offices and/or storage sheds. 4. Sanitary facilities, including toilets and drinking water. 5. Dewatering facilities and drains. 6. Temporary enclosures. 7. Project identification sign. 8. Waste disposal services. 9. Rodent and pest control. 10. Construction aids and miscellaneous general services and facilities. Security and protection facilities and services required include but are not limited to: 1. Barricades, warning signs and lights. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA TEMPORARY FACILITIES 01500-1 2. Enclosure fence for the site. 3. Environmental protection. 1.2 RELATED WORK . A. Drawings and general provisions of Contract, including General and Supplementary Conditions and all other Divisions of the Project Manual, apply to this Section. 1.3 SUBMITTALS A. 1.4 1.5 Project sign and barricades for work in right-of-way: submit drawings for Owner review. QUALITY ASSURANCE A. Regulations: comply with local codes and ordinances of governing authorities having jurisdiction. B. Standards: contractor determines and complies with applicable standards for temporary and construction facilities. C. Inspections: arrange for authorities having jurisdiction to inspect and test each utility before use. Obtain required certification and permits. PROJECT CONDITIONS A. Conditions of use: keep temporary services and facilities clean and neat in appearance. Operate in a safe and efficient manner. Do not overload temporary services or facilities, or permit them to interfere with construction progress. Do not allow hazardous, dangerous or unsanitary conditions or public nuisances to develop or persist on the site. B. Easements: obtain necessary easements for temporary facilities when required. PART 2 - PRODUCTS 2.1 MATERIALS AND EQUIPMENT A. General: provide new materials and equipment or undamaged previously used materials and equipment in serviceable condition. Provide materials and equipment suitable for the use intended. B. Water; provide potable water approved by local health authorities. C. First aid supplies: comply with governing regulations. D. Fire extinguishers: where required, provide hand-carried, portable UL-rated, class fire extinguishers for temporary offices and similar spaces. In other locations, provide handcarried, portable UL-rated, class "ABC” dries chemical extinguishers, or a combination of Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA TEMPORARY FACILITIES 01500-2 extinguishers of NFPA recommended classes for the exposures. 1. E. Comply with NAPA 10 and 241 for classification, extinguishing agent and size required by location and class of fire exposure. Work zone traffic control: comply with IDOL 701 and 702. PART 2 - PRODUCTS 3.1 3.2 3.3 INSTALLATION A. Locate facilities where they will best serve the Project and result in minimum interference with performance of the Work. Relocate and modify facilities as required. B. Provide each facility ready for use when needed to avoid delay. Maintain and modify as required. Do not remove until facilities are no longer needed or are replaced by authorized use of completed permanent facilities. TEMPORARY INSTALLATION A. Temporary water service for construction and drinking purposes: the Contractor is responsible for providing all water required for construction operations. Use of adjacent fire hydrants is permitted provided the Contractor obtain a Fire Hydrant Use Permit available through the City of Chicago Department of Water Management. B. Provide earthen embankments and similar barriers in and around excavations and subgrade construction, sufficient to prevent flooding by runoff of storm water from heavy rains. TEMPORARY CONSTRUCTION AND SUPPORT FACILITY INSTALLATION A. Field offices (optional): provide insulated, weather-tight, prefabricated or mobile units with lockable entrances, operable windows, serviceable finishes and temporary telephone. Provide heated and air conditioned units on foundations for normal loading. 1. Provide lockable filing cabinets for project record documents, plan racks and plan table. Provide meeting area with space and furnishings to accommodate not less than 12 people for project meetings. B. Storage and fabrication sheds (optional): install storage and fabrication sheds, sized, furnished and equipped to accommodate materials and equipment involved, including temporary utility service. Sheds may be open shelters or fully enclosed spaces on the site. C. Sanitary facilities: comply with regulations and health codes for the type, number, location, operation and maintenance of fixtures and facilities. Install where facilities will best serve the Project's needs. 1. Provide self-contained, single-occupant toilet units of the chemical, aerated recirculation or combustion type, properly vented and fully enclosed with a glass fiber reinforced polyester shell or similar nonabsorbent material. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA TEMPORARY FACILITIES 01500-3 2. Provide toilet tissue, paper towels, paper cups and similar disposable materials for each facility. Provide covered waste containers for used material. Temporary enclosures: provide temporary enclosure for protection of construction in progress and completed from exposure, foul weather, other construction operations and similar activities. D. 1. E. Project identification and temporary signs: prepare project identification and other signs of size indicated; install signs to inform the public and persons seeking entrance to the Project. Support on the posts or framing of preservative treated wood or steel. Do not permit installation of unauthorized signs. F. 3.4 3.5 Where heat is needed, provide temporary enclosures where there is no other provision for containment of heat. Coordinate enclosure with ventilating and materials drying or curing requirements to avoid dangerous conditions and effects. Collection of disposal of waste: collect waste from project site daily. Comply with requirements of NFPA 241 for removal of combustible waste materials and debris. Enforce requirements strictly. Do not hold materials more than seven days during normal weather and three days when the temperature is expected to rise above 80 degrees Fahrenheit. Handle hazardous, dangerous or unsanitary waste materials separately from other waste by containerizing properly. Dispose of material in a lawful manner. SHORING, BRACING AND UNDERPINNING (as required) A. Provide shoring and bracing necessary to protect existing buildings, streets, walkways, utilities and other improvements and excavation against loss of ground or caving embankments. Maintain shoring and bracing. Remove temporary shoring and bracing when no longer required. B. Whenever shoring is required, locate the system to clear permanent construction and to permit forming and finishing of concrete surfaces. Provide shoring system, adequately anchored and braced to resist earth and hydrostatic pressures. C. Shoring systems retaining earth on which the support or stability of existing structure is dependent must be left in place at completion of work. D. Maintain bracing until structural elements are re-braced by other bracing or until permanent construction is able to withstand lateral earth and hydrostatic pressures. E. Remove sheeting, shoring and bracing in stages to avoid disturbance to underlying soils and damage to structures, pavements, facilities and utilities. F. Repair or replace as acceptable by Owner, adjacent work damaged or displaced through the installation or removal of shoring and bracing work. SECURITY AND PROTECTION FACILITIES Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA TEMPORARY FACILITIES 01500-4 3.6 A. Barricades, warning signs and lights: Comply with !DOT 701,702 and local code requirements. Paint with appropriate colors, graphics and warning signs to inform personnel and the public of the hazard being protected against. Where appropriate and needed, provide lighting, including flashing red or amber lights. B. Environmental protection: provide environmental protection as outlined in Section 01560- TEMPORARY ENVIRONMENTAL CONTROLS. C. Site security to be provided by the Contractor as required. OPERATION, TERMINATION AND REMOVAL A. Supervision: enforce strict discipline in use of temporary facilities. Limit availability of temporary facilities to essential and intended uses to minimize waste and abuse. B. Maintenance: maintain facilities in good operating condition until removal. 1. Maintain operation of temporary enclosures, heating, cooling, humidity control, ventilation and similar facilities on a 24-hour a day basis where required to achieve indicated results and to avoid the possibility of damage. D. Termination and rcmov.al: remove each temporary facility when the need has ended, or when replaced by authorized use of a pem1anent facility, or no later than Substantial Completion. Complete or, if necessary, restore permanent construction that may have been delayed because of interference with the temporary facility. Repair damaged Work, clean exposed surfaces and replace construction that cannot be satisfactorily repaired. E. Materials and facilities that constitute temporary Contractor. facilities are the property of the END OF SECTION 01500 Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA TEMPORARY FACILITIES 01500-5 SECTION 01524 CONSTRUCTION WASTE MANAGEMENT PART 1 - GENERAL 1.1 SUMMARY A. 1.2 1.3 Section i n c l u d e s : Administrative and procedural requirements for construction wa st e management a cti v iti es. DEFINITIONS A. Construction, Demolition, and Land clearing (CDL) Waste: Includes all nonhazardous solid wastes resulting from construction, re mo d e lin g , alterations, repair demolition and land clearing. Includes material that is recycled, reused, salvaged or disposed as garbage. B. Salvage: Recovery of materials for on-site reuse or donation to a third party. Reuse: Making use of a material without altering its form. Materials can be reused on- site or reused on other projects off-site. Examples include, but are not limited to the following: Grinding of concrete for use as sub-base material. Chipping of land clearing debris for use as mulch. C. Recycling: The process of sorting, cleaning, treating, and reconstituting materials for the purpose of using the material in the manufacture of a new product. D. Source-Separated CDL Recycling: The process of separating recyclable materials in separate containers as they are generated on the job-site. The separated materials are hauled directly to a recycling facility or transfer station. E. Co-mingled CDL Recycling: The process of collecting mixed recyclable materials in one container on-site. The container is taken to a material recovery facility where materials are separated for recycling. F. Approved Recycling Facility: Any of the following: 1. A facility that can legally accept CDL waste materials for the purpose of processing the materials into an altered form for the manufacture new product. 2. Material Recovery Facility: A general term used to describe a waste-sorting f acility. Mechanical, hand-separation, or a combination of both procedures, issued to recover recyclable materials. SUBMITTALS A. Waste Management Plan: Submit (3) three copies of plan within 15 calendar days of Notice to Proceed. B. Waste Management Report: Concurrent with each submittal for partial and final payment Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA CONSTRUCTION WASTE MANAGEMENT 01524-1 1.4 PERFORMANCE REQUIREMENTS A. B. 1.5 General: Divert a minimum of 50% CDL waste, by weight, from the landfill by one or a combination of the following activities: 1. Salvage 2. Reuse 3. Source-Separated CDL Recycling 4. Co-mingled CDL Recycling CDL waste materials that can be salvaged, reused or recycled include, but are not limited to, the following: 1. Asphalt 2. Asphalt shingles 3. Cardboard packaging 4. Concrete 5. Land clearing debris (vegetation, stumpage, dirt) 6. Metals 7. Paint (through hazardous waste outlets) 8. Wood 9. Plastic film (sheeting, shrink wrap, packaging) 10. Wood 11. Field office waste, including office paper, aluminum cans, glass, plastic, and office cardboard. QUALITY ASSURANCE A. Regulatory Requirements: Conduct construction waste management activities in accordance with City of Chicago Construction Recycling Ordinance, Illinois number and all other applicable laws and ordinances. B. Preconstruction Conference: Schedule and conduct meeting at Project site prior to construction activities. 1. Attendees: Inform the following individuals, whose presence is required, of date and time of meeting. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA CONSTRUCTION WASTE MANAGEMENT 01524-2 2. 3. 1.6 a. Owner b. Architect c. Contractor's superintendent and/or Project Manager d. Major Subcontractors e. Other necessary parties Agenda Items: Review methods and procedures related to waste management including, but not limited to the following: a. Review and discuss waste management plan including responsibilities of Contractor’s Waste Management Coordinator. b. Review requirements for documenting quantities of each type of waste and its disposition. c. Review and finalize procedures for materials separation and verify availability of containers and bins needed to avoid delays. d. Review procedures for periodic waste collection and transportation to recycling and disposal facilities. e. Review waste management requirements for each trade. f. Review and distribution of the following publications and programs: g. City of Chicago Best Management Practices for construction recycling. Minutes: Record discussion. Distribute meeting minutes to all participants’ within3 days. WASTE MANAGEMENT PLAN A. General: Develop plan consisting of waste types, quantity by weight, methods of disposal, handling and transportation procedures. Include separate sections in plan for demolition and construction waste. B. Organize the waste management plan in accordance with the sample plan included. At the end of part three in this specification, including the following information: 1. Types and estimated quantities, by weight, of CDL waste expected to be generated during demolition and construction. 2. Proposed methods for salvage, reuse, recycling and disposal during demolition including, but not limited to, one or more of the following: Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA CONSTRUCTION WASTE MANAGEMENT 01524-3 3. 1.7 a. Contracting with a deconstruction specialist to salvage materials generated b. Selective salvage as part of demolition contractor’s work c. Reuse of materials on-site or sale or donation to a third party Proposed methods for salvage, reuse, recycling and disposal during construction including, but not limited to, one or more of the following. a. Requiting subcontractors to take their CDL waste to a recycling facility, b. Contracting with a recycling hauler to haul recyclable CDL waste to and approved recycling or material recovery facility. b. Processing and reusing materials on site. c. Self-hauling to a recycling or material recovery facility. 4. Name of recycling or material recovery facility receiving the CDL wastes. 5. Handling and Transportation Procedures: Include method that will be used for separating recyclable waste including sizes of containers, container labeling, and designated location on the project site where materials separation will be located. WASTE MANAGEMENT REPORT A. Waste Management Report: Submit a cumulative waste management report, on the form included at end of this section, with each application for payment. Include the following attachments: 1. A record of the type and quantity, by weight, of each material salvaged, reused, recycled or disposed. 2. Total quantity of waste recycled as a percentage of total waste. 3. Disposal Receipts: Copy of receipts issued by a disposal facility for CDL waste that is disposed in a landfill. 4. Recycling receipts: Copy of receipts issued by an approved recycling facility. a. 5. For co-mingled materials, include weight tickets from the recycling hauler or material recovery facility and verification of the recycling rate for co-mingled loads at the facility. Salvaged Materials documentation: Types and quantities, by weight, for materials salvaged for reuse on site, sold or donated to a third party. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA CONSTRUCTION WASTE MANAGEMENT 01524-4 PART 2 – PRODUCTS (NOT APPLICABLE) PART 3 – EXECUTION 3.1 3.2 CONSTRUCTION WASTE MANAGEMENT, GENERAL A. Provide containers for CDL waste that is to be recycled clearly labeled as such with a list of acceptable and unacceptable materials. The list of acceptable materials must be the same as the materials recycled at the receiving material recovery facility or recycling processor. B. The collection containers for recyclable CDL waste must contain no more than 10"/o nonrecyclable material, by volume. C. Provide containers for CDL waste that is dispose in a landfill clearly labeled as such. D. Use detailed material estimates to reduce risk of unplanned and potentially wasteful cuts. E. To the greatest extent possible, include in material purchasing agreements a waste reduction provision requesting that materials and equipment be delivered in packaging made of recyclable material, that they reduce the amount of packaging, that packaging is taken back for reuse or recycling, and to take back all unused product. Insure that subcontractors require the same provisions in their purchase agreements. F. Conduct regular visual inspection of dumpsters and recycling bins to remove contaminants. SOURCE SEPARATION A. 3.3 General: Separate recyclable materials from CDL waste to the maximum extent, Possible. Separate recyclable materials by type. 1. Provide containers, clearly labeled, by type of separated materials or provide other storage method for managing recyclable materials until they are removed from the project site. 2. Stockpile processed materials on site without intermixing with other materials. Place, grade, and shape stockpiles to drain surface water. Cover to prevent windblown dust. 3. Stockpile materials away from demolition area. Do not store within drip line of remaining trees. 4. Store components off the ground and protect from weather. CO-MINGLED RECYCLING A. General: Do not put CDL waste that will be disposed in a landfill into a co-mingled CDL waste recycling container. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA CONSTRUCTION WASTE MANAGEMENT 01524-5 3.4 REMOVAL OF CONSTRUCTION WASTE MATERIALS A. Remove CDL waste materials from project site on a regular basis. Do not allow CDL waste to accumulate on-site. B. Transport CDL waste materials off Chicago Park District property and legally dispose of them. C. Burning of CDL waste is not permitted. END O F SECTION 01 5 24 Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA CONSTRUCTION WASTE MANAGEMENT 01524-6 WASTE MANAGEMENT PROGRESS REPORT MATERIAL CATEGORY DISPOSED IN MUNICIPAL SOLID WASTE 1. Asphalt (cu yds.) 2. Concrete (cu yds.) 3. Landscaping materials (lbs.) 3. Porcelain Plumbing Fixtures (lbs.) 4. Ferrous Metals (lbs.) 5. Non- Ferrous Metals (lbs.) 6. Wood (lbs.) 7. Glass (lbs.) 8. Clay Brick (lbs.) 9. Bond Paper (lbs.) 10. Cardboard (lbs.) 11. Plastic (lbs.) . 12. Gypsum (lbs.) 13. Paint (gal) 14. Insulation (lbs.) 15. Other (Insert Description) 16. Other (Insert Description) 17. Other (Insert Description) TOTAL (Weight) Percentage of waste diverted (total waste divided by total diverted) Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA DIVERTED FROM LANDFILL BY RECYCLING, SALVAGE OR REUSE RECYCLED SALVAGED REUSED . % CONSTRUCTION WASTE MANAGEMENT 01524-7 SECTION 01600 MATERIALS AND EQUIPMENT PART 1 - GENERAL 1.1 1.2 SUMMARY A. This Section specifies administrative a n d procedural requirements governing the Contractor's selection of products for use in the Project. B. The Contractor’s Construction Schedule and t h e Schedule of Submittals are included under Section 01010 – Summary of work. RELATED DOCUMENTS A. 1.3 DEFINITIONS A. 1.4 Drawings and general provisions of Contract, including General and Supplementary Conditions and all other Divisions of the Project Manual, apply to this Section. Definitions used in this Article are not intended to change the meaning of other terms used in the Contract Documents, such as ‘ Specialities, "systems," “Structure," "finishes," "accessories," and similar terms. Such terms are self-explanatory and have well recognized meanings in the construction industry. 1. "Products" are items purchased for i n c o r p o r a t i o n in the W o r k , w h e t h e r purchased for the Project or taken from previously purchased stock. The term ''product" includes the terms "material," ''equipment," 11system, a n d terms of similar intent. 2. "Named Products” are i t e m s identified b y manufacturer's product name, including make or model designation, indicated in the manufacturers published product literature that is current as of the date of the Contract Documents. QUALITY ASSURANCE A. Source Limitations: To t h e fullest extent possible, provide products of the same kind, from a single source. 1. When specified products are available only from sources that do not or cannot produce a quantity adequate to complete project requirements in a timely manner, consult with the Owner for a determination of the most important product qualities before proceeding. Qualities may include attributes relating to visual appearance, strength, durability, or compatibility. When a determination has been m a d e , select products from s o u rc es th at produce p r o d u c t s that possess these qualities, to the fullest extent possible. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DAFT MATERIALS AND EQUIPMENTS 01600-1 B. C. Compatibility of Options: When the Contractor is given the option of selecting betweent two or more products for use on the Project, th e product selected shall be compatible with products previously selected, even if previously selected products were also options. 1. The Contractor is responsible for providing products and construction methods that are compatible with products and construction methods of subcontractors. 2. If a dispute arises between the general Contractor and subcontractors over concurrently selectable, but incompatible products, the Owner will determine which products shall be retained and which are incompatible and must be replaced. Nameplates: Except for required labels and operating data, do not attach or imprint manufacturer's or producer's nameplates or trademarks on exposed surfaces of products which will be exposed to view. 1. D. 1.5 Labels: Locate required product labels and stamps on a concealed surface or, where required for observation after installation, on an accessible surface that is not conspicuous. Manufacturer's Instructions 1. When contract documents specify that installation shall comply with manufacturer's printed instructions, obtain and distribute copies of such instructions to all parties involved in the installation, including the Owner. 2. Maintain one set of complete instructions with the Project Record Documents at the job site during installation and until completion. PRODUCT DELIVERY, STORAGE, AND HANDLING A. Deliver, store and handle products in accordance with the manufacturer's recommendations, using means and methods that will prevent damage, deterioration and loss, including theft. 1. Schedule delivery to minimize long-term storage at the site and to prevent overcrowding of construction spaces. 2. Coordinate delivery with installation time to ensure minimum holding time for items that are flammable, hazardous, easily damaged, or sensitive to deterioration, or theft. 3. Deliver products to the site in the manufacturer's original sealed container or other packaging system, complete with labels and instructions for handling, storing, unpacking, protecting and installing. 4. Inspect products upon delivery t o ensure compliance with the Contract Documents, and to ensure that products are undamaged and properly protected. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DAFT MATERIALS AND EQUIPMENTS 01600-2 5. Store products at the site in a manner that will facilitate inspection and measurement of quantity or counting of units. 6. Store heavy materials away from the Project structure in a manner that will not endanger the supporting construction. 7. Store products subject to damage by the elements above ground, under cover in a weather tight enclosure, with ventilation adequate to prevent condensation. Maintain temperature and humidity within range required by manufacturer's instructions. B. Arrange for transportation and deliveries of materials and equipment in accord with approved current construction schedules and in ample time to facilitate inspection prior to installation. C. Coordinate deliveries to avoid conflict with work and conditions at site: 1. Work of other contractors or Owner, or their use of premises. 2. Limitations of storage space. 3. Availability of equipment and personnel for handling products. PART 2 - PRODUCTS 2.1 PRODUCT SELECTION A. General Product Requirements: Provide products that comply with the Contract Documents, that are undamaged and, unless otherwise indicated, unused at the time of installation. 1. Provide products complete with all accessories, trim, finish, safety guards and other devices and details needed for a complete installation and for the intended use and effect. 2. Standard Products: Where available, provide standard products of types that have been produced and used successfully in similar situations on other projects. 3. Comply with size, make, type and quality specified. 4. Manufactured and fabricated products: a. Design, fabricate and assemble in accord with best engineering and shop practices. b. Manufacture like parts of duplicate units to standard interchangeable sizes. c. Two o r more items of the same kind shall be identical from the Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DAFT MATERIALS AND EQUIPMENTS 01600-3 same manufacturer. B. d. All system parts shall be from t h e same manufacturer greatest extent practical. to t h e e. Adhere to equipment capacities, sizes and dimensions shown or specified unless variations are specifically approved by Change Order. Product Selection Procedures: Product selection is governed by the Contract D o c u m e n t s and governing regulations, not by previous Project experience. Procedures governing product selection include the following: 1. Proprietary Specification R e q u i r e m e n t s : Where only a single or manufacturer is named, provide the product indicated. No product s u b s t i t u t i o n s will be permitted. 2. Semi-proprietary S p e c i f i c a t i o n Requirements: Where two or more products or manufacturers are named, provide one of the products No substitutions will be permitted. indicated. a. Where products or manufacturers are specified by name, accompanied by the term “or equal,” or "or approved equal" comply with the Contract's provisions concerning “substitutions” to obtain approval for use of an unnamed product. 3. Non-Proprietary Specifications: When the Specifications l i s t s products or manufacturers that are available and may be incorporated in the Work, but do not restrict the Contractor to use of these products only, the Contractor may propose any available product that complies with Contract requirements. Comply with Contract Document provisions concerning “substitutions” to obtain approval for use of an unnamed product. 4. Descriptive Specification Requirements: Where Specifications describe a product or assembly, listing exact characteristics required, with or without use of a brand or trade name, provide a product or assembly that provides the characteristics and otherwise co mp li es with Contract requirements. 5. Performance Specification Requirements: Where Specifications require compliance with performance requirements, provide products that comply with these requirements, and are recommended by t h e manufacturer f o r the application indicated. General overall performance of a product is implied where the product is specified for a specific application. b. Manufacturer's recommendations may be contained in published product literature, or by the manufacturer's certification of performance. 7. Compliance w i t h Standards, Codes and Regulations: Where t h e Specifications only requires compliance with an imposed code, standard or regulation, select a product that complies with the standards, codes or regulations specified. 8. Visual Matching: Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DAFT Where Specifications require matching an established MATERIALS AND EQUIPMENTS 01600-4 Sample, the Owner’s decision w i l l be final on w h e t h e r a proposed product m a t c h e s satisfactorily. a. Where no product available within the s p e c i f i e d c a t e g o r y matches satisfactorily and also complies with other specified requirements, comply with provisions of the Contract Documents concerning “substitutions” for selection of a matching product in another product category, or for noncompliance with specified requirements. 9. Visual Selection: Where specified product requirements include the phrase “as selected from manufacturer's standard colors, patterns, textures..." or a similar phrase, select a product and manufacturer that complies with other specified requirements. The O w n e r w i l l select the color, pattern and texture from the product line selected. C. Deliver products in undamaged condition in original containers or packaging, with identifying labels intact and legible. D. Clearly mark partial deliveries of component parts or assemblies or equipment to permit easy identification of parts and to facilitate assembly. E. Immediately on delivery, inspect shipment to assure: 1. Product complies with contract documents and Owner 2. Quantities are correct. 3. Containers and packages are intact and labels are legible. 4. Products are properly protected and undamaged. PART 3 - EXECUTION 3.1 INSTALLATION OF PRODUCTS: A. Comply with manufacturer's instructions a n d r e c o m m e n d a t i o n s f o r i n s t a l l a t i o n of products in the applications indicated, A n c h o r each product securely in place, accurately located and aligned with other Work. 1. Clean exposed surfaces and protect as necessary to ensure freedom from damage and deterioration at time of Substantial Completion, B. Provide equipment a n d personnel to handle products and equipment, including those furnished by the Owner. Prevent damage to products or packaging. C. Provide additional protection during handling to prevent scraping, marring or otherwise damaging products, equipment or surrounding surfaces. Handle products and equipment in manner to prevent bending or overstressing. D. E. Lift packages, equipment or components only at designated lift points. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DAFT MATERIALS AND EQUIPMENTS 01600-5 END OF SECTION 01600 Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DAFT MATERIALS AND EQUIPMENTS 01600-6 SECTION 01700 PROJECT CLOSEOUT PART I – GENERAL 1.1 WORK INCLUDES A. Substantial completion, final completion, closeout submittals, and application for final payment. B. This Section specifies administrative and procedural requirements for project closeout, including but not limited to: 1. Inspection procedures. 2. Project record document submittal. 3. Operating and maintenance manual submittal. 4. Submittal of warranties including any pertinent receipts and contact information 5. Final cleaning. 6. Final payment. 1.2 RELATED WORK A. Drawings and general provisions of Contract, including General and Supplementary Conditions and all other Divisions of the Project Manual, apply to this Section. 1.3 SUBSTANTIAL COMPLETION A. When the Contractor considers the work substantially complete, Contractor shall submit written declaration to the Owner that the work, or designated portion thereof, is substantially complete. Include list of items to be completed or corrected. B. Owner and Contractor will make an inspection within seven days after receipt of certification. C. Should the Owner consider that the work is substantially complete: 1. The Owner will prepare and issue a Certificate of Substantial Completion, containing: a. Date of Substantial Completion. b. Punch list of items to be completed or corrected. c. The time within which Contractor shall complete or correct work of listed items. d. Date and time Owner will assume possession of work or designated portion thereof. e. Responsibilities of Owner and Contractor for: (1.) Insurance (2.) Utilities (3.) Operation of mechanical, electrical and other systems. (4.) Maintenance and cleaning. (5.) Security f. Signatures of Owner and Contractor D. Should the Owner consider that work is not substantially completed: 1. The Owner shall immediately notify Contractor, in writing, stating reasons. 2. The Contractor shall complete work and send a second written notice to Owner, certifying that project, or designated portion of project, is substantially complete. 3 The Owner will re-inspect work. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA PROJECT CLOSEOUT 01700-1 1.4 FINAL INSPECTION A. B. C. D. 1.5 1.6 When the Contractor considers the work complete, the Contractor shall submit written declaration to the Owner that the work is complete. Contractor shall submit written certification that: 1. Contract documents have been reviewed. 2. Project has been inspected for compliance with contract. 3. Work has been completed in accord with contract. 4. Equipment and systems have been tested in the Owner's presence and are operational. 5. Project is completed, ready for final inspection. The Owner will make final inspection within seven days after receipt of certification. Should the Owner consider that work is finally complete in accord with Contract Document requirements, he shall request contractor to make project closeout submittals. Should the Owner consider that work is not finally complete: 1. The Owner shall notify the Contractor, in writing, stating reasons. 2. The Contractor shall take immediate steps to remedy the stated deficiencies, and send second written notice to the Owner certifying that the work is complete. 3. The Owner will re-inspect work. CLOSEOUT SUBMITTALS A. Project Record Documents: A set of as built plans, testing reports and documents required in the specifications of Division 1, 2, 12 and 16. B. Deliver evidence of compliance with requirements of governing authorities. C. Deliver Certificate of Insurance and warranties for products and completed operations. Certificate shall include a evidence that insurance required by the Contract Documents to remain in force after final payment is currently in effect and will not be canceled or allowed to expire until at least 30 days prior notice has been given to the Owner. Contractor shall include a written statement that Contractor knows of no substantial reason that the insurance will not be renewable to cover the period required by the Contract Documents. D. Evidence of payments, release of liens 1. Consent of Surety to Final Payment. 2. Other data establishing payment or satisfaction of obligations including receipts, Contractor's releases and waivers of liens, claims, security interests or encumbrances arising out of the Contract, to the extent and form as required by the City. 3. Separate releases of waivers of liens for subcontractors, suppliers and others with lien rights against property of Owner together with list of those parties. 4. Paid utility bills, if any. 5. An affidavit that payrolls, bills for materials and equipment and other indebtedness connected to the work for which the City or the City's property might be responsible or encumbered owes any amounts withheld by City) have been paid or otherwise satisfied. INSTRUCTION A. Instruct Owner's personnel in operation of all systems electrical and other equipment. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA PROJECT CLOSEOUT 01700-2 1.7 FINAL ADJUSTMENT OF ACCOUNTS A. Submit final statement of accounting to Owner. B. Statement shall reflect all adjustments. 1. 2. B. Original contract sum. Additions and deductions resulting from: a. Previous change orders. b. Cash allowances. c. Unit prices. d. Other adjustments. e. Deductions for uncorrected work. f. Deductions for re-inspection payments. 3. Total contract sum, as adjusted. 4. Previous payments. 5. Sum remaining due. The Owner will prepare final change order, reflecting approved adjustments to contract sum not previously made by change orders. 1.8 FINAL APPLICATION FOR PAYMENT A. Contractor shall submit final application in accord with requirements of Conditions of Contract. 1.9 FINAL CERTIFICATE FOR PAYMENT A. The Owner will issue final certificate in accord with provisions of Conditions of contract. B. Should final completion be materially delayed through no fault of the Contractor, the Owner may issue a Semi-Final Certificate of Payment, in accord with provisions of Conditions of Contract. END OF SECTION 01700 Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA PROJECT CLOSEOUT 01700-3 SECTION 02070 SELECTIVE DEMOLITION PART I- GENERAL 1.1 DESCRIPTION A. Work included: Provide labor, material, equipment and services required to complete selective demolition work shown or specified, including but not necessarily limited to: 1. Careful demolition and removal from the site of those items identified to be demolished. 2. Salvage, store and maintain materials for reuse. B. Related work 1. Section 02071 Tree Protection 2. Section 02831 Ornamental Fencing 1.2 QUALITY ASSURANCE A. Use adequate numbers of skilled workmen who are thoroughly trained and experienced in the necessary crafts and who are thoroughly familiar with specified requirements and methods needed for proper installation of work of this section. 1.3 PRODUCT HANDLING A. Comply with pertinent provisions of Sections 01600, 02316 and 02318. PART II- PRODUCTS (No products are required in this Section) PART III -EXECUTION 3.1 SURFACE CONDITIONS A. Examine the areas and conditions under which work of this section will be performed. Correct conditions detrimental to timely and proper completion of work. Do not proceed until unsatisfactory conditions are corrected. 3.2 DEMOLITION A. By careful study of the Contract Documents, determine the location and extent of selective demolition to be performed. B. Visit the site and verify the extent and location of selective demolition required. 1. Carefully identify limits of selective demolition. 2. Mark interface surfaces as required to enable workmen also to identify items to be removed and items to be left in place intact. C. Prepare and follow an organized plan for demolition and removal of items. 1. Shut off, cap and otherwise protect existing public utility lines in accordance with the requirements of the public agency or utility having jurisdiction. Restore utilities damaged during demolition at no additional cost to Owner. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA SELECTIVE DEMOLITION 02070-1 2. Shut off, cap, plug, disconnect and render safe existing mechanical and electrical systems in areas to be selectively demolished. Prepare for modification or extension under sections governing new work. 3. Completely remove items scheduled to be so demolished and removed, leaving surfaces clean, solid and ready to receive new materials specified elsewhere. 4. In all activities, comply with pertinent regulations of governmental agencies having jurisdiction. 5. As noted on plans, remove items by hand in areas adjacent to trees to remain. D. Unless identified as material to be relocated or reused, demolished material shall be handled and removed from the job site as noted in the contract documents. Use means necessary to prevent dust becoming a nuisance to the public, to neighbors and to other work being performed on or near the site. 3.3 MATERIALS FOR REUSE A. Carefully disassemble or remove intact, those items designated for reuse. B. Store, protect, maintain in good condition and deliver to appropriate installing party when required. 3.4 REPLACEMENTS A. In the event of demolition of items not so scheduled to be demolished, promptly replace such items to the approval of the Owner's representative and at no additional cost to the Owner. END OF SECTION 02070 Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA SELECTIVE DEMOLITION 02070-2 SECTION 02071 TREE PROTECTION AND TRIMMING PART 1 - GENERAL 1.1 1.2 SUMMARY A. Protection and trimming of trees that interfere with, or are affected by, execution of the Work, whether temporary or new construction. B. Protection of existing trees. SUBMITTALS A. Product Data: For each type of product indicated. B. Qualification Data: For firms and persons specified in "Quality Assurance" Article to demonstrate their capabilities and experience. Include lists of completed projects with project names and addresses, names and addresses of architects and owners, and other information specified. C. Existing Conditions: Documentation of existing trees and plantings indicated to remain, which establishes preconstruction conditions. 1. Use sufficiently detailed photographs or videotape. 2. Include plans and notations to indicate specific wounds and damage conditions of each tree or other plants designated to remain. 1.3 D. Certification: From a qualified arborist that trees indicated to remain have been protected during construction according to recognized standards. Certification to include appraised monetary value for each tree indicated to remain prior to start of construction. E. Maintenance Recommendations: From a qualified arborist for care and protection of trees affected by construction during and after completing the Work. QUALITY ASSURANCE A. Tree Service Qualifications: Provide an experienced tree service firm acceptable to the Owner that has successfully completed tree protection and trimming work similar to that required for this Project and that will assign an experienced, qualified arborist to Project site on a full-time basis during execution of the Work. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA TREE PROTECTION AND TRIMMING 02071-1 B. Arborist Qualifications: Provide an arborist acceptable to the Owner that is certified by the International Society of Arboriculture or licensed in the jurisdiction where Project is located. C. Tree Pruning Standards: Comply with ANSI A300, "Trees, Shrubs, and Other Woody Plant Maintenance--Standard Practices," unless more stringent requirements are indicated. D. Preinstallation Conference: Conduct conference at Project site 1. Before starting tree protection and trimming, meet with representatives of authorities having jurisdiction, Owner, Architect, consultants, and other concerned entities. Review tree protection and trimming procedures and responsibilities. Notify participants at least three working days before convening conference. Record discussions and agreements and furnish a copy to each participant. PART 2 - PRODUCTS 2.1 MATERIALS A. Drainage Fill: Selected crushed stone, or crushed or uncrushed gravel, washed, ASTM D 448, Size 24, with 90 to 100 percent passing a 2-1/2-inch (63-mm) sieve and not more than 10 percent passing a 3/4-inch (19-mm) sieve and conforming to Section 02222. B. Topsoil: Fertile, friable, surface soil, containing natural loam and complying with ASTM D 5268 and Section 02318. Provide topsoil that is free of stones larger than 1 inch (25 mm) in any dimension and free of other extraneous or toxic matter harmful to plant growth. Obtain topsoil only from well-drained sites where soil occurs in depth of 4 inches (100 mm) or more; do not obtain from bogs or marshes. C. Filter Fabric: Manufacturer's standard, nonwoven, pervious, geotextile fabric of polypropylene, nylon, or polyester fibers. D. Chain Link Fence: Metallic-coated steel chain link fence fabric, 0.120-inch- (3-mm-) diameter wire size; 48 inches (1200 mm) high, minimum; line posts, 1.9 inches (48 mm) in diameter; terminal and corner posts, 2-3/8 inches (60 mm) in diameter; top rail, 1-5/8 inches (41 mm) in diameter; bottom tension wire, 0.177 inch (4.5 mm) in diameter; with tie wires, hog ring ties, and other accessories for a complete fence system. PART 3 - EXECUTION 3.1 PREPARATION A. Temporary Fencing: Install temporary fencing located as indicated or outside the drip line of trees to protect remaining vegetation from construction damage. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA TREE PROTECTION AND TRIMMING 02071-2 1. Install chain link fence according to ASTM F 567 and manufacturer's written instructions. B. Protect tree root systems from damage due to noxious materials caused by runoff or spillage while mixing, placing, or storing construction materials. Protect root systems from flooding, eroding, or excessive wetting caused by dewatering operations. C. Do not store construction materials, debris, or excavated material within the drip line of remaining trees. Do not permit vehicles or foot traffic within the drip line; prevent soil compaction over root systems. Maintain protection zones free of weeds and trash. D. Do not allow fires under or adjacent to remaining trees or other plants. E. Protection-Zone Signage: Install protection-zone signage in visibly prominent locations in a manner approved by architect. Install one sign spaced approximately every 20 feet on protection-zone fencing, but no fewer than four signs with each facing a different direction. F. Maintain protection-zone fencing and signage in good condition as acceptable to Architect and remove when construction operations are complete and equipment has been removed from the site. 1. Do not remove protection-zone fencing, even temporarily, to allow deliveries or equipment access through the protection zone. 2. Temporary access is permitted subject to preapproval in writing by arborist if a root buffer effective against soil compaction is constructed as directed by arborist. Maintain root buffer so long as access is permitted. 3.2 EXCAVATION A. Install shoring or other protective support systems to minimize sloping or benching of excavations. B. Do not excavate within drip line of trees, unless otherwise indicated. C. Where excavation for new construction is required within drip line of trees, hand clear and excavate to minimize damage to root systems. Use narrow-tine spading forks and comb soil to expose roots. 1. Relocate roots in backfill areas where possible. If encountering large, main lateral roots, expose roots beyond excavation limits as required to bend and relocate them without breaking. If encountered immediately adjacent to location of new construction and relocation is not practical, cut roots approximately 3 inches (75 mm) back from new construction. 2. Do not allow exposed roots to dry out before placing permanent backfill. Provide temporary earth cover or pack with peat moss and wrap with burlap. Water and maintain in a moist condition. Temporarily support and protect roots from damage until they are permanently relocated and covered with soil. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA TREE PROTECTION AND TRIMMING 02071-3 D. Where utility trenches are required within drip line of trees, tunnel under or around roots by drilling, auger boring, pipe jacking, or digging by hand. 1. Root Pruning: Do not cut main lateral roots or taproots; cut only smaller roots that interfere with installation of utilities. Cut roots with sharp pruning instruments; do not break or chop. 3.3 REGRADING A. Grade Lowering: Where new finish grade is indicated below existing grade around trees, slope grade beyond drip line of trees. Maintain existing grades within drip line of trees. B. Grade Lowering: Where new finish grade is indicated below existing grade around trees, slope grade away from trees as recommended by qualified arborist, unless otherwise indicated. 1. Root Pruning: Prune tree roots exposed during grade lowering. Do not cut main lateral roots or taproots; cut only smaller roots. Cut roots with sharp pruning instruments; do not break or chop. C. Minor Fill: Where existing grade is 6 inches (150 mm) or less below elevation of finish grade, fill with topsoil. Place topsoil in a single uncompacted layer and hand grade to required finish elevations. D. Moderate Fill: Where existing grade is more than 6 inches (150 mm), but less than 12 inches (300 mm), below elevation of finish grade, place drainage fill, filter fabric, and topsoil on existing grade as follows: 1. Carefully place drainage fill against tree trunk approximately 2 inches (50 mm) above elevation of finish grade and extend not less than 18 inches (450 mm) from tree trunk on all sides. For balance of area within drip-line perimeter, place drainage fill up to 6 inches (150 mm) below elevation of grade. 2. Place filter fabric with edges overlapping 6 inches (150 mm) minimum. 3. Place fill layer of topsoil to finish grade. Do not compact drainage fill or topsoil. Hand grade to required finish elevations. 3.4 TREE PRUNING A. Notify the Owner prior to pruning the trees outside the property. B. Prune remaining trees affected by temporary and new construction. C. Prune remaining trees to compensate for root loss caused by damaging or cutting root system. Provide subsequent maintenance during Contract period as recommended by Owner. D. Pruning Standards: Prune trees according to ANSI A300 as follows: Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA TREE PROTECTION AND TRIMMING 02071-4 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. E. 3.5 Type of Pruning: Type of Pruning: Type of Pruning: Type of Pruning: Type of Pruning: Type of Pruning: Crown cleaning. Crown thinning. Crown raising. Crown reduction. Vista pruning. Crown restoration. Cut branches with sharp pruning instruments; do not break or chop. TREE REPAIR AND REPLACEMENT A. Notify the Owner of any damage to the trees outside the property limits. Repair to the damaged trees will be at no extra cost to the owner and will be as per Owner’s instructions. 3.6 DISPOSAL OF WASTE MATERIALS A. Burning is not permitted. B. Disposal: Remove excess excavated material in accordance with Sections 02316 and 02318, displaced trees, and excess chips from Owner's property. END OF SECTION 02071 Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA TREE PROTECTION AND TRIMMING 02071-5 SECTION 02073 GEOTEXTILES PART 1 - GENERAL 1.1 1.2 SUMMARY A. Work under this Section is subject to the requirements of the Contract Documents. B. Furnish and install all Geotextiles for use as shown on the Contract Drawings and must conform to the requirements for woven and non-woven fabrics as provided in Table 1 of this specification. C. Install products and materials as shown on the Drawings and as specified herein. SUBMITTALS A. Submit the following 1. Shop Drawings a. Fabric panel layout and seams or overlap. b. Placement and method of holding in place. 2. Samples and Product Data a. Product Data b. Samples 3. Test Reports a. Submit test reports necessary to show compliance with the Contract Documents. b. A certification of compliance from the Geotextile Manufacturer that the product(s) delivered to the Project must have property values equal to or greater than those specified. c. Factory test results of materials certified by the manufacturer as being similar, showing conformance with the requirements of the Contract Documents. Certified property values must be equal to the average value less two standard deviations. A swatch of the geotextile to be used must be submitted with the certification letter. B. The Contractor must make available quality control test results for the materials delivered to the Project. Quality control sampling must be done in accordance with ASTM D-4354, and the samples must be tested according to ASTM standards to grab tensile strength, trapezoidal tear strength, and puncture resistance. At least one AOS and one permeability test must be performed per lot number. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA GEOTEXTILES 02073-1 1.3 1.4 QUALITY ASSURANCE A. Contractor Qualifications: Installation of geotextile fabrics must be performed only by a qualified Installer. The term qualified means experienced in performing the Work required by this Section. The Contractor must have a minimum of five (5) years documented experience in Projects similar in size and scope to this Project. The Contractor must submit evidence of such qualifications upon request by the Owner. B. Perform work in accordance with the appropriate divisions of the latest edition of IDOT Standard Specifications. DELIVERY, STORAGE, AND HANDLING A. Materials must be delivered to the Project in sealed containers bearing Manufacturer's name and material identification. Materials must be stored in strict accordance with the Manufacturer's printed directions, copies of which must be furnished to the Owner. B. Protect materials against damage from mechanical abuse, plaster, salts, acids, staining and other foreign matter by an approved means during transportation, storage and erection and until completion of construction Work. All unsatisfactory materials must be removed from the premises, and all damaged materials replaced with new materials. C. Access and Storage Areas 1. All access routes and storage areas must be subject to the approval of the Owner. PART 2 - PRODUCTS 2.1 MATERIALS A. Fibers, used in the manufacture of geotextiles, and threads, used in joining geotextiles by sewing, must consist of long chain synthetic polymers, composed of at least 95 percent by weight polypropylene or polyester. The material must be free of defects and tears and must meet or exceed the material requirements as listed below. B. The geotextile must meet or exceed the minimum property values in Table 1. TABLE 1 Physical Property Requirements Test Grab Tensile D-4632) Woven Strength (ASTM 270 lbs. Non-woven 180 lbs. Puncture Resistance (ASTM D-4833) 100 lbs. 75 lbs. Trapezoid Tear Strength (ASTM 100 lbs. D-4533) 75 lbs. Apparent Opening Size (ASTM 0.3 mm Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA GEOTEXTILES 02073-2 D-4751) Permeability (ASTM D-4491)k Ultraviolet D-4355) 1. C. (ASTM 70% strength 500 hrs exposure Values shown are minimum roll average values with strength values based on the weaker principle direction. Acceptance or rejection of the geotextile must be solely based on the ASTM D-4759 procedure. Manufacturers: Subject to compliance with requirements, provide products by one of the following: 1. 2. 3. 2.2 Degradation 10k or 0.1 cm/sec Tencate Mirafi Triumph Geo-Synthetics, Inc. US Fabrics, Inc., US 180NW PACKAGING A. Geotextile materials delivered to the site must be furnished with an outer plastic wrapping suitable for protection against moisture and extended ultraviolet exposure prior to placement. An opaque tarp must be placed over all rolls where the outer wrap is removed or damaged, such that the geotextile fabric has become exposed. B. Each roll of geotextile will be externally labeled or tagged to provide product identification sufficient for field identification, as well as inventory and quality control purposes. As a minimum, external tagging must include: 1. Name of Manufacturer 2. Product Type and Style 3. Product Grade 4. Lot Number 5. Physical Dimensions (Length and width) C. The product grade, manufacturers name, and lot number must be clearly marked directly on geotextile at the beginning and end of each roll or product: D. Rolls must be stored in a manner which protects them from the elements. If stored outdoors, they must be elevated and protected with a waterproof cover. PART 3 - EXECUTION 3.1 INSTALLATION A. The installation site must be prepared by clearing and grading the areas as indicated on the Plans. Remove all sharp objects, large stones, stumps, etc. B. The geotextile must be unrolled as smoothly as possible with no wrinkles or folds (except in curved Sections and corners) on the prepared subgrade. Adjacent rolls may be Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA GEOTEXTILES 02073-3 connected by sewn or sealed seams, provided the seam meets or exceeds the grab strength requirement in Table 1. 3.2 C. For curves, the geotextile must be folded or cut and overlapped in the direction of the turn. Overlaps must be 12 inches or greater. Folds in geotextile must be stapled or pinned five feet on center. D. The aggregate must be placed onto the geotextile from the edge of the fabric or over previously placed aggregate. The first lift of aggregate must be spread and graded down to the design thickness. Compaction by hand and pneumatic tampers to achieve the specified density will be allowed. The compaction must be done in a manner to avoid injurious top or side pressure on the pipe or damage to the filter fabric. Construction vehicles that create ruts in the apron surface of greater than three inches will not be allowed. All ruts occurring during construction must be filled with additional aggregate and compacted to the specified density. Sudden stops and starts must be avoided where possible. E. Holes, tears, or otherwise damaged geotextiles, as determined by the Owner, must be repaired immediately at the Contractor's expense. The damaged area must be cleared of all fill material, a suitable distance from the damaged area, to allow placement of a geotextile patch, which extends three feet beyond perimeter of the damaged area. Aggregate removed must be replaced to the specified lift thickness and density. GENERAL CLEAN-UP A. All rubbish and debris resulting from the Work of this Section must be collected, removed from the site and legally disposed off the Owner’s property. B. All work areas must be left in a broom clean condition. END OF SECTION 02073 Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA GEOTEXTILES 02073-4 SECTION 02074 PAVEMENT REMOVAL PART 1 - GENERAL 1.1 SUMMARY A. The Work shall be in accordance with Section 440 of Illinois Department of Transportation (IDOT) Standard Specifications for Road and Bridge Construction (SSRBC), adopted January 1, 2012. B. Provide all labor, materials and equipment required for the removal work and disposal of existing Pavements indicated on the drawings and specified, including but not limited to the following: C. 1.2 1. Saw cutting existing concrete pavements, sidewalks, driveways, curbs and gutters noted on Drawings to be removed. 2. Saw cutting existing concrete sidewalks for new pipe trench noted on Drawings to be removed. 3. Saw cutting existing bituminous paving and/or concrete paving for new pipe trench noted on Drawings to be removed. 4. Removal and disposal of demolished concrete sidewalks, driveways, curbs and gutters. 5. Removal and disposal of demolished bituminous paving and/or concrete paving. 6. All excavating, rough grading and compacting as required to establish subgrade for new sidewalks, and Subgrade and Sub-Base for driveways. 7. Providing, placing and grading sand fill under new sidewalks. Top of compacted subgrades will allow for the placement of sidewalks plus thickness of sand fill. 8. Removal and disposal of excavated material. Install products and materials as shown on the Contract Documents. SPECIAL REQUIREMENTS A. Protection: Provide protection barricades, maintain all lights and signals and other measures as required by federal, state, and municipal laws, for the full period of demolition operations and remove same when directed. In removing work, perform all work required to protect and maintain adjacent property, streets, alleys, sidewalks, curbs, and other structures remaining in place. B. Utility Services: Maintain existing utilities unless otherwise noted for removal, keep in service, and protect against damage during demolition operations. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA PAVEMENT REMOVAL 02074-1 1. Do not interrupt existing utilities serving occupied or used facilities, except when authorized in writing by authorities having jurisdiction. Provide temporary services during interruptions to existing utilities. PART 2 - PRODUCTS 2.1 BACKFILLING MATERIAL A. Sand 1. B. Sand having a FA-6 gradation conforming to Article 1003 of the IDOT SSRBC Specifications. Crushed Stone 1. Crushed stone having a CA - 6 gradation conforming to Article 1004 of the IDOT SSRBC Specifications. PART 3 - EXECUTION 3.1 DEMOLITION A. The Contractor must accept the site as he finds it and must inform himself as to the character and types of Work to be removed. The Architect assumes no responsibility for the condition of the existing construction to be removed or demolished. B. No demolition will be commenced until a program of operations has been coordinated with the Owner, except that preparatory work may be started if specifically approved by the Owner. C. Operations must be done in such manner as to avoid hazards to persons and property and interference with use of adjacent areas or interruption of free passage to and from such areas. Maintain Pedestrian access to all private entrances where construction of new sidewalks is in progress. Provide temporary walk ways or other means as required to maintain entry into the building, complying with all laws and ordinances and as approved by the Owner. Care must be taken to prevent the spread of dust and flying particles. D. Demolition and removal Work must be executed in a careful and orderly manner. Accumulation of rubbish will not be permitted. E. After Work is started, it must be continued to completion at a rate that will allow the balance of the work to be completed within the time specified. If extra shifts are necessary beyond regular working hours, the work must proceed with a minimum of nuisance to surrounding properties. F. Contractor must determine the nature and extent of demolition that will be necessary by comparing the Contract Documents with the existing field conditions. It is expressly understood that this Contract includes all work of a demolition nature that may be required or necessary for a full and complete execution of the work, whether particularly referred to herein or not. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA PAVEMENT REMOVAL 02074-2 3.2 3.3 3.4 REMOVAL AND EXCAVATION A. When removing existing sidewalks, driveways, curbs and gutters provisions must be made for satisfactory transition between replacements and the portion remaining in place. The Contractor must saw cut to a minimum depth of 1-½ inches with a concrete sawing machine to prevent the surface from spilling when the concrete is broken out. This Work must be done in such a manner that a straight joint will be secured. B. It must be the responsibility of the Contractor to determine the thickness of the existing sidewalk, driveways, curb and gutter, etc. to be removed. No additional compensation will be allowed because of variations from the assumed thickness or from the thickness shown on the Plans. C. After existing concrete sidewalks and driveways have been removed, excavate to depth required for sand fill. D. The bottoms of all excavations must be properly leveled off and all loose materials must be removed from excavations. All wood, timber and organic materials that are exposed at the bottom of all excavations, must be removed and the area backfilled with the material specified on the drawings and compacted. E. Any excess or unauthorized excavation must be backfilled with sand and compacted, at no additional cost to the owner. F. No backfill will be placed in standing water, on frozen ground or on surfaces which have not been approved by the Owner. G. Backfilling for all areas must be approved material. Backfill must be compacted to at least 95 percent of the laboratory maximum dry density as determined in accordance with ASTM D 1557. H. Contractor must determine the nature and extent of excavation work that will be necessary by comparing the Contract Documents with the existing areas to be excavated. It is expressly understood that this Contract includes all work of an excavation nature that may be required or necessary for a complete execution of all excavation work, whether particularly referred to herein or not. DISPOSAL OF MATERIALS A. All demolished and unsuitable materials, including excavated earth removed to establish required grade elevations must be disposed of in accordance with Section 02316. B. If hazardous materials are encountered during demolition operations, comply with applicable regulations, laws, and ordinances concerning removal, handling and protection against exposure or environmental pollution and to the satisfactory owner. C. Burning of removed materials will not be permitted on site. CLEAN-UP A. On completion of the demolition work, excavation work and before acceptance by the Owner as recommended by the Architect, clean the areas affected, including areas outside the limits Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA PAVEMENT REMOVAL 02074-3 of the Contractor's work area where permission to work has been granted. Remove surplus construction material or debris resulting from the demolition work and excavation work, and dispose of legally off the site. B. Access routes to and from the site must be kept clean of debris resulting from the work. C. Repair demolition performed in excess of that required. Return adjacent areas to condition existing prior to start of selective demolition work. Repair adjacent construction or surfaces soiled or damaged by selective demolition work. END OF SECTION 02074 Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA PAVEMENT REMOVAL 02074-4 SECTION 02222 TRENCH BACKFILL PART 1 – GENERAL 1.1 SUMMARY A. 1.2 Storm and Sanitary Sewer 2. Water 3. Gas ”Standard Specifications for Road and Bridge Construction” (SSRBC), Illinois Department of Transportation, adopted January 1, 2012. QUALITY CONTROL A. 1.5 1. REFERENCES A. 1.3 Furnish and install all stabilization stone, bedding material, fine aggregate for Trench Backfill and approved backfill material for all trenches (pipes) and structure excavations as shown on the Drawings and as specified herein, including but not limited to the following: Regulatory Requirements: Comply with City of Chicago, Department of Water Management, applicable to materials, installation and testing. SUBMITTALS A. Submit the following 1. Product Data 2. Test reports: Submit test reports necessary to show compliance with the contract documents 3. Manufacturer’s certification: Submit certification that products meet or exceeds the specified requirements. PART 2 - PRODUCTS 2.1 MATERIALS A. FINE AGGREGATE 1. Fine aggregate for trench backfill for sewers and electrical trenches shall consist of natural sand having FA-6 gradation as specified in Section 1003 of the SSRBC and in accordance with Section 02318. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA TRENCH BACKFILL 02222-1 B. APPROVED BACKFILL MATERIAL 1. C. D. Approved backfill material shall be as shown on the drawings. For placement and compaction requirement refer Section 02300 - Excavation and Earthwork. BEDDING MATERIAL 1. Bedding material for storm sewer, pipes sanitary shall be gravel, crushed gravel or crushed stone having a CA-11 gradation conforming to Section 1004 of the Standard Specifications for Road and Bridge Construction, latest edition, by Illinois Department of Transportation (SSRBC). 2. Bedding material for water pipe shall be gravel, crushed gravel or crushed stone having a CA-16 gradation conforming to Section 1004 of the Standard Specifications for Road and Bridge Construction, latest edition, by Illinois Department of Transportation (SSRBC). STABILIZATION STONE 1. Stabilization stone shall be crushed stone having CA-1 gradation conforming to Section 1004 of the Standard Specifications for Road and Bridge Construction, latest edition, by Illinois Department of Transportation (SSRBC). PART 3 - EXECUTION 3.1 3.2 GENERAL A. Notify the owner atleast 3 days prior to backfilling the trenches. Backfilling is to be performed in the presence of the Owner’s representative. B. All trenches and excavations shall be backfilled by the end of the day in which pipes have been installed. The backfill material shall be as specified herein. Backfill materials and compaction procedures shall be approved by the Owners Testing Lab. In all backfilling, any compressible or destructible rubbish and refuse shall be removed from the excavated space before backfilling is started, except that sheeting and bracing shall be left in place or removed as the work progresses. C. Trench excavated with sloped or benched wall shall be backfilled for the full width of the trench. D. All backfill materials shall be placed longitudinally along the trench. The backfill material shall be brought up evenly on each side of the pipe or duct. TRENCH STABILIZATION A. If Owners Testing Lab finds that the materials encountered at the elevations specified are unstable and not suitable or in case it is found desirable or necessary to go to an additional depth, the excavation shall be carried to such additional depth as Owner may direct in writing. The Contractor shall refill such excavated space with Stabilization Stone. Stabilization Stone shall be compacted to a firm condition. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA TRENCH BACKFILL 02222-2 3.3 BEDDING A. 3.4 FINE AGGREGATE A. 3.5 3.6 3.7 The pipe laid in trenches shall be bedded in accordance with the details shown on the Plans. Bedding material shall be as specified. Bedding shall be to a minimum of spring line of the pipe. The bedding material shall be placed over the stabilization stone or trench subgrade as applicable. The fine aggregate for trench backfill shall be brought up evenly on each side of the pipe or structure to an elevation 1 foot over the top of the pipe. If the trench is to be under pavement, or within 2 feet of the proposed, future or existing pavement edge, then placement and compaction of the fine aggregate trench backfill shall continue until the top of subgrade is reached. If the trench is not under, or adjacent to, existing, proposed or future pavement, then acceptable fill shall be placed and compacted from an elevation one foot over the top of the pipe to top of subgrade. MATERIAL PLACEMENT A. Material used as stabilization, bedding, or fine aggregate trench backfill to one foot over the top of the pipe shall be placed by hand in uniform layers not greater than 6 inches in loose thickness and thoroughly compacted in place. Special care shall be taken to secure thorough compaction under the haunches and at the sides of the pipe. B. Each layer of bedding material and fine aggregate backfill shall be thoroughly tamped and compacted in place with vibratory methods to at least 95% of the maximum laboratory dry density as determined in accordance with ASTM D 1557. C. If the backfill placed from one foot above the pipe is fine aggregate trench backfill, it shall be placed in uniform layers not greater than 9 inches in loose thickness and thoroughly compacted in place with suitable equipment to at least 95% of the maximum laboratory dry density as determined in accordance with ASTM D 1557. Each lift of Approved Backfill Material shall be within + 2% of optimum moisture content before the succeeding lift is placed. If the backfill is approved backfill material it shall be placed in uniform layers not greater than 12 inches in loose thickness and each layer compacted to at least 85% of the maximum laboratory dry density as determined in accordance with ASTM D 1557. GRADING A. Final grading shall be performed in accordance with the completed contour elevations and grades shown and shall be made to blend into the existing or plan ground surfaces. All finished grading surfaces shall be left smooth and free to drain. Finish grades shall be brought to elevations within plus or minus 0.10 foot of elevations or contours shown. B. Where necessary or where shown, final grading shall be extended to insure that water shall be carried off and the site area left smooth and free from depressions holding water. SETTLEMENT A. Any depression which may develop from settlement in backfilled areas within one year after the work is fully completed and accepted shall be the responsibility of the Contractor. The Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA TRENCH BACKFILL 02222-3 Contractor shall provide, as needed, at contractors expense, additional backfill material, pavement base replacement, permanent pavement repairs or replacement and shall perform the necessary reconditioning and restoration work to bring such depressed areas to proper grade as approved by Owner. 3.8 TESTING A. A Minimum of 1 test per 100 LF of trench, each lift, a minimum 3 test per lift, or as directed by Owner. Trench backfill compaction shall be tested and monitored by the Contractor. All material and backfill operations shall be subjected to testing by Owners Testing Lab with the assistance of the Contractor. END OF SECTION 02222 Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA TRENCH BACKFILL 02222-4 SECTION 02240 DEWATERING PART 1 – GENERAL 1.1 SUMMARY A. 1.2 PERFORMANCE REQUIREMENTS A. 1.3 Dewatering system as required to control surface and ground water for dry construction operations. Dewatering Performance: Design, furnish, install, operate, monitor and maintain dewatering system of sufficient scope, size and capacity to control surface and ground-water flow into excavations and permit construction to proceed on dry, stable sub grades. 1. Maintain dewatering operations to ensure erosion control, stability of excavations and constructed slopes, that excavation does not flood and that damage to sub grades and permanent structures is prevented. 2. Prevent surface water from entering excavations by grading, dikes and other means. 3. Accomplish dewatering without damaging existing structures adjacent to excavation. 4. Remove dewatering system if no longer needed. SUBMITTALS A. Submit the following 1. Shop Drawings for Information: For dewatering system, show arrangement, locations and details of wells and well points; locations of headers and discharge lines; and means of discharge and disposal of water. Contractor to identify their general groundwater dewatering plan prior to construction start. a. Include layouts of piezometers and flow-measuring devices for monitoring performance of dewatering system. b. Include a written report outlining control procedures to be adopted if dewatering problems arise. c. Include Shop Drawings signed and sealed by the qualified Illinois Licensed Professional engineer responsible for their preparation. B. Qualification Data: Contractor to submit qualification data and experience for the Installer and Illinois Licensed Professional Engineer. C. Photographs or Videotape, sufficiently detailed, of existing conditions of adjoining construction and site improvements that might be misconstrued as damage caused by dewatering operations. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA DEWATERING 02240-1 D. Record Drawings at Project closeout identifying and locating capped utilities and other subsurface structural, electrical or mechanical conditions performed during dewatering. 1. E. 1.4 1.5 Note locations and capping depth of wells and well points. Field Test Reports: Before starting excavation, contractor to submit test results and computations by the Illinois Licensed Professional engineer demonstrating that dewatering system is capable of meeting performance requirements. QUALITY CONTROL A. Regulatory Requirements: Comply with water disposal requirements of the City of Chicago, Metropolitan Water Reclamation District and any other party having jurisdiction. B. Pre-installation Conference: Conduct conference at Project site to comply with Project requirements. PROJECT CONDITIONS A. Existing Utilities: Do not interrupt utilities serving facilities occupied by Owner or others unless permitted in writing and then only after arranging to provide temporary utility services according to requirements indicated. B. Project-Site Information: A geotechnical report has been prepared for this Project and is available for information only. The opinions expressed in this report are those of geotechnical engineer and represent interpretations of subsoil conditions, tests and results of analyses conducted by geotechnical engineer. Owner will not be responsible for interpretations or conclusions drawn from this data. 1. C. Make additional test borings and conduct other exploratory operations necessary for dewatering. Survey adjacent structures and improvements, employing a qualified Illinois Licensed Professional engineer or land surveyor, establishing exact elevations at fixed points to act as benchmarks. Clearly identify benchmarks and record existing elevations. 1. During dewatering, regularly resurvey benchmarks maintaining an accurate log of surveyed elevations for comparison with original elevations. Promptly notify Owner if changes in elevations occur or if cracks, sags, or other damage is evident in adjacent construction. PART 2 - PRODUCTS (NOT USED) PART 3 - EXECUTION 3.1 PREPARATION A. Protect structures, utilities, sidewalks, pavements and other facilities from damage caused by settlement, lateral movement, undermining, washout and other hazards created by dewatering operations. 1. Prevent surface water and subsurface or ground water from entering excavations, from ponding on prepared subgrades, and from flooding site and surrounding area. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA DEWATERING 02240-2 2. B. 3.2 Protect subgrades and foundation soils from softening and damage by rain or water accumulation. Install dewatering system to ensure minimum interference with roads, streets, walks, and other adjacent occupied and used facilities. 1. Do not close or obstruct streets, walks or other adjacent occupies or used facilities without permission from authorities having jurisdiction. Provide alternate routes around closed or obstructed traffic ways if required by authorities having jurisdiction. 2. Notify the owner prior to paying the Discharge or application fees as the fees may be waived for a CPD project. INSTALLATION A. Install dewatering system utilizing wells, well points, or similar methods complete with pump equipment, standby power and pumps, filter material gradation, valves, appurtenances, water disposal, and surface-water controls. B. Before excavating below ground-water level, place system into operation to lower water to specified levels. Operate system continuously until drains, sewers, and structures have been constructed and fill materials have been placed, or until dewatering is no longer required. C. Provide an adequate system to lower and control ground water to permit excavation, construction of structures, and placement of fill materials on dry subgrades. Install sufficient dewatering equipment to drain water-bearing strata above and below bottom of foundations, drains, sewers and other excavations. 1. D. Do not permit open-sump pumping that leads to loss of fines, soil piping, subgrade softening, and slope instability. Reduce hydrostatic head in water-bearing strata below subgrade elevations of foundations, drains, sewers and other excavations. 1. Maintain piezometric water level a minimum of 3 feet below surface of excavation. E. Dispose of water removed by dewatering in accordance with Section 02240 – Dewatering. F. Provide standby equipment on-site, installed and available for immediate operation, to maintain dewatering on continuous basis if any part of system becomes inadequate or fails. If dewatering requirements are not satisfied due to inadequacy or failure of dewatering system, restore damaged structures and foundation soils at no additional expense to Owner. 1. G. Remove dewatering system from Project site on completion of dewatering. Plug or fill well holes with sand or cut off and cap wells a minimum of 36 inches below overlying construction. Damages: Promptly repair damages to adjacent facilities caused by dewatering operations. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA DEWATERING 02240-3 3.3 OBSERVATION WELLS A. Provide, take measurements and maintain at least the minimum number of observation wells or piezometers indicated and additional observation wells as may be required by authorities having jurisdiction. B. Observe and record daily elevation of ground water and piezometric water levels in observation wells. C. Repair or replace, within 24 hours, observation wells that become inactive, damaged or destroyed. Suspend construction activities in areas where observation wells are not functioning properly until reliable observations can be made. Add or remove water from observation-well risers to demonstrate that observation wells are functioning properly. 1. Fill observation wells, remove piezometers, and fill holes with sand after dewatering is completed. END OF SECTION 02240 Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA DEWATERING 02240-4 SECTION 02270 EROSION CONTROL PART 1 - GENERAL 1.1 1.2 SUMMARY A. The Work shall be in accordance with Section 250, 251 and 280 of Illinois Department of Transportation (IDOT) Standard Specifications for Road and Bridge Construction (SSRBC), adopted January 1, 2012. B. Work includes but is not limited labor, services, and materials needed to prevent the erosion and degradation of soils and waterways in and around the construction site. C. Soil erosion control measures in accordance with the “Illinois Urban Manual” and NPDES general permit no. ILR1 0 shall be followed. Any soil erosion control measures, in addition to those outlined in these plans and which are deemed necessary by the Owner shall be implemented immediately by the contractor. D. Seeding and mulching shall be in accordance with sections 250 and 251 of the IDOT standard specifications. Seed mixture shall be Class 1 or as noted on the plan, or in specifications. SUBMITTALS A. 1.3 Erosion and Sediment Control Plan a. Submit erosion and sediment control drawings specific to the site within ten (10) days of Notice To Proceed (NTP). Show locations, types and details of erosion and sediment control features and construction. b. Show the schedule of implementation coordinated with the construction schedule. c. Include a narrative describing the program and maintenance. QUALITY ASSURANCE A. Requirements: Create and implement an Erosion and Sedimentation Control Plan that conforms to the erosion and sedimentation requirements of the 2003 EPA Construction General Permit OR local erosion and sedimentation control standards and codes, whichever is more stringent. The Construction General Permit (CGP) outlines the provisions necessary to comply with Phase I and Phase II of the National Pollutant Discharge Elimination System (NPDES) program. B. OBJECTIVES: 1. Prevent loss of soil during construction by storm water runoff and/or wind erosion, including protecting stock pits for reuse. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA EROSION CONTROL 02270-1 2. Prevent sedimentation of storm sewer or receiving streams. 3. Prevent polluting the air with dust and particulate matter. PART 2 - PRODUCTS 2.1 MATERIALS A. All materials shall be in accordance of Section 250.02, 251.02 and 280.02 of Illinois Department of Transportation (IDOT) Standard Specifications for Road and Bridge Construction (SSRBC), adopted January 1, 2012. B. Unless soil erosion control items are specifically referred to as bid items (such as topsoil respread, seeding, etc.), they are to be considered as incidental to the cost of the contract. C. Upon completion of topsoil respread operations, all disturbed areas shall be seeded, sodded, or landscaped as noted on the plan. PART 3 - EXECUTION 3.1 GENERAL A. Streets adjacent to the site shall be kept free of dirt, mud and debris. B. No sediment shall be allowed to enter the existing storm sewer system. C. Silt Fence must be installed in accordance with the Illinois Urban Manual where erosion would occur in the form of sheet flow and there is no concentration of water flowing to the barrier. Silt Fence must be placed as close to the contour as possible with the ends extending upslope. The area below the fence if possible, must be undisturbed or stabilized. Fence posts must be a minimum of 48 inches long and with a minimum cross sectional area of 3.0 square inches. The maximum spacing between posts must be 5 feet and driven a minimum of 18 inches into ground. The silt fence must be entrenched to a minimum depth of 6 inches with an additional 6 inches extending along the bottom of the trench in the upslope direction. D. In accordance with these construction plans, erosion control measures shall be installed and maintained around storm sewer structures, in swale areas or along property lines until vegetation is established and/or construction is complete. E. Topsoil stockpiles shall be located to avoid erosion of said stockpile onto offsite areas i.e. the stockpile shall be located so that an onsite drainage swale is between the stockpile and the downstream offsite property. If a stockpile is to remain in place for more than 15 days, it is required that the stockpile be seeded so as to minimize soil erosion by both wind and water. F. All storm sewers, catch basins, inlets, manholes, sumps and/or detention basins provided within this project are to be cleaned at the end of construction of the project and prior to final acceptance. Cleaning may also be required during the course of the construction of Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA EROSION CONTROL 02270-2 the project if it is determined that the silt and debris traps are not properly functioning and their performance is impaired. G. 3.2 SEQUENCE FOR SOIL EROSION CONTROL ITEMS A. Contractor is responsible for the installation, maintenance and necessary corrective actions associated with the erosion control measures as required. Contractor shall make provisions for erosion control as indicated below. B. Mass Grading/Earthwork: C. 3.3 Stabilized construction entrance for mud and dust control shall be established at the onset of construction activity and shall be maintained throughout the course of the project. The construction entrance shall be located generally as shown on the plans, or at any other points where construction traffic frequently leaves the public roadway to enter the site. The stabilized construction entrance shall be typically 30 feet wide (with a minimum width of 14 feet), 50 feet long and shall consist of a 6” thick minimum layer of 2” angular crushed aggregate (IDOT gradation CA-1, CA-2, CA-3, or CA-4) compacted in place, underlain with a geotextile filter fabric. 1. Provide construction entrance and silt fence prior to the start of construction. 2. Provide diversion swales around site perimeter (which are part of overall grading plan) as necessary to prevent /intercept storm water runoff to offsite areas. As part of initial mass grade improvements. 3. Over-excavate proposed temporary siltation basins as necessary for settling/siltation area. 4. Over-excavate around proposed yard inlets. 5. Provide diversion ditch/topsoil berm in accordance with temporary topsoil stockpile detail for all stockpiles prior to placement of materials in said stockpile. UNDERGROUND 1. Provide straw bales, siltation/debris collection “channel”, synthetic filter fabric, etc., around all yard/detention basin inlets immediately upon installation of said inlets. 2. Provide cleaning of storm sewer system, catch basins, and storm sewer structures in accordance with this soil erosion control specifications. 3. Provide filter fabric or Inlet filters at all inlets, catch basins and sewer manholes during construction. Fabric to be placed between grate and cast iron frame to allow maintenance or replacement of fabric by removing grate with frame to remain in place. The filter fabric to be maintained until end of construction. GENERAL CLEAN-UP A. Contractor shall remove all the temporary erosion control items at the end of the construction. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA EROSION CONTROL 02270-3 END OF SECTION 02270 Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA EROSION CONTROL 02270-4 SECTION 02300 EXCAVATION AND EARTHWORK PART 1 - GENERAL 1.1 RELATED DOCUMENTS A. Drawings B. Book 1: Project Information, Instructions to Bidders, and Execution Documents C. Geotechnical Investigation Report – O’Brien & Associates, Inc. Consulting Engineers dated February 5, 2013. D. Environmental Report – Terracon Consultants Inc., Chicago Park District Park No. 569DFA, 1352-1358 W. Monroe St., Chicago, IL, dated February 27, 2013. E. 1.2 SUMMARY A. 1.3 Specifications Sections 02316 and 02318. Work under this section includes: 1. Remove rubble and unacceptable soils from the site. 2. Cap off and seal discontinued utility services and remove portions of lines within excavated areas. 3. 4. Excavate and remove foundations (if found). Excavate for paving and landscaping. 5. Shore and brace excavations. 6. Place and compact fills to rough grade elevations except in trenches. 7. Dewater excavations. 8. Excavate and grading for the park. SUBMITTALS A. For each off-site source of all fill materials the Contract shall submit the following: 1. For granular fill, the Contractor shall submit certification that the imported material is virgin stone imported to the site from a quarry. Additionally, the Contractor shall provide evidence that historical use of the source location does not indicate potential for the materials to have been impacted. 2. For all other soils, the Contractor shall submit laboratory analysis results and certification that the imported materials do not contain any priority pollutants or any other chemicals at levels exceeding Tier 1 residential soil remediation objectives (SROs). Additionally, the Contractor shall provide evidence that historical use of the source location does not indicate potential for the materials to have been impacted. Source materials must be sampled prior to source approval and every 1,000 cubic yards thereafter. Sample analyses required for Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA EXCAVATION AND EARTHWORK 02300-1 each sample include a) volatile organic compounds (VOCs); (b) semivolatile organic compounds (SVOCs); (c) pesticides; (d) polychlorinated biphenyls; (e) Target Analyte List (TAL) inorganic constituents; and (f) pH. The analytical results shall be performed to meet the approved IEPA method detection limits for each chemical under 35 IAC 742. 3. 1.4 B. Submit test reports of each type of fill to the Owner. Testing of each fill is to be done in a Independent Testing Laboratory paid for by the Contractor. 10 lb. samples of each type of fill material to be used for testing must be packed tightly in containers to prevent contamination. C. Test results shall clearly indicate material types, composition, hardness, compactability and suitability for proposed usage. D. Submit drawings and calculation for shoring, bracing or under pinning required on the project. System design, data and calculations shall be prepared and sealed by a Structural Engineer licensed in the State of Illinois. E. Submit Earthwork surveys as specified in 3.15. A of this document. REFERENCES A. 1.5 For all source locations, regardless of material type, Contractor shall submit the source location and information for approval. The submittal shall include: the exact location of the source site; the source use and past uses; current source site ownership and the contact person (with address and phone number (s)); the soil classification of the soil or fill from the source site (for each “homogeneous volume” encountered at the source site); the pre-qualification results and database search for the source site, the source site visit notes and observations, the amount of import soil or fill delivered from the source site. If recognized environmental conditions or potential contamination sources are identified, a historical report (including environmental database searches) should be provided to determine whether the potential location is a suitable source. Specified references, or cited portions thereof, current at date of bidding documents, govern the work. 1. ASTM D1557: 1978, "Methods for Moisture-Density Relations of Soils and Soil Aggregate Mixtures Using 10 lb. Rammer and 18 in. Drop." 2. ASTM D 2487: 1985, "Standard Test Method for Classification of soils for Engineering Purposes." 3. Illinois Department of Transportation (IDOT), "Standard Specification for Road and Bridge Construction"(SSRBC), latest edition, including all addenda. QUALITY CONTROL TESTING A. All off-site materials for backfill shall be tested in the laboratory at contractor’s expense and submit the testing report to the Owner before delivering the fill material at site. B. Site Compaction Testing 1. Testing of compacted fill materials will be performed by an independent Testing Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA EXCAVATION AND EARTHWORK 02300-2 Laboratory employed and paid for by the Contractor. Testing will be performed in a manner to least encumber performance of work. 1.6 C. When work or portions of work are completed, notify Testing Laboratory to perform density tests. Do not proceed with additional portions of work until satisfactory results have been verified in writing. D. When, during progress of work, tests indicated that compacted materials do not meet specifications, remove defective work, replace and retest, as directed in writing by Testing Laboratory at no additional cost to the owner. E. Ensure that all compacted fills are tested before proceeding with placement of surface materials. PROTECTION A. Protect benchmarks, existing structures, roads, sidewalks, paving and curbs against damage from equipment and vehicular or foot traffic. B. Protect excavations by shoring, bracing, sheet piling, underpinning or other methods, to prevent cave-ins or loose dirt from falling into excavations. C. Protect bottom of excavations and soil around and beneath foundations from frost. D. Grade around excavations to prevent surface water run-off penetrating into excavated areas. E. Subgrade shall be free from roots, rocks larger than three inches in size, and building debris. F. Fill under landscaped areas: Free from alkali, salt, petroleum products. PART 2 - PRODUCTS 2.1 MATERIALS A. Any soil materials imported to the site (not originating from within the site boundaries) shall not contain contaminant values above those listed in APPENDIX B, SECTION 742, TABLE A; TIERED APPROACH TO CORRECTIVE ACTION OBJECTIVES (TACO): 35 ILL. ADM. CODE 742. B. Granular Fill type A: 1. Material for backfill over water line shall be CA-16 in compliance with IDOT’s SSRBC 2012, section 1004 unless noted otherwise. The material shall conform to the following gradations: Sieve Size 1/2 inch 3/8 inch No. 4 Percent Passing 100 94-100 15-45 No. 16 0-4 Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA EXCAVATION AND EARTHWORK 02300-3 3. Drainage fill used as storage medium and as a base course below turf and pea gravel shall be CA-7 in compliance with IDOT’s SSRBC 2012, section 1004 unless noted otherwise. The material shall conform to the following gradations: Sieve Size 1 1/2 inch 1 inch 1/2 inch No. 4 4. Material for granular fill under structural slabs, roads and pavement shall be CA-6 in compliance with IDOT 2012, section 1004, unless noted otherwise. The material shall be graded from coarse to fine and shall conform to the following gradations: Sieve Size 1 1/2 inch 1 inch 1/2 inch No. 4 No. 16 No. 200 D. Percent Passing 100 90-100 30-60 0-10 Percent Passing 100 90-100 60-90 30-56 10-40 4-12 Bedding Material: 1. Material for bedding in soft spots of subgrade shall be CA-1 in compliance with Section 1004 of SSRBC and shall conform to the following gradations: Sieve Size 3 inch 2 ½ inch 2 inch 1 ½ inch 1 inch 2. Percent Passing 100 90 - 100 45 – 75 0 - 30 0–6 Bedding material for storm sewers and sanitary pipes shall be CA-11 in compliance with IDOT’s SSRBC 2012, section 1004 unless noted otherwise. The material shall conform to the following gradations: Sieve Size 1 inch 3/4 inch 1/2 inch Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA Percent Passing 100 84-100 30-60 EXCAVATION AND EARTHWORK 02300-4 No. 4 No. 16 2. 0-12 0-6 Material for bedding over water line and below permeable pavers shall be CA-16 in compliance with IDOT’s SSRBC 2012, section 1004 unless noted otherwise. The material shall conform to the following gradations: Sieve Size 1/2 inch 3/8 inch No. 4 Percent Passing 100 94-100 15-45 No. 16 0-4 PART 3 - EXECUTION 3.1 3.2 3.3 PREPARATION AND LAYOUT A. Establish extent of excavated area by area and elevation. Designate and identify data elevation. B. Set specified lines and levels. C. Maintain benchmarks, monuments and other reference points. UTILITIES A. Before starting excavation, establish location and extent of underground utilities occurring in work area. B. Notify utility companies and relocate lines, which are in the way of excavation. C. Maintain, reroute or extend existing utility lines to remain which pass through work area. The Contractor shall pay for the cost of this work, except work performed by utility companies. D. Protect utility services uncovered by excavation. E. Remove abandoned utility service lines from area of excavation; cap, plug or seal such lines and identify at grade. F. Accurately locate and record abandoned and active utility lines rerouted or extended, on Project Record Documents. EXCAVATION A. Excavation around trees shall be as specified in Section 02900 Landscaping. B. Excavate subsoil in accord with lines and levels established for the work, including space for forms, bracing and shoring, waterproofing and to permit inspection. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA EXCAVATION AND EARTHWORK 02300-5 3.4 C. Hand trim excavations and leave free from loose or organic matter. D. When complete, the Owner’s Independent Testing Laboratory will verify soil bearing capacities, depths and dimensions. E. Correct unauthorized excavation in accord with Owner’s written directions at no additional cost to the owner. F. Fill over excavated areas under structure bearing surfaces with granular fill type A. Compact in accordance with 3.11. G. Excavations shall not interfere with normal 45 degree angle of repose of any foundation. H. Remove excess or unsuitable excavated subsoil from site. STABILITY OF EXCAVATIONS A. 3.5 DEWATERING A. 3.6 3.7 Slope sides, walls or faces of all open excavations and trenches. Maintain the slopes in a safe manner and in the required conditions until completion of backfilling. Excavations shall be braced or sloped in compliance to the latest Occupational Safety, Health Administration (OSHA) requirements, other related requirements from the City. Provide dewatering system components wherever necessary in accordance with Section 02240 Dewatering. STORAGE OF EXCAVATED MATERIALS A. Stockpile excavated materials in area designated by Owner. Place, grade, and shape stockpiles for proper drainage. B. Locate and retain soil materials away from edge of excavations. C. Dispose of excess excavated soil material and materials not acceptable as backfill in accordance with Section 02316. EXCAVATION FOR PAVEMENTS A. Cut or fill surface under pavements to comply with cross-sections, elevations and grades as indicated on the drawings. 3.8 COLD WEATHER PROTECTION A. Protect excavation bottoms against freezing when atmospheric temperature is less than 35 F. 3.9 BACKFILLING A. Ensure areas to be backfilled are free from debris, snow, ice and water, and that ground surfaces are not frozen. B. Do not backfill over existing subgrade surfaces that are porous, wet or spongy. C. Compact existing subgrade surfaces when densities, determined by testing laboratory, Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA EXCAVATION AND EARTHWORK 02300-6 are not equal to that specified for backfill material. 3.10 D. Cut out soft areas of existing subgrade. Backfill with CA-1 and compact to specified density. E. Backfill areas to grade, contours, levels and elevations shown. F. Backfill symmetrically and as early as possible to allow maximum time for natural settlement and compaction. G. Place and compact fill materials in continuous layers not to exceed limits specified in 3.10. H. Maintain optimum moisture content of backfill materials to attain specified compaction density. I. Backfill simultaneously on each side of foundation walls to equalize soil pressures. Do not backfill against foundation walls until the main floor is in place. FILL TYPES AND COMPACTION A. Compact all fill and backfill to specified values based on ASTM D 1557 Modified Proctor Test. B. Existing Ground in Place: Area/Condition 1. Overlot - Landscaped areas 2. Pavements, floor slabs: a. C. Percent of Compaction 85% Less than 2 ft. below subgrade 95% Backfill Materials: Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA EXCAVATION AND EARTHWORK 02300-7 Area/Condition Fill Type 1. Pavements, roads parking lots, sidewalks, and other exterior concrete slabs. a. Top 24 in. under pavements 3. D. 3.11 Percent of Compaction 8 in. 95% 12 in. 95% b. 24 in. and more below pavement c. 5 in. and more below pavement with 6 in. permeable pavers 95% Trenches: a. Under slabs: 1) Top 8 in. under slab 2) 8 in. and more below slab 8 in. 12 in. 95% 95% b. Cross lot landscaping 12 in. 85% Moisture content: Not less than 2% below optimum moisture content determined in accord with: 1. Modified Proctor Test: ASTM D1557 or AASHTO T-I8.0. PLACEMENT OF BACKFILL AND FILL MATERIALS A. Place backfill as per schedule 3.10, within the construction limits, to the elevations, slopes, and shapes indicated. 1. B. 3.12 Max. Loose Lift Do not place the above listed materials until the Owner's Testing Laboratory representative has approved the materials and verified that the sub grade is in a suitable condition. Backfill and fill to the elevations, slopes, and shapes indicated, promptly upon receiving authorization. COMPACTION OF BACKFILL AND FILL MATERIALS A. Under Roadways, and Paved Areas: Upon removal of topsoil and in-situ unsuitable soil, proof roll in order to locate any soft or unsuitable soil zones within the areas under pavements and structures. The minimum requirements for proof rolling procedure shall consist of a fully loaded tandem axle truck with at least 25 tons gross weight being driven across the site under the observation of the Owner's testing agency representative. All soils displaying excessive deflection or rutting shall be undercut and. replaced with a suitable material to the satisfaction of owner’s testing agency representative. The suitable excavated material or off-site borrow material shall be placed in 8 inch loose lifts under roads and pavement and compacted to a minimum of 95 percent of the maximum density in accordance with ASTM D 1557. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA EXCAVATION AND EARTHWORK 02300-8 3.13 3.14 MAINTENANCE A. Protection of Areas of Excavation: Protect newly excavated areas from traffic and erosion. B. Reconditioning Compacted Areas: Where completed compacted areas are disturbed by any construction activity, re compact to required density. As Built surveys A. Earthwork Surveys: Employ a surveyor licensed in the State of IL to take readings to perform the following: 1. BOTTOM OF EXCAVATION AS-BUILT SURVEY a. b. c. d. e. f. g. 2. Provide a bottom of excavation as-built survey with a maximum grid spacing of 25 feet for all soil remediation, soil undercuts, and foundation removal. Clearly delineate the perimeter, corners, and elevations of all locations in which foundations were removed and where authorized undercut areas were excavated. Survey to include spot elevations along perimeter and corners of the property lines/project boundary lines. Provide dimensions from property lines to benchmarks and to all undercut areas and excavation areas. Provide length and width dimensions for all undercut areas and excavation areas. Submit one (1) electronic copy in PDF format and three (3) full size hard copies, stamped by a Professional Land Surveyor, within 7 business days of completion of all demolition / excavation / export operations. For projects with construction durations greater than 30 calendar days, submit one (1) electronic copy in PDF format monthly from construction start date to substantial completion date. Top of Compacted BackFill and Fill As-built Survey a. b. c. d. e. f. Provide a top of compacted backfill and fill as-built survey with a maximum grid spacing of 25 feet for all soil remediation, soil undercuts, and foundation removal. Clearly delineate the perimeter, corners, and elevations of all locations in which foundations were removed and where authorized undercut areas were excavated. Survey to include spot elevations along perimeter and corners of the property lines/project boundary lines. Provide dimensions from property lines to benchmarks and to all undercut areas and excavation areas. Provide length and width dimensions for all undercut areas and excavation areas. Submit one (1) electronic copy in PDF format and three (3) full size hard copies, stamped by a Professional Land Surveyor, within 7 business days Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA EXCAVATION AND EARTHWORK 02300-9 g. of completion of all demolition / excavation / export operations. For projects with construction durations greater than 30 calendar days, submit one (1) electronic copy in PDF format monthly from construction start date to substantial completion date. END OF SECTION 02300 Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA EXCAVATION AND EARTHWORK 02300-10 SECTION 02310 SITE GRADING PART 1 - GENERAL 1.1 RELATED DOCUMENTS A. B. C. 1.2 SUMMARY A. 1.3 Drawings Sections 02316 and 02318 Book 1: Project Information, Instructions to Bidders, and Execution Documents Work included: Cutting, filling, compacting, and grading the site to the elevations shown on the Contract Documents, as specified herein, and as needed to meet the requirements of the construction shown on the Contract Documents including but not necessarily limited to: 1. Cut and fill to new elevations. 2. Removal of unsuitable material. 3. Compaction of fills. QUALITY ASSURANCE A. Use adequate number of skilled workmen who are thoroughly trained and experienced in the necessary crafts and who are completely familiar with the specified requirements and the methods needed for proper performance of the work of this Section. B. Use equipment adequate in size, capacity, and numbers to accomplish the work in a timely manner. C. Comply with requirements of governmental agencies having jurisdiction. PART 2 - PRODUCTS 2.1 SOIL MATERIALS A. Fill and backfill materials: 1. Refer to Section 02300 and Section 02222, for fill and backfill materials. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA SITE GRADING 02310-1 PART 3 - EXECUTION 3.1 SURFACE CONDITIONS A. 3.2 SUBGRADE PREPARATION A. 3.3 Prepare subgrade in accordance with IDOT Specification, Section 212, and Articles 212.01 through 212.06. FINISH ELEVATIONS AND LINES A. 3.4 Examine the areas and conditions under which work of this Section will be performed. Correct conditions detrimental to timely and proper completion of the Work. Do not proceed until unsatisfactory conditions are corrected. Comply with proposed spot elevations and proposed contour information provided in contract documents. PROCEDURES A. B. Utilities: 1. Unless shown to be removed, protect active utility lines shown on the Contract Documents or otherwise made known to the Contractor prior to excavating. If damaged, repair or replace at no additional cost to the Owner. 2. If active utility lines are encountered, and are not shown on the Contract Documents or otherwise made known to the Contractor, promptly take necessary steps by supporting and bracing the Utility and assuring that service is not interrupted. 3. If service is interrupted as a result of work under this Section, immediately restore service by repairing the damaged utility at no additional cost to the Owner. 4. If existing utilities are found to interfere with the permanent facilities being constructed under this Section, immediately notify the Owner. 5. Do not proceed with permanent relocation of utilities until written information received from Owner. Protection of persons and property: 1. C. As required for debris, excavations, dust, noise etc. Dewatering: 1. 2. Remove all water, including rain water, encountered during trench and substructure work in accordance with Section 02240 – Dewatering. Keep excavations and site construction area free from water. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA SITE GRADING 02310-2 3.5 3.6 EXCAVATING A. Perform excavating of every type of material encountered within the limits of the Work to the lines, grades, and elevations indicated and specified herein. B. Excavate and backfill in a manner and sequence that will provide proper drainage at all times. FILLING AND BACKFILLING A. B. Backfill excavations as promptly as progress of the Work permits, but not until: 1. Acceptance of construction below finish grade. 2. Inspecting, testing, approving, and recording locations of underground utilities; 3. Concrete formwork is removed; 4. Trash and debris have been removed Ground surface preparation: 1. C. 3.7 Remove vegetation, debris, unsatisfactory soil materials, obstructions, and deleterious materials from the ground surface prior to placement of fills. Placing and compacting: 1. Place backfill and fill materials in layers not more than 8" in loose depth. 2. Do not place backfill or fill material on surfaces that are muddy, frozen, or containing frost or ice. 3. Place backfill and fill materials evenly adjacent to structures by carrying the material uniformly around the structures to approximately the same elevation in each lift. GRADING A. General: 1. Uniformly grade the areas within limits of grading under this Section, including adjacent transition areas. 2. Smooth the finished surfaces within specified tolerance. 3. Compact with uniform levels or slopes between points where elevations are shown on the Drawings, or between such points and existing grades. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA SITE GRADING 02310-3 3.8 COMPACTING A. Control soil compaction during construction to provide the minimum percentage of density specified for each area as determined according to ASTM D1557. B. Provide not less than the following maximum density of soil material compacted at optimum moisture content for the actual density of each layer of soil material in place. 1. 2. Lawn and unpaved areas: a. Compact the top 8" of subgrade and each layer of fill material or backfill material at 95% of maximum density; b. Compact the upper 12" of filled areas, or natural soils exposed by excavating, at 95% of maximum density. Walks: a. C. 3.9 Compact the top 8" of subgrade and each layer of fill material or backfill material at 95% of maximum density. Moisture control: 1. Where subgrade or layer of soil material must be moisture-conditioned before compacting, uniformly apply water to surface of subgrade or layer of soil material to prevent free water appearing on surface during or subsequent to compacting operations. 2. Remove and replace, or scarify and air dry, soil material that is too wet to permit compacting to the specified density. 3. Soil material that has been removed because it is too wet to permit compacting may be stockpiled or spread and allowed to dry. Assist drying by discing, harrowing, or pulverizing until moisture content is reduced to a satisfactory value as determined by moisture-density relation tests, described in ASTM D 2922 and ASTM D 3017. The tests are to be conducted by an independent testing laboratory to be employed by the Owner. MAINTENANCE A. Protection of newly graded areas: 1. Protect newly graded areas from traffic and erosion, and keep free from trash and weeds; 2. Repair and reestablish grades in settled, eroded, and rutted areas to the specified tolerances. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA SITE GRADING 02310-4 B. Where completed compacted areas are disturbed by subsequent construction operations or adverse weather, scarify the surface, reshape, and compact to the required density prior to further construction. END OF SECTION 02310 Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA SITE GRADING 02310-5 SECTION 02316 SOIL HANDLING AND MANAGEMENT PART 1 - GENERAL 1.1 A. SUMMARY Work included: This specification is for the excavation, stockpiling, permitting, loading, hauling, importing, exporting and disposal of materials according to the scope of work or as directed by the Owner’s Representative. The Contractor shall perform the work under this section in accordance with all applicable local, county, Illinois EPA, U.S. EPA, and Occupational Safety and Health Administration rules and regulations, including the following: 1. Removal and disposal a. Dispose of all excess materials removed from the site in a licensed/permitted Subtitle D landfill. Soils generated from the site are classified as Non-Hazardous Non-Special waste, general construction and demolition debris. b. Collect representative soil samples from within the site and perform all required analytical testing to secure disposal permit from Subtitle D licensed/permitted disposal sites. Contractor may utilize waste characterization analysis from sample collected on behalf of Owner on 10/24/2012 (attached), but is responsible for any additional testing required. c. Prior to excavation of any soil (including non-special waste soils and non-hazardous special waste soils), fill, backfill, top soil, CU Structural Soil, and general construction and demolition debris material, obtain authorization for ultimate disposition of materials from an open and active Subtitle D facility approved by the CPD Authorized representative. The Subtitle D facility shall be permitted to accept both NonHazardous Special Waste and Special Waste. d. Obtain authorization from an open and active Permitted Subtitle D landfill indicating acceptance of materials at the facility. The Authorization must be signed by the owner of the open and active Permitted Subtitle D landfill and state that the facility complies with all local zoning codes and all local, State, and Federal rules and regulations, that all required laboratory analyses has been received by the facility, and that the facility has agreed to accept the soils (including non-special waste soils, and non-hazardous special waste soils), fill, backfill, top soil, CU Structural Soil, and general construction and demolition debris materials. The Authorization shall further state that the soils (including non-special waste soils and non-hazardous special waste soils), fill, backfill, top soil, CU Structural Soil, general construction and demolition debris materials are being accepted for permanent placement on site under the cap, and that the material will not be removed from the site unless required by a local, State or Federal Authority. e. Excavate soil to depths shown in the Architect/Engineer plans to complete the proposed construction work at the site. Contractor shall also remove contaminated soil from throughout the site, including but not limited to the landscape areas, to depths shown in the site remediation plan (R2.0). f. All excess excavated materials to be disposed should be either directly loaded into hauling trucks or temporary stockpiled for future disposal. All soil excavation and handling and management shall be coordinated with the Owner’s Representative. g. Provide copies of all daily reports, disposal tickets, weight tickets (as applicable) to the Owner’s Representative within seven (7) calendar days after removing such materials from the site. h. Complete a Site Survey showing the topography of original ground elevation, topography of bottom elevation, and topography of finished grade. The licensed Rev. 07/29/2013 Park # 569 02316 - 1 SOIL HANDLING AND MANAGEMENT i. surveyor shall measure elevations using 30-feet grid to produce data to verify the size and depth of excavation areas for each type of material excavated from the site. The Contractor shall comply with all applicable federal, state, and local laws, regulations and ordinance that govern or regulate the handling, transportation, and disposal of all excavated materials from the site. 2. Placement of backfill materials a. Contractor is to use on-site suitable and approved excavated materials as backfill only beneath engineered barriers (i.e., concrete slab or three feet of clean fill). Excess soil should be disposed at a permitted Subtitle D landfill. Refer to Remediation Plan (R2.0) for details on backfill materials and on site placement locations. b. Place and maintain a minimum three (3) feet cover consisting of imported clean fill/top soil over all areas at the site, including areas covered by landscape areas and tree planting areas, pea gravel, artificial turf or other surfaces. In areas covered by concrete, concrete plus underlying clean fill must total three (3) feet. c. Place and compact backfill materials at all excavation areas using approved materials in accordance with the Architectural/Engineering specifications. Certification and a copy of the analytical results of imported backfill materials should be provided to the owner’s representative prior to any such material being brought to the site as further discussed under Section e, below. d. The imported clean backfill materials shall not contain any chemicals that exceed the parameter values as listed in APPENDIX B, SECTION 742, TABLE A, TABLE C, and TABLE E (SPLP Results for RCRA 8 metals); TIERED APPROACH TO CORRECTIVE ACTION OBJECTIVES (TACO): 35 ILL. ADM. CODE 742. e. Provide certification and a copy of the analytical results of imported backfill materials from each source stating that the imported materials do not contain chemicals exceeding the values as listed in APPENDIX B, SECTION 742, TABLE A; TIERED APPROACH TO CORRECTIVE ACTION OBJECTIVES (TACO): 35 ILL. ADM. CODE 742 values for 35 ILL. ADM CODE 740 APPENDIX A Target Compound List (TCL) parameters, Total Petroleum Hydrocarbons (TPH-GRO+DRO), and SPLP Testing for RCRA 8 metals. For Target Compound Listed parameters known as PNAs, Appendix A TABLE H (Concentrations of Polynuclear Hydrocarbon Chemicals in background Soils) values may be used. For samples from virgin sources, if no letter certifying virgin material is received, one representative sample must be analyzed for 35 ILL. ADM CODE 740 APPENDIX A Target Compound List (TCL) parameters and SPLP Testing for RCRA 8 metals. For inorganic parameters over background values shown for metropolitan properties in Appendix A, TABLE G, SROs must additionally meet pH-Specific values provided in Appendix B, TABLE C. RCRA 8 Inorganics tested with SPLP must meet values shown for Class II groundwater in 742 Appendix B TABLE E. No recycled stone/concrete will be permitted. A copy of the analytical results shall be submitted at least one week prior to depositing backfill or top soil on site. The date of the analysis shall be within 60 days of importing such material to the project. f. Contractor shall provide one sample per material type at a rate of on sample per 1,000 tons imported. B. 1.2 Related Documents: All terms and conditions of the Contract apply to this Section. DEFINITIONS A. Agency: Illinois Environmental Protection Agency (IEPA). B. Backfill means granular or cohesive material used to fill the excavation to design grade as referenced in design plans and specifications. Rev. 07/29/2013 Park # 569 02316 - 2 SOIL HANDLING AND MANAGEMENT C. CU Structural Soil means a uniformly blended mixture of crushed stone, clay, loam and hydrogel by weight consisting of approximately 83% crushed limestone (3/4 to 1.5 inch, highly angular with limited fines), 17% clay loam and hydrogel (1 oz. per 200 pounds of stone). D. Fill means any earthen or non-earthen materials including but not limited to any sediment, granular or cohesive non-native earthen materials, cinders, ash, wood, and brick, concrete, and asphalt fragments, glass, and building debris encountered above naturally occurring undisturbed soils or bedrock in built-up areas. E. General Construction and Demolition (C&D) Debris means non-hazardous, uncontaminated materials resulting from construction, remodeling, repair, and demolition of utilities, structures, and roads as defined in Public Act 92-0574, The Environmental Protection Act, 415 ILCS 5 Section 3.160 and regulated under Title 35: Environmental Protection; Subtitle G: Waste Disposal; Chapter I: Pollution Control Board; Subchapter i: Solid Waste and Special Waste Hauling. General Construction and demolition (C&D) debris may include soil, wall coverings, reclaimed asphalt pavement, rock, plaster, glass, non-hazardous painted wood, drywall, plastics, non-hazardous coated wood, non-asbestos insulation, bricks, wood products, roofing shingles, concrete, and general roof coverings. F. Open and active Permitted Subtitle D landfill means any open and active solid waste landfill facility in any state licensed and permitted to accept non-hazardous waste including both nonspecial waste soils and non-hazardous special waste soils, fill, general construction and demolition debris are to be deposited. If the landfill facility is located in Illinois, the landfill must be licensed/ open, active and permitted by the Illinois Environmental Protection Agency and other applicable local regulatory agencies as applicable. If the landfill is located outside of Illinois, the landfill facility must be open, active and permitted by applicable state and local regulatory agencies. G. Owner: Chicago Park District. H. CDL: Commercial Driver’s License. I. CFR: Code of Federal Regulations. J. Licensed Disposal Facility: means any landfill licensed/permitted by Illinois EPA, US. EPA, other states approving agencies, or local government agencies to accept non-hazardous special waste, or general construction and demolition debris. Non-Hazardous special waste shall be disposed of at only state permitted facilities authorized to accept Non-Hazardous Special Waste licensed pursuant to Subtitle D of RCRA. K. Owner’s Representative: means the entity that will perform oversight on the behalf of the Owner. Contractor shall coordinate all soil excavation and placement remediation activities with the Owner’s Representative. L. Hazardous Waste means a waste, or combination of wastes, which has been identified by characteristics or listing as hazardous pursuant to Section 3001 of the Resource Conservation and Recovery Act of 1976, P.L. 94-580, 40 CFR part 261, Illinois Environmental protection Act 415 ILCS 5/3.220, and Section 809.103 of Title 35: Environmental Protection; Subtitle G: Waste Disposal; Chapter I: Pollution Control Board. A waste is classified as hazardous if it exhibits any of the following characteristics: 1) ignitability, 2) corrosivity, 3) reactivity, or 4) toxicity, and as defined in Illinois Administrative Code Title 35, Section 721.103 (35 IAC 721.103). M. IDOT: Illinois Department of Transportation. Rev. 07/29/2013 Park # 569 02316 - 3 SOIL HANDLING AND MANAGEMENT N. Manifest: means the form provided or prescribed by IEPA and used for identifying name, quality, routing, and destination of special waste, non-hazardous and hazardous waste during its transportation from point of generation to the point of disposal, treatment, or storage. O. MWRDGC: Metropolitan Water Reclamation District of Greater Chicago P. OSHA: Occupational Safety and Health Administration. Q. RCRA 8: Resource Conservation Recovery Act (RCRA) 8 metals: Arsenic, Barium, Cadmium, Chromium, Lead, Mercury, Selenium, Silver R. Remediation Area: Areas on the site where underground storage tanks, or contaminated soil is present as shown in the Remediation Plan. S. SROs: Soil remediation objectives for various exposure routes identified in 35 Illinois Administrative Code 742: Tiered Approach To Corrective Action Objectives (TACO), or site specific approved by the Illinois EPA. T. SPLP: Synthetic Precipitation Leaching Procedure (EPA Method 1312) U. TACO: 35 Illinois Administrative Code 742: TIERED APPROACH TO CORRECTIVE ACTION OBJECTIVES (TACO). V. Tier 1 SROs: Means Tier 1 SROs for the most restrictive values for residential properties use as listed in PART 742, APPENDIX B, TABLE A; TIERED APPROACH TO CORRECTIVE ACTION OBJECTIVES (TACO): 35 ILL. ADM. CODE 742. For inorganic parameters over background values shown for metropolitan properties in Appendix A, TABLE G, SROs must additionally meet pH-Specific values provided in Appendix B, Table C. RCRA 8 Inorganics tested with SPLP must meet values shown for Class II groundwater in 742 Appendix B TABLE E. W. USEPA - United States Environmental Protection Agency. 1.3 SITE ASSESSMENT The site is currently enrolled in the Site Remediation Program (SRP) in order to obtain an NFR Letter. Several environmental site assessments and a site investigation have been completed at the site. The following is a summary of the site environmental investigation findings: A. Phase I ESA (December 2012): Terracon Consultants, Inc. (Terracon) performed A Phase I Environmental Site Assessment (ESA). Recognized Environmental Conditions (RECs) identified in the Phase I ESA include the following: Identified impacts found in samples collected during the removal of a heating oil Underground Storage Tank (UST); and associated open LUST incident; The potential for impacts from the past and present operation of a UST on the east adjoining property; Documented on-site urban fill material. B. Comprehensive Site Investigation (CSI/ROR/RAP (March 2013) – The CSI by Terracon included soil sampling activities at the Site on October 2012. The CSI was performed to characterize the extent of the contaminants of concern detected in prior UST release and Recognized Environmental Concerns (RECs) identified in the Phase I ESA as required by the IEPA, IAC Title 35, Part 740. The sampling plan consisted of advancing twelve soil borings and installing three temporary monitoring wells. Several PNA constituents, Lead, and Arsenic Rev. 07/29/2013 Park # 569 02316 - 4 SOIL HANDLING AND MANAGEMENT exceeded the Tier 1 SROs. The LUST incident (20101033) was recorded during the removal of the heating oil tank in 2010 that was formerly located in the south-central portion of the site. The LUST incident is planned for closure within the SRP. The available Laboratory Data is included as an Attachment to this section. The Contractor shall coordinate with the Owner to obtain copies of the above reports. The contractor shall be responsible for reviewing all above reports and understanding all data associated with these reports. 1.4 SUBMITTALS A. Copies of the following submittals shall be prepared and submitted to the Owner’s Representative at Contractor’s own cost: 1. Contractor’s Site Specific Health and Safety Plan for all workers engaged in construction activities in the vicinity of contaminated soils above the IEPA Soil Remediation Objectives (SROs) for Construction Workers. The plan shall comply with all OSHA requirements. The plan should at a minimum include the following: a. Name of key personnel and alternates responsible for site safety. b. Describe the risks associated with each operation conducted. c. Type of personnel training and responsibilities and to handle the specific hazardous situations they may encounter. d. Describe the protective clothing and equipment to be worn by personnel during various site operations. e. Describe any site specific medical surveillance requirements. f. Describe the program for the periodic air monitoring, personnel monitoring, and environmental sampling if needed. g. Describe the actions to be taken to mitigate existing hazards to make the work environment less hazardous. h. Define site control measures including a site map. i. Establish procedures for personnel and equipment and transporting trucks to ensure that impacted soils are not tracked off site on to non impacted areas of the site. j. Set forth the site Standard Operating Procedures (SOPs). SOPs are those activities that can be standardized (i.e., decontamination procedures and respirator fit testing). k. Set forth a Contingency Plan for the safe and effective response to emergencies. 2. Proof of OSHA training in compliance with the Hazardous Waste Operations and Emergency Response Standard (29 CFR 1910.120) for applicable workers. 3. Soil Management Plan outlining proposed excavation work sequences and soil handling and management procedures. The Soil Management Plan shall show the locations of each type of material to be stored on site and the materials to be stored at the site for reuse, and location of material to be stored on site for future disposal. 4. Decontamination Plan outlining procedures and list of equipment for decontamination of personnel, materials and equipment employed in performing remediation work at the site. Decontamination Plan outlining decontamination procedures, dust control, and mud cleaning from all field equipment and trucks prior to leaving the site. 5. Storm Water Management Plan - prior to commencing work, the contractor shall provide a Storm Water Management Plan stipulating provisions for dewatering, pumping, collection, temporary storage, and discharge or disposal of storm water, perched water and other liquids, contaminated and/or uncontaminated, at the site so as to facilitate soil removal and minimize disposal costs of contaminated fluids. The plan should include list of permits to be secured for the disposal of water accumulated/collected during site excavation activities. The Plan should also include provisions for control rainwater run-off from entering excavation areas. This may include, but not limited to, surface grading, pumping and/or combination of silt fence, sandbags, tarpaulins, plastic sheeting, and movable straw bales. 6. Copies of analytical results for each waste stream to be removed from the site as applicable. Rev. 07/29/2013 Park # 569 02316 - 5 SOIL HANDLING AND MANAGEMENT 7. 8. 9. 10. 11. 12. The name and address and telephone number of the laboratory that will be used by the Contractor to perform analytical testing for waste stream authorization. Name, address, and telephone number of the licensed/permitted disposal sites where contaminated soil will be disposed of. This submittal must be made prior to removal of any materials from the site. This information should include, at a minimum, the following: a. Facility Name and Address and Telephone Number. b. Site Contact. c. Facility Identification Number issued by Illinois, U.S. EPA, or other state licensing agencies for site outside Illinois Copies for special waste hauler licenses. A copy of the license shall be maintained in all trucks leaving the site at all times. Copies of all daily reports, transport manifests, weight tickets and disposal receipts to the Construction Manager and/or Project Manager on a daily basis. Any air sampling data collected during the course of the Work, including OSHA compliance air monitoring, if needed. Prior to importing any backfill to the site, provide copies of analytical results of for each source of backfill materials verifying that the backfill does not exceed the values listed in APPENDIX B, SECTION 742, TABLE A; TIERED APPROACH TO CORRECTIVE ACTION OBJECTIVES (TACO): 35 ILL. ADM. CODE 742 values for 35 ILL. ADM CODE 740 APPENDIX A Target Compound List (TCL) parameters, Total Petroleum Hydrocarbons (TPH-GRO+DRO), and SPLP Testing for RCRA 8 metals. For Target Compound Listed parameters known as PNAs, Appendix A TABLE H (Concentrations of Polynuclear Hydrocarbon Chemicals in background Soils) values may be used. For samples from virgin sources, if no letter certifying virgin material is received, one representative sample must be analyzed for 35 ILL. ADM CODE 740 APPENDIX A Target Compound List (TCL) parameters and SPLP Testing for RCRA 8 metals. For inorganic parameters over background values shown for metropolitan properties in Appendix A, TABLE G, SROs must additionally meet pH-Specific values provided in Appendix B, TABLE C. RCRA 8 Inorganics tested with SPLP must meet values shown for Class II groundwater in 742 Appendix B TABLE E. No recycled stone/concrete will be permitted. A copy of the analytical results shall be submitted at least one week prior to depositing backfill or top soil on site. The date of the analysis shall be within 60 days of importing such material to the project. Contractor shall provide one sample per material type at a rate of on sample per 1,000 tons imported. B. Submittal Review: Review of submittals or any comments made does not relieve the Contractor from compliance with the requirements of the drawings and specifications. The purpose of this check is to review for general conformance with the design concept of the project and general compliance with the information given in the contract documents. The Contractor is responsible for confirming and correlating all quantities and dimensions, electing techniques of construction, coordinating the Work, and performing the Work in a safe and satisfactory manner. 1.5 NOTIFICATIONS A. The Contractor shall notify the owner/owner’s representative, in writing, not less than forty-eight (48) hours prior to excavating, loading, and transporting any materials from the site. PART 2 – PRODUCTS 2.1 CONTAMINATED SOIL REMOVAL A. The Contractor shall furnish all necessary means, products, tools, personal protective equipment, and equipment required to remove contaminated soil from the site. Rev. 07/29/2013 Park # 569 02316 - 6 SOIL HANDLING AND MANAGEMENT PART 3 – EXECUTION 3.0 MATERIAL SAMPLING A 3.1 The Contractor shall collect sufficient amount of representative sample(s) from the materials require removal from the site for analytical testing to obtaining waste stream authorization from a licensed/permitted disposal sites. The contractor is responsible for acquisition of any required permits and payment of all required fees. AUTHORIZATIONS A. Obtain authorization from a Subtitle D landfill for the disposal of access stockpiled soils and other excavated materials from the site. The Authorization must be signed by the property owner and shall state that the property owner has received a copy of one or more laboratory analyses of representative sample(s) collected from the site by the contractor and has agreed to accept the material. The Authorization shall further state that the site owner agrees to accept the material for permanent placement on their site and that the material will not be removed from their site unless required by a local, State or Federal Authority. The Authorization further shall state that the site complies with all local zoning codes, State, Federal and Local laws, rules, and regulations. B. Obtain authorization from the Commission’s Representative prior to performing any backfilling activities. All backfill placement and compaction requirements shall comply with the requirements of the Architectural/Engineering design plans and project specifications. C. Haulers for transportation of soils, backfill and top soil shall hold, and present upon request, a current valid Commercial Driver’s License (CDL). 3.2 EXCAVATION A Contractor shall coordinate all soil excavation and hauling from the site activities with the Owner’s Representative. The Contractor must provide a written notification to the Owner’s Representative at least 48-hour prior to starting any soil excavation or hauling from the site. B Contractor shall slope the side of excavations to comply with local codes, authorities having jurisdiction, and the City of Chicago, and maintain same. Contractor shall maintain sides and slopes of excavations in a safe condition until completion of backfilling. C Contractor shall be responsible for maintaining the structural integrity of all surrounding streets, underground utilities, buildings, and structures (walkways, sidewalks, underground tunnels, etc.). Contractor shall secure, shore, and brace where sloping is not possible either because of space restrictions or stability of material excavated. Excavations shall be braced or sloped in compliance to the latest Occupational Safety and Health Administration (OSHA) requirements. Provide materials for shoring and bracing, such as sheet piling, uprights, stringers and cross braces, in good serviceable conditions. Maintain shoring and bracing in excavations regardless of the time period excavations will remain open. Carry down shoring and bracing as the excavation progresses. D The Contractor shall excavate contaminated soil to the extent required by the proposed new construction as shown the Architectural/Engineering design drawings and specifications. The contractor shall also excavate and remove contaminated soil to the depth shown in the Remediation Plan drawing. The Contractor shall then perform the following: 1 Stockpile onsite contaminated soil which is suitable for use as backfill. Contractor shall refer to the Architect/Engineer specification for the definition of suitable backfill materials. Contaminated suitable onsite backfill soil shall be used as backfill only beneath the concrete Rev. 07/29/2013 Park # 569 02316 - 7 SOIL HANDLING AND MANAGEMENT slab and below three feet of clean fill. Excess contaminated soil shall be disposed at the approved licensed/permitted disposal facility. No contaminated soil shall be placed in areas where soil below TACO Tier 1 SROs is present. 2 Contaminated soil which will not be reused on site shall be loaded directly into hauling trucks for transportation to the approved landfill. Contaminated soil may be stored on site for a maximum of five (5) working days prior to its disposal. 3 All contaminated soil stockpiles shall be placed upon and covered by 6-mil polyethylene sheeting (visqueen) all the times. The integrity of the visqueen shall be inspected at the end of each working day and corrective measures should be implemented to ensure no portion of stockpiled soil is exposed at the end of each working day. 4 Maintain a minimum three (3) feet cover below final grade consisting of imported clean fill/top soil over all areas at the site, including areas covered by pea gravel, artificial turf or other surfaces (as indicated in Drawing No. R2.0.). In areas covered by concrete, concrete plus underlying clean fill must total three (3) feet. Place orange snow fence indicator barrier at landscape areas at 3 feet below finished grade. 5 In the proposed landscaped and tree planting areas, per the Site Remediation Plan (R2.0), the contractor shall excavate contaminated soil and construction debris to a minimum depth of three (3) feet below the proposed finished grade, and backfill with clean soil. Place orange snow fence indicator barrier at landscape areas at 3 feet below finished grade. 6 In the proposed underground utilities sewer trenching areas, the contractor shall excavate contaminated soil to a depth required by the new development. Contaminated suitable backfill materials can be used as backfill to a depth up to 3 feet below finished grade. 7 For the water main connection, excavate contaminated soil to a depth of 2 feet below the water main invert and backfill with clean fill. The width of the water main trench should be at least 4 feet larger than the pipe diameter. A minimum of 2 feet of clean fill should be placed at each side of the water main. 8 In the proposed areas covered by concrete, pea gravel, artificial turf, or tree planting areas, the contractor shall remove contaminated soil up to the extent required to complete work, but not less than 3 feet below finished elevation. E The Contractor shall be responsible for keeping the contaminated soil separated from the clean soil/materials. If the contaminated soil comes in contact with the clean soil, the Contractor shall dispose of the clean soil as contaminated soil at the Contractor’s own expense. F The Contractor shall retain the services of an independent Illinois Licensed Surveyor to record the original ground topography, the after excavation (pre- engineered barrier installation) topography and the final grade (post- engineered barrier installation) topography for the site. The Licensed Surveyor shall measure elevations using 30-feet grid to produce data to verify the size and depth of excavation areas for each type of material excavated from the site. The Licensed Surveyor shall provide a minimum of 5 survey points for each excavation area less than 30 feet long (one at each corner and one point at the center). The original ground and after excavation survey data with copies of all applicable field notes and survey readings as backup, shall be submitted to the Environmental Consultant for approval within ten (10) working days of conducting the survey. All survey data shall be sealed and signed by an Illinois Licensed Surveyor. The Contractor shall also provide an electronic copy of all topographic surveys in AutoCAD format. G The Owner’s Representative may collect soil samples for laboratory analysis or field Photoionization Detector (PID) screening, or liquid samples for laboratory analysis during site Rev. 07/29/2013 Park # 569 02316 - 8 SOIL HANDLING AND MANAGEMENT excavation activities. Contractor shall provide all necessary equipment and manpower to assist the Owner’s Representative in collecting all required samples at no additional cost to the Owner. H 3.3 If contaminated soil is discovered during excavation work in areas not identified in the Drawings, the Contractor shall stop excavation work and immediately inform the Owner’s Representative. The Owner’s Representative will assess the site conditions and instruct the Contractor how to proceed with the work. WATER MANAGEMENT A. The Contractor shall subscribe to a weather notification system and manage the work so as not to accumulate storm water on the site during excavation. B. The Contractor shall implement all measures provided in the Storm Water Management Plan to minimize the volume of water entering excavation areas. C. Storm Water Run-on /Run-off and Dewatering: If perched water/groundwater or rainwater is accumulated in excavation areas, the Contractor shall not discharge onsite water into the MWRDGC or the City of Chicago sewer without first obtaining all required permits from the City of Chicago and MWRD. This shall includes performing the followings: 1. Collect representative water samples from each excavation area. The samples should be analyzed for the chemical of concerns identified at each excavation area. 2. Obtain Water Discharge permit from the City of Chicago Water Management Department – Sewer Section if the analytical results revealed no detection of any of the chemical of concerns constituents. 3. If the water samples analytical results show presence of chemicals of concern in the water sample, Contractor shall obtain Water Discharge permit into the City of Chicago sewer system from City of Chicago Water Management – Sewer Section, and a Special Discharge permit from MWRDGC. This permit application is normally submitted to MWRDGC after the City of Chicago issued its permit to allow discharging water into the sewer. 4. If MWRDGC does not approve water discharge permit in the sewer, then no water should be discharge into the sewer even if the City of Chicago issued a permit. In this case, water should be transferred into a vacuum truck and should be discharged at a treatment facility. 3.4 DECONTAMINATION A. The Contractor shall decontaminate all heavy equipment after each use in the contaminated soil areas using steam cleaning and/or hand scrubbing methods. Run-off from the decontamination area must be prevented using polyethylene plastic sheeting and a sump system. B. The Contractor shall remove soils, dusts and rocks from the exterior of trucks, tractortrailers and other heavy equipment which are used in the contaminated soil areas prior to leaving the site. Contractor shall not allow equipment to leave with water leaking or mud dripping or caked to the equipment. Rev. 07/29/2013 Park # 569 02316 - 9 SOIL HANDLING AND MANAGEMENT 3.5 3.6 HAULING AND TRANSPORTATION A. All excavated materials shall be hauled off-site using only covered trucks. All trucks must be covered prior to leaving the site. B. Contractor shall conduct soils removal in a manner that ensures minimum interference with roads; streets, walks and other adjacent occupied and used facilities. Do not close or obstruct streets, walks or other occupied or used facilities without permission from the applicable governing agency and the Owner. Provide alternate routes around closed or obstructed traffic ways if required by the governing agency. C. The non-hazardous special waste shall be transported by a licensed hauler to transport non-hazardous special waste by the State of Illinois, and by any other state agencies if the soil is transported to other states. Hauling trucks shall maintain a copy of the transporter’s special waste hauling permit in the truck. D. Contractor shall provide and complete copies of all daily reports, weight tickets and receipts (as applicable) for transportation and ultimate off site placement of materials removed from the property to the Owner, review and signature as required. E. Contractor shall remove soils, dusts, rocks, etc. from the exterior of trucks, trailers, or other heavy equipment leaving the site before they leave the site. F. Contractor shall not create dust and shall maintain adequate dust suppression equipment on site if conditions warrant. DUST CONTROL A. The Contractor shall control dust by all necessary means, including but not limited to covering trucks, stockpiles and open materials, watering haul roads, sweeping paved roads, and limiting the speed of all on-site vehicles. B. The Contractor shall not create dust and shall maintain adequate dust suppression equipment on site if conditions warrant. C. The Contractor shall maintain streets clean and free of mud and dirt. 3.7 STOCKPILING A. Contractor may stockpile special wastes, non-hazardous special waste, or general construction and demolition debris/materials on site for a maximum of five (5) working days. The Contractor shall keep special wastes, non-hazardous special waste, or soil generated from site excavation activities, covered with 6-mil polyethylene visqueen or containerized until subsequent, placement on site, or loading, transportation and disposal. For stockpiled soils, provide a 12" to 18" berm around the stockpile. Base sheeting shall overlap the dike. B. The Contractor shall be responsible for keeping such soil (Soil above Tier 1 SROs) separated from soils/materials that are not designated as special wastes, non-hazardous special waste, or general construction and demolition debris. If said soil comes in contact with soils/materials that are not designated as special wastes or non-hazardous special waste, the Contractor shall dispose of newly contaminated soils/materials as special wastes, nonhazardous special waste, or hazardous waste soil/materials at his own expense. The Contractor will be responsible for sampling analysis costs associated with Characterization of newly contaminated soils/materials as special wastes, non-hazardous special waste, or hazardous waste soil/materials. Rev. 07/29/2013 Park # 569 02316 - 10 SOIL HANDLING AND MANAGEMENT C. The location of the stockpiles area shall be coordinated with the Owner Representative. The Contractor shall not allow runoff from stockpiled soil/materials to enter storm drains or leave the site 3.8 3.9 QUALITY CONTROL A. Visual inspections and damage repairs shall be made daily by the Contractor and/or as directed by the Owner’s Representative to assure that erosion, drainage and containment control measures are functioning properly. B. The Contractor shall take all necessary precautions to protect structures, equipment, pavement, walks, and utilities against movement or settlement during the course of work. C. Damages: Promptly replace or repair any damage caused to adjacent pavement, utilities or facilities by removal operations at no additional cost. Work shall be performed to the satisfaction of the Owner. D. Utility Services: Maintain existing utilities and protect against damage during removal operations. BACKFILL A. Prior to importing any backfill materials, Contractor shall provide the name and location of all sources to be used to import the backfill. B. For each off-site source of imported materials, including top soil, cohesive, granular and other fill materials; Contractor shall provide to the Owner’s Representative certification and IEPA-approved laboratory analyses showing that all imported materials do not exceed the values those listed in PART 742, APPENDIX B, TABLE A, TABLE C, and TABLE E (SPLP Results); TIERED APPROACH TO CORRECTIVE ACTION OBJECTIVES (TACO): 35 ILL. ADM. CODE 742. The Contractor shall collect sufficient number of conformation soil samples throughout the backfilling activities to verify that all imported soils do not exceed the TACO values. The date of the analytical results shall be within 60 days of importing such material to the site. Provide a copy of the certification prior to importing the materials to the site. C. Contractor shall coordinate with the Owner’s Representative regarding backfilling activities. If the Contractor backfills areas without obtaining approval from the Environmental Consultant, the backfill materials shall be excavated, if required, at the Contractor’s expense. D. The Owner’s Representative may collect confirmation samples of materials imported and placed at the site. Contractor will be required to remove and replace any materials found to contain chemicals exceeding the Tier 1 SROs for residential properties at the Contractor’s own expense. Rev. 07/29/2013 Park # 569 02316 - 11 SOIL HANDLING AND MANAGEMENT PART 4 - MEASUREMENT AND PAYMENT 4.1 Volume determination and pricing shall be in accordance with the contract documents. ATTACHMENTS 1. 2. 3. Tables – Soil Analytical Results Soil Borings Location Map Site Waste Characterization Laboratory Information, Collected 10/24/2012 END OF SECTION Rev. 07/29/2013 Park # 569 02316 - 12 SOIL HANDLING AND MANAGEMENT Table Notes Remediation Objectives from 35 Illinois Administrative Code Chapter 742: Tiered Approach to Corrective Action Objectives (TACO). Remediation Objectives for Non-TACO compounds from Illinois Environmental Protection Agency's (IEPA's) web site (http://www.epa.state.il.us/land/taco/chemicals-not-in-taco-tier-1-tables.html). mg/L = milligrams per liter, generally equivalent to parts per million (ppm) mg/kg = milligrams per kilogram, generally equivalent to ppm TCLP = Toxicity Characteristic Leaching Procedure SPLP = Synthetic Precipitation Leaching Procedure NA = Not analyzed for this constituent = Highlighted cells indicate exceedances of Tier 1 SRO/GRO values. Background considered SRO value for many PNA constituents. Bold = Analyte concentrations above background concentrations. Samples BP-01 through BP-05 collected on November 8, 2010 by Tecnica Environmental Services, Inc. ** Hexavalent Chromium run on this sample to evaluate highest concentration at site. SRP Tables_Skinner_Class2-GW.xlsx Page 1 of 1 Table 1 - Terracon Soil Analytical Results Proposed Skinner Park 1352 - 1358 W Monroe St, Chicago, Illinois Page 1 of 12 Sample Location/Identification Sample Depth (feet) B-102 (1-3) 1' - 3' Date Collected 10/24/2012 B-102 (4-6) 4' - 6' B-102 (8-10) 8' - 10' B-104 (1-3) 1' - 3' B-104 (8-10) 8' - 10' B-105 (1-3) 1' - 3' B-106 (1-3) 1' - 3' B-107 (1-3) 1' - 3' 10/24/2012 10/24/2012 10/24/2012 10/24/2012 10/24/2012 10/24/2012 10/24/2012 Units Chicago Soil Component of the Groundwater Ingestion Route Values Class II --------------------------------------------------------------------- 0.68 1.2 0.07 70 0.2 25 160 0.3 110 1.1 3.4 2.9 0.1 17 9.6 0.33 0.6 0.15 0.02 0.3 0.4 0.3 0.17 0.8 0.32 2.5 1.3 0.3 29 3.3 6.5 19 18 150 Tier 1 Soil Remediation Objectives for Residential Properties Construction Workers Ingestion Inhalation Ingestion Inhalation Occupants Background Volatile Organic Analytical Parameters 74-87-3 74-83-9 75-01-4 75-00-3 75-09-2 67-64-1 75-15-0 75-35-4 75-34-3 156-59-2 156-60-5 67-66-3 107-06-2 78-93-3 71-55-6 56-23-5 75-27-4 78-87-5 542-75-6 79-01-6 124-48-1 79-00-5 71-43-2 75-25-2 1634-04-4 108-10-1 591-78-6 127-18-4 108-88-3 79-34-5 108-90-7 100-41-4 100-42-5 1330-20-7 Chloromethane Bromomethane Vinyl Chloride Chloroethane Methylene Chloride Acetone Carbon Disulfide 1,1-Dichloroethene 1,1-Dichloroethane cis-1,2-Dichloroethene trans-1,2-Dichloroethene Chloroform 1,2-Dichloroethane 2-Butanone 1,1,1-Trichloroethane Carbon Tetrachloride Bromodichloromethane 1,2-Dichloropropane 1,3-Dichloropropene (cis + trans) Trichloroethene Dibromochloromethane 1,1,2-Trichloroethane Benzene Bromoform Methyl Tertiary-Butyl Ether 4-Methyl-2-pentanone 2-Hexanone Tetrachloroethene Toluene 1,1,2,2-Tetrachloroethane Chlorobenzene Ethylbenzene Styrene Xylenes (total) mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg < 0.01 < 0.01 < 0.005 < 0.01 < 0.01 < 0.075 < 0.05 < 0.005 < 0.005 < 0.005 < 0.005 < 0.005 < 0.005 < 0.075 < 0.005 < 0.005 < 0.005 < 0.005 < 0.002 < 0.005 < 0.005 < 0.005 < 0.005 < 0.005 < 0.005 < 0.02 < 0.02 < 0.005 < 0.005 < 0.005 < 0.005 < 0.005 < 0.005 < 0.015 < 0.01 < 0.01 < 0.005 < 0.01 < 0.01 < 0.075 < 0.05 < 0.005 < 0.005 < 0.005 < 0.005 < 0.005 < 0.005 < 0.075 < 0.005 < 0.005 < 0.005 < 0.005 < 0.002 < 0.005 < 0.005 < 0.005 < 0.005 < 0.005 < 0.005 < 0.02 < 0.02 < 0.005 < 0.005 < 0.005 < 0.005 < 0.005 < 0.005 < 0.015 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA < 0.0053 NA NA NA NA NA < 0.0053 NA NA < 0.0053 NA < 0.016 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA < 0.0046 NA NA NA NA NA < 0.0046 NA NA 0.0054 NA < 0.014 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA < 0.0049 NA NA NA NA NA < 0.0049 NA NA < 0.0049 NA < 0.015 < 0.0098 < 0.0098 < 0.0049 < 0.0098 < 0.0098 < 0.074 < 0.049 < 0.0049 < 0.0049 < 0.0049 < 0.0049 < 0.0049 < 0.0049 < 0.074 < 0.0049 < 0.0049 < 0.0049 < 0.0049 < 0.002 < 0.0049 < 0.0049 < 0.0049 < 0.0049 < 0.0049 < 0.0049 < 0.02 < 0.02 < 0.0049 < 0.0049 < 0.0049 < 0.0049 < 0.0049 < 0.0049 < 0.015 < 0.0098 < 0.0098 < 0.0049 < 0.0098 < 0.0098 < 0.074 < 0.049 < 0.0049 < 0.0049 < 0.0049 < 0.0049 < 0.0049 < 0.0049 < 0.074 < 0.0049 < 0.0049 < 0.0049 < 0.0049 < 0.002 < 0.0049 < 0.0049 < 0.0049 < 0.0049 < 0.0049 < 0.0049 < 0.02 < 0.02 < 0.0049 < 0.0049 < 0.0049 < 0.0049 < 0.0049 < 0.0049 < 0.015 310 110 0.46 31000 85 70000 7800 3900 7800 780 1600 100 7 47000 --5 10 9 6.4 58 1600 310 12 81 780 --3100 12 16000 4700 1600 7800 16000 16000 110 10 0.28 1500 13 100000 720 290 1300 1200 3100 0.3 0.4 25000 1200 0.3 3000 15 1.1 5 1300 1800 0.8 53 8800 3100 70 11 650 2000 130 400 1500 320 820 1000 170 82000 12000 --20000 10000 200000 20000 41000 2000 1400 120000 --410 2000 1800 1200 1200 41000 8200 2300 16000 2000 --8200 2400 410000 12000 4100 20000 41000 41000 1.1 3.9 1.1 94 34 100000 9 3 130 1200 3100 0.76 0.99 710 1200 0.9 3000 0.5 0.39 12 1300 1800 2.2 140 140 340 0.72 28 42 2000 1.3 58 430 5.6 Table 1 - Terracon Soil Analytical Results Proposed Skinner Park 1352 - 1358 W Monroe St, Chicago, Illinois Page 2 of 12 Sample Location/Identification Sample Depth (feet) B-107 (8-10) 8' - 10' Date Collected 10/24/2012 B-108 (0-2) 0' - 2' B-108 (8-10) 8' - 10' B-109 (1-3) 1' - 3' B-110 (1-3) 1' - 3' B-111 (1-3) 1' - 3' B-111 (8-10) 8' - 10' B-112 (1-3) 1' - 3' 10/24/2012 10/24/2012 10/24/2012 10/24/2012 10/24/2012 10/24/2012 10/24/2012 Units Chicago Soil Component of the Groundwater Ingestion Route Values Class II --------------------------------------------------------------------- 0.68 1.2 0.07 70 0.2 25 160 0.3 110 1.1 3.4 2.9 0.1 17 9.6 0.33 0.6 0.15 0.02 0.3 0.4 0.3 0.17 0.8 0.32 2.5 1.3 0.3 29 3.3 6.5 19 18 150 Tier 1 Soil Remediation Objectives for Residential Properties Construction Workers Ingestion Inhalation Ingestion Inhalation Occupants Background Volatile Organic Analytical Parameters 74-87-3 74-83-9 75-01-4 75-00-3 75-09-2 67-64-1 75-15-0 75-35-4 75-34-3 156-59-2 156-60-5 67-66-3 107-06-2 78-93-3 71-55-6 56-23-5 75-27-4 78-87-5 542-75-6 79-01-6 124-48-1 79-00-5 71-43-2 75-25-2 1634-04-4 108-10-1 591-78-6 127-18-4 108-88-3 79-34-5 108-90-7 100-41-4 100-42-5 1330-20-7 Chloromethane Bromomethane Vinyl Chloride Chloroethane Methylene Chloride Acetone Carbon Disulfide 1,1-Dichloroethene 1,1-Dichloroethane cis-1,2-Dichloroethene trans-1,2-Dichloroethene Chloroform 1,2-Dichloroethane 2-Butanone 1,1,1-Trichloroethane Carbon Tetrachloride Bromodichloromethane 1,2-Dichloropropane 1,3-Dichloropropene (cis + trans) Trichloroethene Dibromochloromethane 1,1,2-Trichloroethane Benzene Bromoform Methyl Tertiary-Butyl Ether 4-Methyl-2-pentanone 2-Hexanone Tetrachloroethene Toluene 1,1,2,2-Tetrachloroethane Chlorobenzene Ethylbenzene Styrene Xylenes (total) mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg < 0.009 < 0.009 < 0.0045 < 0.009 < 0.009 < 0.067 < 0.045 < 0.0045 < 0.0045 < 0.0045 < 0.0045 < 0.0045 < 0.0045 < 0.067 < 0.0045 < 0.0045 < 0.0045 < 0.0045 < 0.0018 < 0.0045 < 0.0045 < 0.0045 < 0.0045 < 0.0045 < 0.0045 < 0.018 < 0.018 < 0.0045 < 0.0045 < 0.0045 < 0.0045 < 0.0045 < 0.0045 < 0.013 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA < 0.0088 < 0.0088 < 0.0044 < 0.0088 < 0.0088 < 0.066 < 0.044 < 0.0044 < 0.0044 < 0.0044 < 0.0044 < 0.0044 < 0.0044 < 0.066 < 0.0044 < 0.0044 < 0.0044 < 0.0044 < 0.0018 < 0.0044 < 0.0044 < 0.0044 < 0.0044 < 0.0044 < 0.0044 < 0.018 < 0.018 < 0.0044 < 0.0044 < 0.0044 < 0.0044 < 0.0044 < 0.0044 < 0.013 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA < 0.0051 NA NA NA NA NA < 0.0051 NA NA < 0.0051 NA < 0.015 < 0.0087 < 0.0087 < 0.0044 < 0.0087 < 0.0087 < 0.066 < 0.044 < 0.0044 < 0.0044 < 0.0044 < 0.0044 < 0.0044 < 0.0044 < 0.066 < 0.0044 < 0.0044 < 0.0044 < 0.0044 < 0.0017 < 0.0044 < 0.0044 < 0.0044 < 0.0044 < 0.0044 < 0.0044 < 0.017 < 0.017 < 0.0044 < 0.0044 < 0.0044 < 0.0044 < 0.0044 < 0.0044 < 0.013 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA < 0.0053 NA NA NA NA NA < 0.0053 NA NA < 0.0053 NA < 0.016 < 0.0089 < 0.0089 < 0.0045 < 0.0089 < 0.0089 < 0.067 < 0.045 < 0.0045 < 0.0045 < 0.0045 < 0.0045 < 0.0045 < 0.0045 < 0.067 < 0.0045 < 0.0045 < 0.0045 < 0.0045 < 0.0018 < 0.0045 < 0.0045 < 0.0045 < 0.0045 < 0.0045 < 0.0045 < 0.018 < 0.018 < 0.0045 < 0.0045 < 0.0045 < 0.0045 < 0.0045 < 0.0045 < 0.013 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA 310 110 0.46 31000 85 70000 7800 3900 7800 780 1600 100 7 47000 --5 10 9 6.4 58 1600 310 12 81 780 --3100 12 16000 4700 1600 7800 16000 16000 110 10 0.28 1500 13 100000 720 290 1300 1200 3100 0.3 0.4 25000 1200 0.3 3000 15 1.1 5 1300 1800 0.8 53 8800 3100 70 11 650 2000 130 400 1500 320 820 1000 170 82000 12000 --20000 10000 200000 20000 41000 2000 1400 120000 --410 2000 1800 1200 1200 41000 8200 2300 16000 2000 --8200 2400 410000 12000 4100 20000 41000 41000 1.1 3.9 1.1 94 34 100000 9 3 130 1200 3100 0.76 0.99 710 1200 0.9 3000 0.5 0.39 12 1300 1800 2.2 140 140 340 0.72 28 42 2000 1.3 58 430 5.6 Table 1 - Soil Analytical Results Proposed Skinner Park 1352 - 1358 W Monroe St, Chicago, Illinois Page 3 of 12 Sample Location/Identification Sample Depth (feet) BP-01 BP-02 BP-03 BP-04 BP-05 - - - - - 11/8/2010 11/8/2010 11/8/2010 11/8/2010 Date Collected 11/8/2010 Units Chicago Soil Component of the Groundwater Ingestion Route Values Class II --------------------------------------------------------------------- 0.68 1.2 0.07 70 0.2 25 160 0.3 110 1.1 3.4 2.9 0.1 17 9.6 0.33 0.6 0.15 0.02 0.3 0.4 0.3 0.17 0.8 0.32 2.5 1.3 0.3 29 3.3 6.5 19 18 150 Tier 1 Soil Remediation Objectives for Residential Properties Construction Workers Ingestion Inhalation Ingestion Inhalation Occupants Background Volatile Organic Analytical Parameters 74-87-3 74-83-9 75-01-4 75-00-3 75-09-2 67-64-1 75-15-0 75-35-4 75-34-3 156-59-2 156-60-5 67-66-3 107-06-2 78-93-3 71-55-6 56-23-5 75-27-4 78-87-5 542-75-6 79-01-6 124-48-1 79-00-5 71-43-2 75-25-2 1634-04-4 108-10-1 591-78-6 127-18-4 108-88-3 79-34-5 108-90-7 100-41-4 100-42-5 1330-20-7 Chloromethane Bromomethane Vinyl Chloride Chloroethane Methylene Chloride Acetone Carbon Disulfide 1,1-Dichloroethene 1,1-Dichloroethane cis-1,2-Dichloroethene trans-1,2-Dichloroethene Chloroform 1,2-Dichloroethane 2-Butanone 1,1,1-Trichloroethane Carbon Tetrachloride Bromodichloromethane 1,2-Dichloropropane 1,3-Dichloropropene (cis + trans) Trichloroethene Dibromochloromethane 1,1,2-Trichloroethane Benzene Bromoform Methyl Tertiary-Butyl Ether 4-Methyl-2-pentanone 2-Hexanone Tetrachloroethene Toluene 1,1,2,2-Tetrachloroethane Chlorobenzene Ethylbenzene Styrene Xylenes (total) mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA < 0.005 NA NA NA NA NA < 0.005 NA NA < 0.005 NA < 0.005 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA < 0.005 NA NA NA NA NA < 0.005 NA NA < 0.005 NA < 0.005 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA < 0.005 NA NA NA NA NA < 0.005 NA NA < 0.005 NA < 0.005 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA < 0.005 NA NA NA NA NA < 0.005 NA NA < 0.005 NA < 0.005 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA < 0.005 NA NA NA NA NA < 0.005 NA NA < 0.005 NA < 0.005 310 110 0.46 31000 85 70000 7800 3900 7800 780 1600 100 7 47000 --5 10 9 6.4 58 1600 310 12 81 780 --3100 12 16000 4700 1600 7800 16000 16000 110 10 0.28 1500 13 100000 720 290 1300 1200 3100 0.3 0.4 25000 1200 0.3 3000 15 1.1 5 1300 1800 0.8 53 8800 3100 70 11 650 2000 130 400 1500 320 820 1000 170 82000 12000 --20000 10000 200000 20000 41000 2000 1400 120000 --410 2000 1800 1200 1200 41000 8200 2300 16000 2000 --8200 2400 410000 12000 4100 20000 41000 41000 1.1 3.9 1.1 94 34 100000 9 3 130 1200 3100 0.76 0.99 710 1200 0.9 3000 0.5 0.39 12 1300 1800 2.2 140 140 340 0.72 28 42 2000 1.3 58 430 5.6 Table 1 - Terracon Soil Analytical Results Proposed Skinner Park 1352 - 1358 W Monroe St, Chicago, Illinois Page 4 of 12 Sample Location/Identification Sample Depth (feet) B-102 (1-3) 1' - 3' Date Collected 10/24/2012 B-102 (4-6) 4' - 6' B-102 (8-10) 8' - 10' B-104 (1-3) 1' - 3' B-104 (8-10) 8' - 10' B-105 (1-3) 1' - 3' B-106 (1-3) 1' - 3' B-107 (1-3) 1' - 3' 10/24/2012 10/24/2012 10/24/2012 10/24/2012 10/24/2012 10/24/2012 10/24/2012 Units Chicago Soil Component of the Groundwater Ingestion Route Values Class II ------------------------------------0.04 --------------------0.03 ----0.09 ------------0.1 ------------- 100 0.0004 4 43 1 11 15 2.4 0.2 0.00005 2.6 0.1 8 --9 --1 53 18 0.7 15 120 36 2200 0.77 1400 240 0.14 380 420 0.0007 0.01 2900 0.2 --30 0.0008 470 --2800 0.1 --5.6 --11 0.14 Tier 1 Soil Remediation Objectives for Residential Properties Construction Workers Ingestion Inhalation Ingestion Inhalation Occupants Background Semivolatile Organic Analytical Parameters - PNAs 108-95-2 111-44-4 95-57-8 95-50-1 541-73-1 106-46-7 95-48-7 108-60-1 106-44-5 621-64-7 67-72-1 98-95-3 78-59-1 88-75-5 105-67-9 111-91-1 120-83-2 120-82-1 91-20-3 106-47-8 87-68-3 59-50-7 91-57-6 77-47-4 88-06-2 95-95-4 91-58-7 88-74-4 131-11-3 208-96-8 606-20-2 99-09-2 83-32-9 51-28-5 100-02-7 132-64-9 121-14-2 84-66-2 7005-72-3 86-73-7 100-01-6 534-52-1 86-30-6 101-55-3 118-74-1 87-86-5 Phenol bis(2-Chloroethyl) ether 2-Chlorophenol 1,2-Dichlorobenzene 1,3-Dichlorobenzene 1,4-Dichlorobenzene 2-Methylphenol 2,2'-oxybis (1-chloropropane) 4-Methylphenol N-Nitroso-di-n-propylamine Hexachloroethane Nitrobenzene Isophorone 2-Nitrophenol 2,4-Dimethylphenol bis(2-Chloroethoxy) methane 2,4-Dichlorophenol 1,2,4-Trichlorobenzene Naphthalene 4-Chloroaniline Hexachlorobutadiene 4-Chloro-3-methylphenol 2-Methylnaphthalene Hexachlorocyclopentadiene 2,4,6-Trichlorophenol 2,4,5-Trichlorophenol 2-Chloronaphthalene 2-Nitroaniline Dimethylphthalate Acenaphthylene 2,6-dinitrotoluene 3-Nitroanaline Acenaphthene 2,4-Dinitrophenol 4-Nitrophenol Dibenzofuran 2,4-Dinitrotoluene Diethylphthalate 4-Chlorophenyl-phenyl ether Fluorene 4-Nitroaniline 4,6-Dinitro-2-methylphenol N-nitrosodiphenylamine 4-Bromophenyl-phenyl ether Hexachlorobenzene Pentachlorophenol mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg < 0.19 < 0.19 < 0.19 < 0.19 < 0.19 < 0.19 < 0.19 < 0.19 < 0.19 < 0.038 < 0.19 < 0.038 < 0.19 < 0.19 < 0.19 < 0.19 < 0.19 < 0.19 < 0.038 < 0.19 < 0.19 < 0.38 < 0.19 < 0.19 < 0.19 < 0.19 < 0.19 < 0.19 < 0.19 0.42 < 0.038 < 0.19 0.053 < 0.95 < 0.38 < 0.19 < 0.038 < 0.19 < 0.19 0.1 < 0.19 < 0.38 < 0.038 < 0.19 < 0.19 < 0.038 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA 0.05 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA 0.74 NA NA 0.086 NA NA NA NA NA NA 0.15 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA < 0.038 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA < 0.038 NA NA < 0.038 NA NA NA NA NA NA < 0.038 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA 0.074 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA 0.18 NA NA 0.12 NA NA NA NA NA NA 0.15 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA 0.32 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA 1.9 NA NA 2.7 NA NA NA NA NA NA 3.6 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA < 0.036 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA < 0.036 NA NA < 0.036 NA NA NA NA NA NA < 0.036 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA < 0.037 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA < 0.037 NA NA < 0.037 NA NA NA NA NA NA < 0.037 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA 0.056 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA 0.24 NA NA 0.085 NA NA NA NA NA NA 0.15 NA NA NA NA NA NA 23000 0.6 390 7000 70 --3900 3100 390 0.09 78 39 15600 --1600 --230 780 1600 310 16 5500 310 550 58 7800 6300 230 780000 2300 0.9 23 4700 160 630 160 0.9 63000 --3100 230 7.8 130 --0.4 3 --0.2 53000 560 570 11000 --1300 ------92 4600 --------3200 170 --1000 ----10 200 ----35 1300 ----250 ----------2000 ----1000 ------1 --- 61000 75 10000 18000 180 --100000 8200 1000 18 2000 1000 410000 --41000 --610 2000 4100 820 41 41000 820 14000 11000 200000 160000 610 1000000 61000 180 61 120000 410 16000 4100 180 1000000 --82000 610 820 4100 --78 520 --0.66 53000 310 570 340 --1300 ------9.4 4600 --------920 1.8 --180 ----1.1 540 ----3.6 1300 ----26 ----------2000 ----110 --1.8 --2.6 --- Table 1 - Terracon Soil Analytical Results Proposed Skinner Park 1352 - 1358 W Monroe St, Chicago, Illinois Page 5 of 12 Sample Location/Identification Sample Depth (feet) B-107 (8-10) 8' - 10' Date Collected 10/24/2012 B-108 (0-2) 0' - 2' B-108 (8-10) 8' - 10' B-109 (1-3) 1' - 3' B-110 (1-3) 1' - 3' B-111 (1-3) 1' - 3' B-111 (8-10) 8' - 10' B-112 (1-3) 1' - 3' 10/24/2012 10/24/2012 10/24/2012 10/24/2012 10/24/2012 10/24/2012 10/24/2012 Units Chicago Soil Component of the Groundwater Ingestion Route Values Class II ------------------------------------0.04 --------------------0.03 ----0.09 ------------0.1 ------------- 100 0.0004 4 43 1 11 15 2.4 0.2 0.00005 2.6 0.1 8 --9 --1 53 18 0.7 15 120 36 2200 0.77 1400 240 0.14 380 420 0.0007 0.01 2900 0.2 --30 0.0008 470 --2800 0.1 --5.6 --11 0.14 Tier 1 Soil Remediation Objectives for Residential Properties Construction Workers Ingestion Inhalation Ingestion Inhalation Occupants Background Semivolatile Organic Analytical Parameters - PNAs 108-95-2 111-44-4 95-57-8 95-50-1 541-73-1 106-46-7 95-48-7 108-60-1 106-44-5 621-64-7 67-72-1 98-95-3 78-59-1 88-75-5 105-67-9 111-91-1 120-83-2 120-82-1 91-20-3 106-47-8 87-68-3 59-50-7 91-57-6 77-47-4 88-06-2 95-95-4 91-58-7 88-74-4 131-11-3 208-96-8 606-20-2 99-09-2 83-32-9 51-28-5 100-02-7 132-64-9 121-14-2 84-66-2 7005-72-3 86-73-7 100-01-6 534-52-1 86-30-6 101-55-3 118-74-1 87-86-5 Phenol bis(2-Chloroethyl) ether 2-Chlorophenol 1,2-Dichlorobenzene 1,3-Dichlorobenzene 1,4-Dichlorobenzene 2-Methylphenol 2,2'-oxybis (1-chloropropane) 4-Methylphenol N-Nitroso-di-n-propylamine Hexachloroethane Nitrobenzene Isophorone 2-Nitrophenol 2,4-Dimethylphenol bis(2-Chloroethoxy) methane 2,4-Dichlorophenol 1,2,4-Trichlorobenzene Naphthalene 4-Chloroaniline Hexachlorobutadiene 4-Chloro-3-methylphenol 2-Methylnaphthalene Hexachlorocyclopentadiene 2,4,6-Trichlorophenol 2,4,5-Trichlorophenol 2-Chloronaphthalene 2-Nitroaniline Dimethylphthalate Acenaphthylene 2,6-dinitrotoluene 3-Nitroanaline Acenaphthene 2,4-Dinitrophenol 4-Nitrophenol Dibenzofuran 2,4-Dinitrotoluene Diethylphthalate 4-Chlorophenyl-phenyl ether Fluorene 4-Nitroaniline 4,6-Dinitro-2-methylphenol N-nitrosodiphenylamine 4-Bromophenyl-phenyl ether Hexachlorobenzene Pentachlorophenol mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA < 0.038 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA < 0.038 NA NA < 0.038 NA NA NA NA NA NA < 0.038 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA 0.35 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA 0.31 NA NA 0.42 NA NA NA NA NA NA 0.53 NA NA NA NA NA NA < 0.21 < 0.21 < 0.21 < 0.21 < 0.21 < 0.21 < 0.21 < 0.21 < 0.21 < 0.042 < 0.21 < 0.042 < 0.21 < 0.21 < 0.21 < 0.21 < 0.21 < 0.21 < 0.042 < 0.21 < 0.21 < 0.42 < 0.21 < 0.21 < 0.21 < 0.21 < 0.21 < 0.21 < 0.21 < 0.042 < 0.042 < 0.21 < 0.042 <1 < 0.42 < 0.21 < 0.042 < 0.21 < 0.21 < 0.042 < 0.21 < 0.42 < 0.042 < 0.21 < 0.21 < 0.042 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA < 0.038 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA < 0.038 NA NA < 0.038 NA NA NA NA NA NA < 0.038 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA < 0.038 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA < 0.038 NA NA < 0.038 NA NA NA NA NA NA < 0.038 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA 1.3 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA 1.3 NA NA 4.6 NA NA NA NA NA NA 6 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA < 0.04 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA < 0.04 NA NA < 0.04 NA NA NA NA NA NA < 0.04 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA < 0.05 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA < 0.05 NA NA < 0.05 NA NA NA NA NA NA < 0.05 NA NA NA NA NA NA 23000 0.6 390 7000 70 --3900 3100 390 0.09 78 39 15600 --1600 --230 780 1600 310 16 5500 310 550 58 7800 6300 230 780000 2300 0.9 23 4700 160 630 160 0.9 63000 --3100 230 7.8 130 --0.4 3 --0.2 53000 560 570 11000 --1300 ------92 4600 --------3200 170 --1000 ----10 200 ----35 1300 ----250 ----------2000 ----1000 ------1 --- 61000 75 10000 18000 180 --100000 8200 1000 18 2000 1000 410000 --41000 --610 2000 4100 820 41 41000 820 14000 11000 200000 160000 610 1000000 61000 180 61 120000 410 16000 4100 180 1000000 --82000 610 820 4100 --78 520 --0.66 53000 310 570 340 --1300 ------9.4 4600 --------920 1.8 --180 ----1.1 540 ----3.6 1300 ----26 ----------2000 ----110 --1.8 --2.6 --- Table 1 - Soil Analytical Results Proposed Skinner Park 1352 - 1358 W Monroe St, Chicago, Illinois Page 6 of 12 Sample Location/Identification Sample Depth (feet) BP-01 BP-02 BP-03 BP-04 BP-05 - - - - - 11/8/2010 11/8/2010 11/8/2010 11/8/2010 Date Collected 11/8/2010 Units Chicago Soil Component of the Groundwater Ingestion Route Values Class II ------------------------------------0.04 --------------------0.03 ----0.09 ------------0.1 ------------- 100 0.0004 4 43 1 11 15 2.4 0.2 0.00005 2.6 0.1 8 --9 --1 53 18 0.7 15 120 36 2200 0.77 1400 240 0.14 380 420 0.0007 0.01 2900 0.2 --30 0.0008 470 --2800 0.1 --5.6 --11 0.14 Tier 1 Soil Remediation Objectives for Residential Properties Construction Workers Ingestion Inhalation Ingestion Inhalation Occupants Background Semivolatile Organic Analytical Parameters - PNAs 108-95-2 111-44-4 95-57-8 95-50-1 541-73-1 106-46-7 95-48-7 108-60-1 106-44-5 621-64-7 67-72-1 98-95-3 78-59-1 88-75-5 105-67-9 111-91-1 120-83-2 120-82-1 91-20-3 106-47-8 87-68-3 59-50-7 91-57-6 77-47-4 88-06-2 95-95-4 91-58-7 88-74-4 131-11-3 208-96-8 606-20-2 99-09-2 83-32-9 51-28-5 100-02-7 132-64-9 121-14-2 84-66-2 7005-72-3 86-73-7 100-01-6 534-52-1 86-30-6 101-55-3 118-74-1 87-86-5 Phenol bis(2-Chloroethyl) ether 2-Chlorophenol 1,2-Dichlorobenzene 1,3-Dichlorobenzene 1,4-Dichlorobenzene 2-Methylphenol 2,2'-oxybis (1-chloropropane) 4-Methylphenol N-Nitroso-di-n-propylamine Hexachloroethane Nitrobenzene Isophorone 2-Nitrophenol 2,4-Dimethylphenol bis(2-Chloroethoxy) methane 2,4-Dichlorophenol 1,2,4-Trichlorobenzene Naphthalene 4-Chloroaniline Hexachlorobutadiene 4-Chloro-3-methylphenol 2-Methylnaphthalene Hexachlorocyclopentadiene 2,4,6-Trichlorophenol 2,4,5-Trichlorophenol 2-Chloronaphthalene 2-Nitroaniline Dimethylphthalate Acenaphthylene 2,6-dinitrotoluene 3-Nitroanaline Acenaphthene 2,4-Dinitrophenol 4-Nitrophenol Dibenzofuran 2,4-Dinitrotoluene Diethylphthalate 4-Chlorophenyl-phenyl ether Fluorene 4-Nitroaniline 4,6-Dinitro-2-methylphenol N-nitrosodiphenylamine 4-Bromophenyl-phenyl ether Hexachlorobenzene Pentachlorophenol mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA 0.948 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA 0.47 NA NA 0.651 NA NA NA NA NA NA 0.997 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA 0.149 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA 0.459 NA NA 0.245 NA NA NA NA NA NA 0.398 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA 0.266 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA 0.142 NA NA 0.284 NA NA NA NA NA NA 0.368 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA <0.025 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA <0.05 NA NA <0.05 NA NA NA NA NA NA <0.05 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA <0.025 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA <0.05 NA NA <0.05 NA NA NA NA NA NA <0.05 NA NA NA NA NA NA 23000 0.6 390 7000 70 --3900 3100 390 0.09 78 39 15600 --1600 --230 780 1600 310 16 5500 310 550 58 7800 6300 230 780000 2300 0.9 23 4700 160 630 160 0.9 63000 --3100 230 7.8 130 --0.4 3 --0.2 53000 560 570 11000 --1300 ------92 4600 --------3200 170 --1000 ----10 200 ----35 1300 ----250 ----------2000 ----1000 ------1 --- 61000 75 10000 18000 180 --100000 8200 1000 18 2000 1000 410000 --41000 --610 2000 4100 820 41 41000 820 14000 11000 200000 160000 610 1000000 61000 180 61 120000 410 16000 4100 180 1000000 --82000 610 820 4100 --78 520 --0.66 53000 310 570 340 --1300 ------9.4 4600 --------920 1.8 --180 ----1.1 540 ----3.6 1300 ----26 ----------2000 ----110 --1.8 --2.6 --- Table 1 - Terracon Soil Analytical Results Proposed Skinner Park 1352 - 1358 W Monroe St, Chicago, Illinois Page 7 of 12 Sample Location/Identification Sample Depth (feet) B-102 (4-6) 4' - 6' B-102 (8-10) 8' - 10' B-104 (1-3) 1' - 3' B-104 (8-10) 8' - 10' B-105 (1-3) 1' - 3' B-106 (1-3) 1' - 3' B-107 (1-3) 1' - 3' 10/24/2012 10/24/2012 10/24/2012 10/24/2012 10/24/2012 10/24/2012 10/24/2012 Chicago Soil Component of the Groundwater Ingestion Route Values Class II 1.3 0.62 < 0.19 < 0.19 4.2 5.4 < 0.19 < 0.19 3.3 3.2 < 0.95 < 0.19 2.3 2.2 2.9 1.7 1.1 1.7 2 1 NA NA 8.1 9.4 NA NA 6.2 6.1 NA NA 4.5 3.2 5.2 2.9 1.8 3 < 0.038 < 0.038 NA NA < 0.038 < 0.038 NA NA < 0.038 < 0.038 NA NA < 0.038 < 0.038 < 0.038 < 0.038 < 0.038 < 0.038 2.2 0.41 NA NA 3.5 3.2 NA NA 1.8 2 NA NA 1.9 1.5 1.9 1.4 0.76 1.6 7.9 1 NA NA 0.87 0.71 NA NA 0.38 0.37 NA NA 0.3 0.23 0.33 0.2 0.13 0.22 0.52 0.097 NA NA 0.74 0.69 NA NA 0.39 0.41 NA NA 0.37 0.26 0.35 0.24 0.15 0.27 0.05 < 0.037 NA NA 0.075 0.072 NA NA 0.042 0.045 NA NA 0.04 < 0.037 < 0.037 < 0.037 < 0.037 < 0.037 1.5 0.47 NA NA 3.2 3.4 NA NA 2 2 NA NA 1.5 1.4 1.8 1.1 0.67 1.2 2300 23000 32 7800 3100 2300 16000 1 0.9 88 46 1600 0.9 9 0.09 0.9 0.09 2300 ------2300 ----930 ------31000 10000 ------------- 61000 610000 6200 200000 82000 61000 410000 280 170 17000 4100 4100 170 1700 17 170 17 61000 ------2300 ----930 ------31000 10000 ------------- 1.3 0.25 ----2.7 1.9 ----1.1 1.2 ----1.5 0.99 1.3 0.86 0.2 0.68 1000 59000 2.8 2300 21000 21000 930 0.033 8 800 31000 10000 25 250 82 69 7.6 130000 < 0.0018 < 0.0018 < 0.0018 < 0.0018 < 0.0018 < 0.0018 < 0.0018 < 0.0018 < 0.0018 < 0.0018 < 0.0018 < 0.0018 < 0.0018 < 0.0018 < 0.0018 < 0.0018 < 0.0018 < 0.0018 < 0.0018 < 0.0018 < 0.038 < 0.091 < 0.091 < 0.091 < 0.091 < 0.091 < 0.091 < 0.091 < 0.637 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA 0.1 ----0.5 0.1 0.04 0.07 470 0.04 2 23 470 3 470 2 390 23 23 1.8 1.8 0.6 --------------1 0.8 ------0.1 3 5 --1 ------------------72 72 89 ----------------- 20 ----96 28 6.1 2.7 1200 7.8 370 61 1200 520 1200 100 1000 61 61 100 100 110 --------------1 2.1 ------16 9.3 13 --3.1 ----------2100 ------22 22 240 ----------------- ----------------------------------------------------------- 0.003 ----0.047 110 2.5 3.3 90 0.02 270 5 90 80 90 160 780 5 5 48 48 150 ----------------- B-102 (1-3) 1' - 3' Date Collected 10/24/2012 Units 85-01-8 Phenanthrene mg/kg 120-12-7 Anthracene mg/kg 86-74-8 Carbazole mg/kg 84-74-2 Di-n-butylphthalate mg/kg 206-44-0 Fluoranthene mg/kg 129-00-0 Pyrene mg/kg 85-68-7 Butylbenzylphthalate mg/kg 91-94-1 3,3'-Dichlorobenzidine mg/kg 56-55-3 Benzo(a)anthracene mg/kg 218-01-9 Chrysene mg/kg 117-81-7 bis(2-Ethylhexyl)phthalate mg/kg 117-84-0 Di-n-octylphthalate mg/kg 205-99-2 Benzo(b)fluoranthene mg/kg 207-08-9 Benzo(k)fluoranthene mg/kg 50-32-8 Benzo(a)pyrene mg/kg 193-39-5 Indeno(1,2,3-c,d)pyrene mg/kg 53-70-3 Dibenzo(a,h)anthracene mg/kg 191-24-2 Benzo(g,h,i)perylene mg/kg Pesticide and Aroclors Organic Analytical Parameters 319-84-6 alpha-BHC mg/kg 319-85-7 beta-BHC mg/kg 319-86-8 delta-BHC mg/kg 58-89-9 gamma-BHC mg/kg 76-44-8 Heptachlor mg/kg 309-00-2 Aldrin mg/kg 1024-57-3 Heptachlor epoxide mg/kg 959-98-8 Endosulfan I mg/kg 60-57-1 Dieldrin mg/kg 72-55-9 4,4'-DDE mg/kg 72-20-8 Endrin mg/kg 33213-65-9 Endosulfan II mg/kg 72-54-8 4,4'-DDD mg/kg 1031-07-8 Endosulfan sulfate mg/kg 50-29-3 4,4'-DDT mg/kg 72-43-5 Methoxychlor mg/kg 53494-70-5 Endrin ketone mg/kg 7421-93-4 Endrin aldehyde mg/kg 5103-71-9 alpha-Chlordane mg/kg 5566-34-7 gamma-Chlordane mg/kg 8001-35-2 Toxaphene mg/kg 12674-11-2 Aroclor - 1016 mg/kg 11104-28-2 Aroclor - 1221 mg/kg 11141-16-5 Aroclor - 1232 mg/kg 53469-21-9 Aroclor - 1242 mg/kg 12672-29-6 Aroclor - 1248 mg/kg 11097-69-1 Aroclor - 1254 mg/kg 11096-82-5 Aroclor - 1260 mg/kg 1336-36-3 Polychlorinated Biphenyls (PCBs) mg/kg Tier 1 Soil Remediation Objectives for Residential Properties Construction Workers Ingestion Inhalation Ingestion Inhalation Occupants Background Table 1 - Terracon Soil Analytical Results Proposed Skinner Park 1352 - 1358 W Monroe St, Chicago, Illinois Page 8 of 12 Sample Location/Identification Sample Depth (feet) B-108 (0-2) 0' - 2' B-108 (8-10) 8' - 10' B-109 (1-3) 1' - 3' B-110 (1-3) 1' - 3' B-111 (1-3) 1' - 3' B-111 (8-10) 8' - 10' B-112 (1-3) 1' - 3' 10/24/2012 10/24/2012 10/24/2012 10/24/2012 10/24/2012 10/24/2012 10/24/2012 Chicago Soil Component of the Groundwater Ingestion Route Values Class II 0.041 < 0.038 NA NA < 0.038 < 0.038 NA NA < 0.038 < 0.038 NA NA < 0.038 < 0.038 < 0.038 < 0.038 < 0.038 < 0.038 6.1 1.4 NA NA 7.7 6.2 NA NA 3.2 3.3 NA NA 2.5 2.6 3 1.8 0.98 1.9 0.22 0.048 < 0.21 < 0.21 0.34 0.3 < 0.21 < 0.21 0.17 0.17 <1 < 0.21 0.14 0.13 0.15 0.097 0.06 0.11 0.11 < 0.038 NA NA 0.29 0.28 NA NA 0.15 0.16 NA NA 0.13 0.12 0.15 0.099 < 0.038 0.13 0.51 0.08 NA NA 0.79 0.81 NA NA 0.36 0.45 NA NA 0.33 0.31 0.37 0.24 0.13 0.28 64 18 NA NA 84 66 NA NA 35 36 NA NA 27 23 30 19 10 21 < 0.04 < 0.04 NA NA < 0.04 < 0.04 NA NA < 0.04 < 0.04 NA NA < 0.04 < 0.04 < 0.04 < 0.04 < 0.04 < 0.04 0.11 < 0.05 NA NA 0.21 0.21 NA NA 0.12 0.13 NA NA 0.11 0.095 0.12 0.073 < 0.05 0.084 2300 23000 32 7800 3100 2300 16000 1 0.9 88 46 1600 0.9 9 0.09 0.9 0.09 2300 ------2300 ----930 ------31000 10000 ------------- 61000 610000 6200 200000 82000 61000 410000 280 170 17000 4100 4100 170 1700 17 170 17 61000 ------2300 ----930 ------31000 10000 ------------- 1.3 0.25 ----2.7 1.9 ----1.1 1.2 ----1.5 0.99 1.3 0.86 0.2 0.68 1000 59000 2.8 2300 21000 21000 930 0.033 8 800 31000 10000 25 250 82 69 7.6 130000 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA < 0.002 < 0.002 < 0.002 < 0.002 < 0.002 < 0.002 < 0.002 < 0.002 < 0.002 < 0.002 < 0.002 < 0.002 < 0.002 < 0.002 < 0.002 < 0.002 < 0.002 < 0.002 < 0.002 < 0.002 < 0.042 < 0.1 < 0.1 < 0.1 < 0.1 < 0.1 < 0.1 < 0.1 < 0.7 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA 0.1 ----0.5 0.1 0.04 0.07 470 0.04 2 23 470 3 470 2 390 23 23 1.8 1.8 0.6 --------------1 0.8 ------0.1 3 5 --1 ------------------72 72 89 ----------------- 20 ----96 28 6.1 2.7 1200 7.8 370 61 1200 520 1200 100 1000 61 61 100 100 110 --------------1 2.1 ------16 9.3 13 --3.1 ----------2100 ------22 22 240 ----------------- ----------------------------------------------------------- 0.003 ----0.047 110 2.5 3.3 90 0.02 270 5 90 80 90 160 780 5 5 48 48 150 ----------------- B-107 (8-10) 8' - 10' Date Collected 10/24/2012 Units 85-01-8 Phenanthrene mg/kg 120-12-7 Anthracene mg/kg 86-74-8 Carbazole mg/kg 84-74-2 Di-n-butylphthalate mg/kg 206-44-0 Fluoranthene mg/kg 129-00-0 Pyrene mg/kg 85-68-7 Butylbenzylphthalate mg/kg 91-94-1 3,3'-Dichlorobenzidine mg/kg 56-55-3 Benzo(a)anthracene mg/kg 218-01-9 Chrysene mg/kg 117-81-7 bis(2-Ethylhexyl)phthalate mg/kg 117-84-0 Di-n-octylphthalate mg/kg 205-99-2 Benzo(b)fluoranthene mg/kg 207-08-9 Benzo(k)fluoranthene mg/kg 50-32-8 Benzo(a)pyrene mg/kg 193-39-5 Indeno(1,2,3-c,d)pyrene mg/kg 53-70-3 Dibenzo(a,h)anthracene mg/kg 191-24-2 Benzo(g,h,i)perylene mg/kg Pesticide and Aroclors Organic Analytical Parameters 319-84-6 alpha-BHC mg/kg 319-85-7 beta-BHC mg/kg 319-86-8 delta-BHC mg/kg 58-89-9 gamma-BHC mg/kg 76-44-8 Heptachlor mg/kg 309-00-2 Aldrin mg/kg 1024-57-3 Heptachlor epoxide mg/kg 959-98-8 Endosulfan I mg/kg 60-57-1 Dieldrin mg/kg 72-55-9 4,4'-DDE mg/kg 72-20-8 Endrin mg/kg 33213-65-9 Endosulfan II mg/kg 72-54-8 4,4'-DDD mg/kg 1031-07-8 Endosulfan sulfate mg/kg 50-29-3 4,4'-DDT mg/kg 72-43-5 Methoxychlor mg/kg 53494-70-5 Endrin ketone mg/kg 7421-93-4 Endrin aldehyde mg/kg 5103-71-9 alpha-Chlordane mg/kg 5566-34-7 gamma-Chlordane mg/kg 8001-35-2 Toxaphene mg/kg 12674-11-2 Aroclor - 1016 mg/kg 11104-28-2 Aroclor - 1221 mg/kg 11141-16-5 Aroclor - 1232 mg/kg 53469-21-9 Aroclor - 1242 mg/kg 12672-29-6 Aroclor - 1248 mg/kg 11097-69-1 Aroclor - 1254 mg/kg 11096-82-5 Aroclor - 1260 mg/kg 1336-36-3 Polychlorinated Biphenyls (PCBs) mg/kg Tier 1 Soil Remediation Objectives for Residential Properties Construction Workers Ingestion Inhalation Ingestion Inhalation Occupants Background Table 1 - Soil Analytical Results Proposed Skinner Park 1352 - 1358 W Monroe St, Chicago, Illinois Page 9 of 12 Sample Location/Identification Sample Depth (feet) BP-01 BP-02 BP-03 BP-04 BP-05 - - - - - 11/8/2010 11/8/2010 11/8/2010 11/8/2010 Chicago Soil Component of the Groundwater Ingestion Route Values Class II 6.4 1.48 NA NA 8.59 5.73 NA NA 3.92 3.42 NA NA 4.21 2.87 4.47 3.16 0.805 2.9 1.64 0.911 NA NA 6.06 4.81 NA NA 3.32 2.59 NA NA 2.36 2.81 3.46 2.13 0.639 1.87 2.86 0.586 NA NA 3.98 2.38 NA NA 1.61 1.41 NA NA 1.43 1.7 1.79 1.35 0.335 1.23 <0.05 <0.05 NA NA <0.05 <0.05 NA NA <0.0087 <0.05 NA NA <0.011 <0.011 <0.015 <0.029 <0.02 <0.05 <0.05 <0.05 NA NA <0.05 <0.05 NA NA <0.0087 <0.05 NA NA <0.011 <0.011 <0.015 <0.029 <0.02 <0.05 2300 23000 32 7800 3100 2300 16000 1 0.9 88 46 1600 0.9 9 0.09 0.9 0.09 2300 ------2300 ----930 ------31000 10000 ------------- 61000 610000 6200 200000 82000 61000 410000 280 170 17000 4100 4100 170 1700 17 170 17 61000 ------2300 ----930 ------31000 10000 ------------- 1.3 0.25 ----2.7 1.9 ----1.1 1.2 ----1.5 0.99 1.3 0.86 0.2 0.68 1000 59000 2.8 2300 21000 21000 930 0.033 8 800 31000 10000 25 250 82 69 7.6 130000 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA 0.1 ----0.5 0.1 0.04 0.07 470 0.04 2 23 470 3 470 2 390 23 23 1.8 1.8 0.6 --------------1 0.8 ------0.1 3 5 --1 ------------------72 72 89 ----------------- 20 ----96 28 6.1 2.7 1200 7.8 370 61 1200 520 1200 100 1000 61 61 100 100 110 --------------1 2.1 ------16 9.3 13 --3.1 ----------2100 ------22 22 240 ----------------- ----------------------------------------------------------- 0.003 ----0.047 110 2.5 3.3 90 0.02 270 5 90 80 90 160 780 5 5 48 48 150 ----------------- Date Collected 11/8/2010 Units 85-01-8 Phenanthrene mg/kg 120-12-7 Anthracene mg/kg 86-74-8 Carbazole mg/kg 84-74-2 Di-n-butylphthalate mg/kg 206-44-0 Fluoranthene mg/kg 129-00-0 Pyrene mg/kg 85-68-7 Butylbenzylphthalate mg/kg 91-94-1 3,3'-Dichlorobenzidine mg/kg 56-55-3 Benzo(a)anthracene mg/kg 218-01-9 Chrysene mg/kg 117-81-7 bis(2-Ethylhexyl)phthalate mg/kg 117-84-0 Di-n-octylphthalate mg/kg 205-99-2 Benzo(b)fluoranthene mg/kg 207-08-9 Benzo(k)fluoranthene mg/kg 50-32-8 Benzo(a)pyrene mg/kg 193-39-5 Indeno(1,2,3-c,d)pyrene mg/kg 53-70-3 Dibenzo(a,h)anthracene mg/kg 191-24-2 Benzo(g,h,i)perylene mg/kg Pesticide and Aroclors Organic Analytical Parameters 319-84-6 alpha-BHC mg/kg 319-85-7 beta-BHC mg/kg 319-86-8 delta-BHC mg/kg 58-89-9 gamma-BHC mg/kg 76-44-8 Heptachlor mg/kg 309-00-2 Aldrin mg/kg 1024-57-3 Heptachlor epoxide mg/kg 959-98-8 Endosulfan I mg/kg 60-57-1 Dieldrin mg/kg 72-55-9 4,4'-DDE mg/kg 72-20-8 Endrin mg/kg 33213-65-9 Endosulfan II mg/kg 72-54-8 4,4'-DDD mg/kg 1031-07-8 Endosulfan sulfate mg/kg 50-29-3 4,4'-DDT mg/kg 72-43-5 Methoxychlor mg/kg 53494-70-5 Endrin ketone mg/kg 7421-93-4 Endrin aldehyde mg/kg 5103-71-9 alpha-Chlordane mg/kg 5566-34-7 gamma-Chlordane mg/kg 8001-35-2 Toxaphene mg/kg 12674-11-2 Aroclor - 1016 mg/kg 11104-28-2 Aroclor - 1221 mg/kg 11141-16-5 Aroclor - 1232 mg/kg 53469-21-9 Aroclor - 1242 mg/kg 12672-29-6 Aroclor - 1248 mg/kg 11097-69-1 Aroclor - 1254 mg/kg 11096-82-5 Aroclor - 1260 mg/kg 1336-36-3 Polychlorinated Biphenyls (PCBs) mg/kg Tier 1 Soil Remediation Objectives for Residential Properties Construction Workers Ingestion Inhalation Ingestion Inhalation Occupants Background Table 1 - Terracon Soil Analytical Results Proposed Skinner Park 1352 - 1358 W Monroe St, Chicago, Illinois Page 10 of 12 Sample Location/Identification Sample Depth (feet) B-102 (1-3) 1' - 3' Date Collected 10/24/2012 B-102 (4-6) 4' - 6' B-102 (8-10) 8' - 10' B-104 (1-3) 1' - 3' B-104 (8-10) 8' - 10' B-105 (1-3) 1' - 3' B-106 (1-3) 1' - 3' B-107 (1-3) 1' - 3' 10/24/2012 10/24/2012 10/24/2012 10/24/2012 10/24/2012 10/24/2012 10/24/2012 Units Chicago Soil Component of the Groundwater Ingestion Route Values Class II Tier 1 Soil Remediation Objectives for Residential Properties Construction Workers Ingestion Inhalation Ingestion Inhalation Occupants Background Inorganic Analytical Parameters 7429-90-5 Aluminum 7440-36-0 Antimony 7440-38-2 Arsenic 7440-39-3 Barium 7440-41-7 Beryllium 7440-43-9 Cadmium 7440-70-2 Calcium 7440-47-3 Chromium 7440-48-4 Cobalt 7440-50-8 Copper 7439-89-6 Iron 7439-92-1 Lead 7439-95-4 Magnesium 7439-96-5 Manganese 7439-97-6 Mercury 7440-02-0 Nickel 7440-09-7 Potassium 7782-49-2 Selenium 7440-22-4 Silver 7440-23-5 Sodium 7440-28-0 Thallium 7440-62-2 Vanadium 7440-66-6 Zinc 57-12-5 Cyanide Inorganic Analytical Parameters (SPLP) 7429-90-5 Aluminum 7440-48-4 Cobalt 7439-89-6 Iron 7439-92-1 Lead 7782-49-2 Selenium 7439-92-1 Lead (TCLP) mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg 6300 < 2.3 7.4 49 < 0.58 < 0.58 35000 11 6.2 17 13000 66 17000 370 0.31 17 890 < 1.2 < 1.2 240 < 1.2 19 60 < 0.29 NA NA 5.8 35 NA < 0.6 NA 8.1 NA NA NA 54 NA NA 0.068 NA NA < 1.2 < 1.2 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA 10 290 NA 1.2 NA 10 NA NA NA 520 NA NA 0.53 NA NA < 1.3 < 1.3 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA 6.5 43 NA < 0.54 NA 9.2 NA NA NA 87 NA NA 0.033 NA NA 1.3 < 1.1 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA 8.8 64 NA < 0.58 NA 9.5 NA NA NA 110 NA NA 0.16 NA NA < 1.2 < 1.2 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA 2.8 18 NA < 0.58 NA 4.4 NA NA NA 33 NA NA 0.024 NA NA < 1.2 < 1.2 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA 6.2 56 NA < 0.56 NA 11 NA NA NA 71 NA NA 0.096 NA NA < 1.1 < 1.1 NA NA NA NA NA 78000 31 13 5500 160 78 --230 4700 2900 --400 325000 1600 23 1600 --390 390 --6.3 550 23000 1600 1000000 --750 690000 1300 1800 --270 ----------69000 10 13000 ----------------- 410000 82 61 14000 410 200 --4100 12000 8200 --700 730000 4100 61 4100 --1000 1000 --160 1400 61000 4100 870000 --25000 870000 44000 59000 --690 ----------8700 0.1 440000 ----------------- 9500 4.0 13 110 0.59 0.6 9300 16.2 8.9 19.6 15900 36 4820 636 0.06 18 1268 0.48 0.55 130 0.32 25.2 95 0.51 ------------------------------------------------- mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA 0.059 NA NA NA NA NA NA < 0.004 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA ------------- ------------- ------------- ------------- ------------- 5 1 5 0.1 0.05 0.1 Table 1 - Terracon Soil Analytical Results Proposed Skinner Park 1352 - 1358 W Monroe St, Chicago, Illinois Page 11 of 12 Sample Location/Identification Sample Depth (feet) B-107 (8-10) 8' - 10' Date Collected 10/24/2012 B-108 (0-2) 0' - 2' B-108 (8-10) 8' - 10' B-109 (1-3) 1' - 3' B-110 (1-3) 1' - 3' B-111 (1-3) 1' - 3' B-111 (8-10) 8' - 10' B-112 (1-3) 1' - 3' 10/24/2012 10/24/2012 10/24/2012 10/24/2012 10/24/2012 10/24/2012 10/24/2012 Units Chicago Soil Component of the Groundwater Ingestion Route Values Class II Tier 1 Soil Remediation Objectives for Residential Properties Construction Workers Ingestion Inhalation Ingestion Inhalation Occupants Background Inorganic Analytical Parameters 7429-90-5 Aluminum 7440-36-0 Antimony 7440-38-2 Arsenic 7440-39-3 Barium 7440-41-7 Beryllium 7440-43-9 Cadmium 7440-70-2 Calcium 7440-47-3 Chromium 7440-48-4 Cobalt 7440-50-8 Copper 7439-89-6 Iron 7439-92-1 Lead 7439-95-4 Magnesium 7439-96-5 Manganese 7439-97-6 Mercury 7440-02-0 Nickel 7440-09-7 Potassium 7782-49-2 Selenium 7440-22-4 Silver 7440-23-5 Sodium 7440-28-0 Thallium 7440-62-2 Vanadium 7440-66-6 Zinc 57-12-5 Cyanide Inorganic Analytical Parameters (SPLP) 7429-90-5 Aluminum 7440-39-3 Barium 7440-43-9 Cadmium 7440-48-4 Cobalt 7440-50-8 Copper 7439-89-6 Iron 7439-92-1 Lead 7440-02-0 Nickel 7782-49-2 Selenium 7440-22-4 Silver 7439-92-1 Lead (TCLP) mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg NA NA 6.6 76 NA < 0.57 NA 20 NA NA NA 18 NA NA < 0.022 NA NA < 1.1 < 1.1 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA 2.9 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA 120 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA 13000 < 2.3 12 59 0.57 < 0.57 74000 18 11 23 25000 23 31000 570 0.028 34 2300 < 1.1 < 1.1 440 < 1.1 21 47 0.34 NA NA 2.3 16 NA < 0.62 NA 4.9 NA NA NA 23 NA NA 0.07 NA NA < 1.2 < 1.2 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA 8.7 120 NA < 0.56 NA 8.4 NA NA NA 400 NA NA 0.24 NA NA < 1.1 < 1.1 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA 19 310 NA 3 NA 21 / <0.58** NA NA NA 760 NA NA 0.47 NA NA 1.6 1.3 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA 4.8 66 NA < 0.61 NA 13 NA NA NA 14 NA NA < 0.022 NA NA 1.4 < 1.2 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA 3.7 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA 21 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA 78000 31 13 5500 160 78 --230 4700 2900 --400 325000 1600 23 1600 --390 390 --6.3 550 23000 1600 1000000 --750 690000 1300 1800 --270 ----------69000 10 13000 ----------------- 410000 82 61 14000 410 200 --4100 12000 8200 --700 730000 4100 61 4100 --1000 1000 --160 1400 61000 4100 870000 --25000 870000 44000 59000 --690 ----------8700 0.1 440000 ----------------- 9500 4.0 13 110 0.59 0.6 9300 16.2 8.9 19.6 15900 36 4820 636 0.06 18 1268 0.48 0.55 130 0.32 25.2 95 0.51 ------------------------------------------------- mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA 1.6 NA NA < 0.004 < 0.02 1.8 NA < 0.008 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA 0.023 < 0.002 NA NA NA 0.011 NA NA < 0.05 0.12 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA ----------------------- ----------------------- ----------------------- ----------------------- ----------------------- 5 2 0.05 1 0.65 5 0.1 2 0.05 --0.1 Table 1 - Soil Analytical Results Proposed Skinner Park 1352 - 1358 W Monroe St, Chicago, Illinois Page 12 of 12 Sample Location/Identification Sample Depth (feet) BP-01 BP-02 BP-03 BP-04 BP-05 - - - - - 11/8/2010 11/8/2010 11/8/2010 11/8/2010 Date Collected 11/8/2010 Units Chicago Soil Component of the Groundwater Ingestion Route Values Class II Tier 1 Soil Remediation Objectives for Residential Properties Construction Workers Ingestion Inhalation Ingestion Inhalation Occupants Background Inorganic Analytical Parameters 7429-90-5 Aluminum 7440-36-0 Antimony 7440-38-2 Arsenic 7440-39-3 Barium 7440-41-7 Beryllium 7440-43-9 Cadmium 7440-70-2 Calcium 7440-47-3 Chromium 7440-48-4 Cobalt 7440-50-8 Copper 7439-89-6 Iron 7439-92-1 Lead 7439-95-4 Magnesium 7439-96-5 Manganese 7439-97-6 Mercury 7440-02-0 Nickel 7440-09-7 Potassium 7782-49-2 Selenium 7440-22-4 Silver 7440-23-5 Sodium 7440-28-0 Thallium 7440-62-2 Vanadium 7440-66-6 Zinc 57-12-5 Cyanide Inorganic Analytical Parameters (SPLP) 7429-90-5 Aluminum 7440-48-4 Cobalt 7439-89-6 Iron 7439-92-1 Lead 7782-49-2 Selenium 7439-92-1 Lead (TCLP) mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg mg/kg NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA 78000 31 13 5500 160 78 --230 4700 2900 --400 325000 1600 23 1600 --390 390 --6.3 550 23000 1600 1000000 --750 690000 1300 1800 --270 ----------69000 10 13000 ----------------- 410000 82 61 14000 410 200 --4100 12000 8200 --700 730000 4100 61 4100 --1000 1000 --160 1400 61000 4100 870000 --25000 870000 44000 59000 --690 ----------8700 0.1 440000 ----------------- 9500 4.0 13 110 0.59 0.6 9300 16.2 8.9 19.6 15900 36 4820 636 0.06 18 1268 0.48 0.55 130 0.32 25.2 95 0.51 ------------------------------------------------- mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA ------------- ------------- ------------- ------------- ------------- 5 1 5 0.1 0.05 0.1 Table 2 - Terracon pH-Specific Soil Analytical Results Proposed Skinner Park 1352 - 1358 Monroe St, Chicago, Illinois Page 1 of 2 CAS Number 7440-36-0 7440-38-2 7440-39-3 7440-41-7 7440-43-9 18540-29-9 7440-50-8 57-12-5 7439-92-1 7439-97-6 7440-02-0 7782-49-2 7440-22-4 7440-28-0 7440-62-2 7440-66-6 95-57-8 120-83-2 87-86-5 95-95-4 88-06-2 534-52-1 100-02-7 Sample Location B‐102 (1‐3) Sample Depth (feet) Date Sampled pH (Standard Units) Chemical Units Antimony mg/kg Arsenic mg/kg Barium mg/kg Beryllium mg/kg Cadmium mg/kg Chromium * mg/kg Copper mg/kg Cyanide mg/kg Lead mg/kg Mercury mg/kg Nickel mg/kg Selenium mg/kg Silver mg/kg Thallium mg/kg Vanadium mg/kg Zinc mg/kg 2-Chlorophenol mg/kg 2,4-Dichlorophenol mg/kg Pentachlorophenol mg/kg 2,4,5-Trichlorophenol mg/kg 2,4,6-Trichlorophenol mg/kg 4,6-Dinitro-2-methylphenol mg/kg 4-Nitrophenol mg/kg 1' - 3' 10/24/2012 B‐102 (4‐6) Class II Objective 8.3 < 2.3 7.4 49 < 0.58 < 0.58 NA 17 < 0.29 66 0.31 17 < 1.2 < 1.2 < 1.2 19 60 < 0.19 < 0.19 < 0.038 < 0.19 < 0.19 < 0.38 < 0.38 4' - 6' 10/24/2012 B‐104 (1‐3) Class II Objective 8.3 20 130 NE NE NE NE NE 120 1420 NE NE 1.8 NE 44 NE NE 2.2 0.56 0.1 36 0.07 0.0031 0.23 NA 5.8 35 NA < 0.6 NA NA NA 54 0.068 NA < 1.2 < 1.2 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA 1' - 3' 10/24/2012 B‐104 (8‐10) Class II Objective 8.9 20 130 NE NE NE NE NE 120 1420 NE NE 1.8 NE 44 NE NE 2.2 0.56 0.1 36 0.07 0.0031 0.23 NA 10 290 NA 1.2 NA NA NA 520 0.53 NA < 1.3 < 1.3 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA Notes: Remediation Objectives from 35 Illinois Administrative Code Chapter 742: Tiered Approach to Corrective Action Objectives . mg/kg = milligrams per kilogram, generally equivalent to ppm NA = Not Applicable NE = Not Established * Hexavalent Chromium 8' - 10' 10/24/2012 B‐105 (1‐3) Class II Objective 10.6 20 130 NE NE NE NE NE 120 3760 NE NE 1.3 NE 49 NE NE 1.5 0.48 0.1 26 0.07 0.0031 0.23 NA 6.5 43 NA < 0.54 NA NA NA 87 0.033 NA 1.3 < 1.1 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA 1' - 3' 10/24/2012 B‐106 (1‐3) Class II Objective 8 NE NE NE NE NE NE NE NE NE NE NE NE NE NE NE NE NE NE NE NE NE NE NE NA 8.8 64 NA < 0.58 NA NA NA 110 0.16 NA < 1.2 < 1.2 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA 1' - 3' 10/24/2012 Class II Objective 8 20 120 2100 1000000 4300 NE 330000 120 1420 40 76000 2.4 NE 38 NE 110000 3.1 0.69 0.1 64 0.07 0.0031 0.23 NA 2.8 18 NA < 0.58 NA NA NA 33 0.024 NA < 1.2 < 1.2 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA 20 120 2100 1000000 4300 NE 330000 120 1420 40 76000 2.4 NE 38 NE 110000 3.1 0.69 0.1 64 0.07 0.0031 0.23 Table 2 - Terracon pH-Specific Soil Analytical Results Proposed Skinner Park 1352 - 1358 Monroe St, Chicago, Illinois Page 2 of 2 CAS Number 7440-36-0 7440-38-2 7440-39-3 7440-41-7 7440-43-9 18540-29-9 7440-50-8 57-12-5 7439-92-1 7439-97-6 7440-02-0 7782-49-2 7440-22-4 7440-28-0 7440-62-2 7440-66-6 95-57-8 120-83-2 87-86-5 95-95-4 88-06-2 534-52-1 100-02-7 Sample Location B‐107 (1‐3) Sample Depth (feet) Date Sampled pH (Standard Units) Chemical Units Antimony mg/kg Arsenic mg/kg Barium mg/kg Beryllium mg/kg Cadmium mg/kg Chromium * mg/kg Copper mg/kg Cyanide mg/kg Lead mg/kg Mercury mg/kg Nickel mg/kg Selenium mg/kg Silver mg/kg Thallium mg/kg Vanadium mg/kg Zinc mg/kg 2-Chlorophenol mg/kg 2,4-Dichlorophenol mg/kg Pentachlorophenol mg/kg 2,4,5-Trichlorophenol mg/kg 2,4,6-Trichlorophenol mg/kg 4,6-Dinitro-2-methylphenol mg/kg 4-Nitrophenol mg/kg 1' - 3' 10/24/2012 B‐107 (8‐10) Class II Objective 8.4 NA 6.2 56 NA < 0.56 NA NA NA 71 0.096 NA < 1.1 < 1.1 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA 8' - 10' 10/24/2012 B‐108 (8‐10) Class II Objective 8.2 20 130 NE NE NE NE NE 120 1420 NE NE 1.8 NE 44 NE NE 2.2 0.56 0.1 36 0.07 0.0031 0.23 NA 6.6 76 NA < 0.57 NA NA NA 18 < 0.022 NA < 1.1 < 1.1 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA 8' - 10' 10/24/2012 B‐109 (1‐3) Class II Objective 10.6 20 120 2100 1000000 4300 NE 330000 120 1420 40 76000 2.4 NE 38 NE 110000 3.1 0.69 0.1 64 0.07 0.0031 0.23 < 2.3 12 59 0.57 < 0.57 NA 23 0.34 23 0.028 34 < 1.1 < 1.1 < 1.1 21 47 < 0.21 < 0.21 < 0.042 < 0.21 < 0.21 < 0.42 < 0.42 Notes: Remediation Objectives from 35 Illinois Administrative Code Chapter 742: Tiered Approach to Corrective Action Objectives . mg/kg = milligrams per kilogram, generally equivalent to ppm NA = Not Applicable NE = Not Established * Hexavalent Chromium 1' - 3' 10/24/2012 B‐110 (1‐3) Class II Objective 8.9 NE NE NE NE NE NE NE NE NE NE NE NE NE NE NE NE NE NE NE NE NE NE NE NA 2.3 16 NA < 0.62 NA NA NA 23 0.07 NA < 1.2 < 1.2 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA 1' - 3' 10/24/2012 B‐111 (1‐3) Class II Objective 8.7 20 130 NE NE NE NE NE 120 3760 NE NE 1.3 NE 49 NE NE 1.5 0.48 0.1 26 0.07 0.0031 0.23 NA 8.7 120 NA < 0.56 NA NA NA 400 0.24 NA < 1.1 < 1.1 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA 1' - 3' 10/24/2012 B‐111 (8‐10) Class II Objective 8.4 20 130 NE NE NE NE NE 120 1420 NE NE 1.8 NE 44 NE NE 2.2 0.56 0.1 36 0.07 0.0031 0.23 NA 19 310 NA 3 < 0.58 NA NA 760 0.47 NA 1.6 1.3 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA 8' - 10' 10/24/2012 Class II Objective 8.1 20 130 NE NE NE NE NE 120 1420 NE NE 1.8 NE 44 NE NE 2.2 0.56 0.1 36 0.07 0.0031 0.23 NA 4.8 66 NA < 0.61 NA NA NA 14 < 0.022 NA 1.4 < 1.2 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA 20 120 2100 1000000 4300 NE 330000 120 1420 40 76000 2.4 NE 38 NE 110000 3.1 0.69 0.1 64 0.07 0.0031 0.23 Table 3 - Terracon Groundwater Analytical Results Proposed Skinner Park 1352 - 1358 W Monroe St, Chicago, Illinois Page 1 of 3 Sample Location/Identification Date Collected Volatile Organic Analytical Parameters 74-87-3 Chloromethane 74-83-9 Bromomethane 75-01-4 Vinyl Chloride 75-00-3 Chloroethane 75-09-2 Methylene Chloride 67-64-1 Acetone 75-15-0 Carbon Disulfide 75-35-4 1,1-Dichloroethene 75-34-3 1,1-Dichloroethane 156-59-2 cis-1,2-Dichloroethene 156-60-5 trans-1,2-Dichloroethene 67-66-3 Chloroform 107-06-2 1,2-Dichloroethane 78-93-3 2-Butanone 71-55-6 1,1,1-Trichloroethane 56-23-5 Carbon Tetrachloride 75-27-4 Bromodichloromethane 78-87-5 1,2-Dichloropropane 542-75-6 1,3-Dichloropropene (cis + trans) 79-01-6 Trichloroethene 124-48-1 Dibromochloromethane 79-00-5 1,1,2-Trichloroethane 71-43-2 Benzene 75-25-2 Bromoform 1634-04-4 Methyl Tertiary-Butyl Ether 108-10-1 4-Methyl-2-pentanone 591-78-6 2-Hexanone 127-18-4 Tetrachloroethene 108-88-3 Toluene 79-34-5 1,1,2,2-Tetrachloroethane 108-90-7 Chlorobenzene 100-41-4 Ethylbenzene 100-42-5 Styrene 1330-20-7 Xylenes (total) Units mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L MW‐101 MW‐105 MW‐112 10/31/2012 10/31/2012 10/31/2012 Tier 1 Groundwater Remediation Objectives <0.0010 <0.0010 <0.00050 <0.0010 <0.0050 <0.0050 <0.0050 <0.0010 <0.0010 <0.0010 <0.0010 <0.0010 <0.0010 <0.0050 <0.0010 <0.0010 <0.0010 <0.0010 <0.0010 <0.00050 <0.0010 <0.0010 <0.00050 <0.0010 <0.0010 <0.0050 <0.0050 <0.0010 <0.00050 <0.0010 <0.0010 <0.00050 <0.0010 <0.0010 <0.0010 <0.0010 <0.00050 <0.0010 <0.0050 <0.0050 <0.0050 <0.0010 <0.0010 <0.0010 <0.0010 <0.0010 <0.0010 <0.0050 <0.0010 <0.0010 <0.0010 <0.0010 <0.0010 <0.00050 <0.0010 <0.0010 <0.00050 <0.0010 <0.0010 <0.0050 <0.0050 <0.0010 <0.00050 <0.0010 <0.0010 <0.00050 <0.0010 <0.0010 <0.0010 <0.0010 <0.00050 <0.0010 <0.0050 <0.0050 <0.0050 <0.0010 <0.0010 <0.0010 <0.0010 <0.0010 <0.0010 <0.0050 <0.0010 <0.0010 <0.0010 <0.0010 <0.0010 <0.00050 <0.0010 <0.0010 <0.00050 <0.0010 <0.0010 <0.0050 <0.0050 <0.0010 <0.00050 <0.0010 <0.0010 <0.00050 <0.0010 <0.0010 Class II 0.14 0.049 0.01 14 0.05 6.3 3.5 0.035 3.5 0.2 0.5 0.001 0.025 4.2 1.0 0.025 0.0002 0.025 0.0025 0.025 0.14 0.05 0.025 0.001 0.07 0.56 0.28 0.025 2.5 0.42 0.5 1.0 0.5 10.0 Table 3 - Terracon Groundwater Analytical Results Proposed Skinner Park 1352 - 1358 W Monroe St, Chicago, Illinois Page 2 of 3 Sample Location/Identification Date Collected Semivolatile Organic Analytical Parameters 108-95-2 Phenol 111-44-4 bis(2-Chloroethyl) ether 95-57-8 2-Chlorophenol (pH 4.9-7.3) 95-57-8 2-Chlorophenol (pH 7.4-8.0) 95-50-1 1,2-Dichlorobenzene 541-73-1 1,3-Dichlorobenzene 106-46-7 1,4-Dichlorobenzene 95-48-7 2-Methylphenol 108-60-1 2,2'-oxybis (1-chloropropane) 106-44-5 4-Methylphenol 621-64-7 N-Nitroso-di-n-propylamine 67-72-1 Hexachloroethane 98-95-3 Nitrobenzene 78-59-1 Isophorone 88-75-5 2-Nitrophenol 105-67-9 2,4-Dimethylphenol 111-91-1 bis(2-Chloroethoxy) methane 120-83-2 2,4-Dichlorophenol 120-82-1 1,2,4-Trichlorobenzene 91-20-3 Naphthalene 106-47-8 4-Chloroaniline 87-68-3 Hexachlorobutadiene 59-50-7 4-Chloro-3-methylphenol 91-57-6 2-Methylnaphthalene 77-47-4 Hexachlorocyclopentadiene 88-06-2 2,4,6-Trichlorophenol (pH 4.9-6.8) 88-06-2 2,4,6-Trichlorophenol (pH 6.9-8.0) 95-95-4 2,4,5-Trichlorophenol (pH 4.9-7.8) 95-95-4 2,4,5-Trichlorophenol (pH 7.9-8.0) 91-58-7 2-Chloronaphthalene 88-74-4 2-Nitroaniline 131-11-3 Dimethylphthalate 208-96-8 Acenaphthylene 606-20-2 2,6-dinitrotoluene 99-09-2 3-Nitroanaline 83-32-9 Acenaphthene 51-28-5 2,4-Dinitrophenol 100-02-7 4-Nitrophenol 132-64-9 Dibenzofuran 121-14-2 2,4-Dinitrotoluene 84-66-2 Diethylphthalate 7005-72-3 4-Chlorophenyl-phenyl ether 86-73-7 Fluorene 100-01-6 4-Nitroaniline 534-52-1 4,6-Dinitro-2-methylphenol 86-30-6 N-nitrosodiphenylamine 101-55-3 4-Bromophenyl-phenyl ether 118-74-1 Hexachlorobenzene 87-86-5 Pentachlorophenol 85-01-8 Phenanthrene 120-12-7 Anthracene 86-74-8 Carbazole 84-74-2 Di-n-butylphthalate 206-44-0 Fluoranthene 129-00-0 Pyrene 85-68-7 Butylbenzylphthalate 91-94-1 3,3'-Dichlorobenzidine 56-55-3 Benzo(a)anthracene 218-01-9 Chrysene 117-81-7 bis(2-Ethylhexyl)phthalate 117-84-0 Di-n-octylphthalate 205-99-2 Benzo(b)fluoranthene 207-08-9 Benzo(k)fluoranthene 50-32-8 Benzo(a)pyrene 193-39-5 Indeno(1,2,3-c,d)pyrene 53-70-3 Dibenzo(a,h)anthracene 191-24-2 Benzo(g,h,i)perylene mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L MW‐101 MW‐105 MW‐112 10/31/2012 10/31/2012 10/31/2012 Tier 1 Groundwater Remediation Objectives NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA <0.0020 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA <0.0020 NA NA <0.0020 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA <0.0020 <0.0020 NA NA <0.0020 <0.0020 NA NA <0.00026 <0.0010 NA NA <0.00034 <0.00036 <0.00040 <0.00040 <0.00060 <0.0020 <0.010 <0.0040 <0.010 <0.010 <0.0040 <0.0040 <0.0040 <0.0040 <0.0040 <0.0040 <0.0010 <0.010 <0.0020 <0.0040 <0.020 <0.020 <0.0040 <0.020 <0.0040 <0.0020 <0.020 <0.010 <0.020 <0.0010 <0.040 <0.010 <0.010 <0.020 <0.020 <0.0040 <0.010 <0.0040 <0.0020 <0.0010 <0.020 <0.0020 <0.040 <0.040 <0.0040 <0.0020 <0.0040 <0.010 <0.0020 <0.020 <0.040 <0.0020 <0.010 <0.0010 <0.040 <0.0020 <0.0020 <0.010 <0.010 <0.0020 <0.0020 <0.0040 <0.010 <0.00026 <0.0010 <0.020 <0.020 <0.00034 <0.00036 <0.00040 <0.00040 <0.00060 <0.0020 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA <0.0020 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA <0.0020 NA NA <0.0020 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA <0.0020 <0.0020 NA NA <0.0020 <0.0020 NA NA 0.00019 <0.0010 NA NA 0.00018 0.00019 0.00019 <0.00040 <0.00060 <0.0020 Class II 0.1 0.01 0.175 0.035 1.5 0.0315 0.375 0.35 0.28 0.035 0.0018 0.035 0.0035 1.4 --0.14 --0.021 0.7 0.22 0.028 0.007 2.45 0.14 0.5 0.05 0.01 3.5 0.7 2.8 0.021 70 1.05 0.00031 0.0021 2.1 0.014 0.056 0.07 0.00002 5.6 --1.4 0.021 0.0007 0.016 --0.0003 0.005 1.05 10.5 --3.5 1.4 1.05 7 0.1 0.00065 0.0075 0.06 0.7 0.0009 0.00085 0.002 0.00215 0.0015 1.05 Table 3 - Terracon Groundwater Analytical Results Proposed Skinner Park 1352 - 1358 W Monroe St, Chicago, Illinois Page 3 of 3 Sample Location/Identification Date Collected MW‐101 MW‐105 MW‐112 10/31/2012 10/31/2012 10/31/2012 Tier 1 Groundwater Remediation Objectives Pesticide and Aroclors Organic Analytical Parameters 319-84-6 alpha-BHC 319-85-7 beta-BHC 319-86-8 delta-BHC 58-89-9 gamma-BHC 76-44-8 Heptachlor 309-00-2 Aldrin 1024-57-3 Heptachlor epoxide 959-98-8 Endosulfan I 60-57-1 Dieldrin 72-55-9 4,4'-DDE 72-20-8 Endrin 33213-65-9 Endosulfan II 72-54-8 4,4'-DDD 1031-07-8 Endosulfan sulfate 50-29-3 4,4'-DDT 72-43-5 Methoxychlor 53494-70-5 Endrin ketone 7421-93-4 Endrin aldehyde 57-74-9 Chlordane 8001-35-2 Toxaphene 12674-11-2 Aroclor - 1016 11104-28-2 Aroclor - 1221 11141-16-5 Aroclor - 1232 53469-21-9 Aroclor - 1242 12672-29-6 Aroclor - 1248 11097-69-1 Aroclor - 1254 11096-82-5 Aroclor - 1260 1336-36-3 Polychlorinated Biphenyls (PCBs) mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L <0.000048 <0.000048 <0.000048 <0.000048 <0.000048 <0.000048 <0.000048 <0.000048 <0.000048 <0.000048 <0.000048 <0.000048 <0.000048 <0.000048 <0.000048 <0.000096 <0.000048 <0.000048 <0.000096 <0.00048 <0.00048 <0.00048 <0.00048 <0.00048 <0.00048 <0.00048 <0.00048 <0.00048 <0.000048 <0.000048 <0.000048 <0.000048 <0.000048 <0.000048 <0.000048 <0.000048 <0.000048 <0.000048 <0.000048 <0.000048 <0.000048 <0.000048 <0.000048 <0.000096 <0.000048 <0.000048 <0.000096 <0.00048 <0.00048 <0.00048 <0.00048 <0.00048 <0.00048 <0.00048 <0.00048 <0.00048 <0.000047 <0.000047 <0.000047 <0.000047 <0.000047 <0.000047 <0.000047 <0.000047 <0.000047 <0.000047 <0.000047 <0.000047 <0.000047 <0.000047 <0.000047 <0.000093 <0.000047 <0.000047 <0.000093 <0.00047 <0.00047 <0.00047 <0.00047 <0.00047 <0.00047 <0.00047 <0.00047 <0.00047 Class II 0.00055 ----0.001 0.002 0.07 0.001 0.21 0.045 0.05 0.01 0.21 0.07 0.21 0.03 0.2 0.01 0.01 0.01 0.015 --------------0.0025 Herbicide Analytical Parameters 1918-00-9 Dicamba 94-75-7 2,4-D 93-72-1 Silvex (2,4,5-TP) 93-76-5 2,4,5-Trichlorophenoxyacetic Acid 1918-02-1 Picloram mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L NA NA NA NA NA <0.00093 <0.00093 <0.00093 <0.00093 <0.00047 NA NA NA NA NA Class II 0.21 0.35 0.25 1.4 5.0 NA NA <0.010 0.20 NA 0.0009 NA <0.010 NA NA NA 0.006 NA NA <0.00020 NA NA <0.010 <0.0050 NA NA NA NA Class II 5 0.024 0.2 2 0.5 0.05 --1 1 0.65 5 0.1 --10 0.01 2 --0.05 ----0.02 0.1 10 Inorganic Analytical Parameters 7429-90-5 Aluminum 7440-36-0 Antimony 7440-38-2 Arsenic 7440-39-3 Barium 7440-41-7 Beryllium 7440-43-9 Cadmium 7440-70-2 Calcium 7440-47-3 Chromium 7440-48-4 Cobalt 7440-50-8 Copper 7439-89-6 Iron 7439-92-1 Lead 7439-95-4 Magnesium 7439-96-5 Manganese 7439-97-6 Mercury 7440-02-0 Nickel 7440-09-7 Potassium 7782-49-2 Selenium 7440-22-4 Silver 7440-23-5 Sodium 7440-28-0 Thallium 7440-62-2 Vanadium 7440-66-6 Zinc mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L mg/L NA NA <0.010 0.18 NA 0.0012 NA <0.010 NA NA NA 0.0028 NA NA <0.00020 NA NA <0.010 <0.0050 NA NA NA NA <0.10 0.004 0.0016 0.19 <0.0010 <0.00050 290.00 <0.0050 0.0012 0.0025 <0.10 <0.00050 82.00 0.82 <0.00020 0.0035 20.00 <0.0025 <0.00050 27.00 <0.0020 0.0011 <0.020 1 2 3 4 ANALYTICAL REPORT TestAmerica Laboratories, Inc. TestAmerica Chicago 2417 Bond Street University Park, IL 60484 Tel: (708)534-5200 TestAmerica Job ID: 500-51668-1 Client Project/Site: Skinner Park - (A2127030) For: Terracon Consulting Eng & Scientists 650 West Lake Street Suite 420 Chicago, Illinois 60661 Attn: Richard M O'Brien 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 Authorized for release by: 10/30/2012 3:53:48 PM Jim Knapp Customer Service Manager [email protected] The test results in this report meet all 2003 NELAC and 2009 TNI requirements for accredited parameters, exceptions are noted in this report. This report may not be reproduced except in full, and with written approval from the laboratory. For questions please contact the Project Manager at the e-mail address or telephone number listed on this page. This report has been electronically signed and authorized by the signatory. Electronic signature is intended to be the legally binding equivalent of a traditionally handwritten signature. Results relate only to the items tested and the sample(s) as received by the laboratory. Client: Terracon Consulting Eng & Scientists Project/Site: Skinner Park - (A2127030) TestAmerica Job ID: 500-51668-1 2 Table of Contents Cover Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table of Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Case Narrative . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Detection Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Method Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Sample Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Client Sample Results . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Definitions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . QC Association . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Surrogate Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . QC Sample Results . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Chronicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Certification Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Chain of Custody . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Receipt Checklists . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 3 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 9 10 14 16 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 25 26 28 29 12 13 14 15 Page 2 of 30 TestAmerica Chicago 10/30/2012 Case Narrative Client: Terracon Consulting Eng & Scientists Project/Site: Skinner Park - (A2127030) 1 TestAmerica Job ID: 500-51668-1 2 3 Job ID: 500-51668-1 Laboratory: TestAmerica Chicago 4 Narrative 5 Job Narrative 500-51668-1 6 Comments No additional comments. 7 Receipt The sample was received on 10/24/2012 3:42 PM; the sample arrived in good condition, properly preserved and, where required, on ice. The temperature of the cooler at receipt was 4.4º C. 8 9 GC/MS VOA No analytical or quality issues were noted. 10 GC/MS Semi VOA Method(s) 8270C: The matrix spike (MS) recovery for Pyridine and for two surrogates in sample -1 was above the control limits. The associated laboratory control sample (LCS) recovery met acceptance criteria. No corrective action was required. B-100-WC (500-51668-1) 11 12 No other analytical or quality issues were noted. 13 GC Semi VOA No analytical or quality issues were noted. 14 Metals No analytical or quality issues were noted. 15 General Chemistry No analytical or quality issues were noted. Organic Prep No analytical or quality issues were noted. Page 3 of 30 TestAmerica Chicago 10/30/2012 Detection Summary 1 Client: Terracon Consulting Eng & Scientists Project/Site: Skinner Park - (A2127030) TestAmerica Job ID: 500-51668-1 2 Client Sample ID: B-100-WC Analyte Flashpoint Analyte Lab Sample ID: 500-51668-1 Result Qualifier NONE >176 Result Qualifier pH 7.95 Paint Filter pass NONE Unit Degrees F RL 0.200 MDL Unit 0.200 SU mL/100g Dil Fac D Method 1 1010 Dil Fac D Method Prep Type Total/NA Prep Type 1 9045C Total/NA 1 9095A Total/NA 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 Page 4 of 30 TestAmerica Chicago 10/30/2012 Method Summary Client: Terracon Consulting Eng & Scientists Project/Site: Skinner Park - (A2127030) 1 TestAmerica Job ID: 500-51668-1 2 Method Method Description Protocol Laboratory 8260B TCLP Volatiles SW846 TAL CHI 8270C TCLP Semivolatiles SW846 TAL CHI 8082 Polychlorinated Biphenyls (PCBs) by Gas Chromatography SW846 TAL CHI 6010B TCLP Metals (ICP) SW846 TAL CHI 7470A TCLP Mercury SW846 TAL CHI 1010 Ignitability, Pensky-Martens Closed-Cup Method SW846 TAL CHI 7.3.4 Reactive Sulfide EPA TAL CHI 9014 Reactive Cyanide SW846 TAL CHI 9023 Organic Halides, Extractable (EOX) SW846 TAL NSH 9045C pH SW846 TAL CHI 9066 Phenolics, Total Recoverable SW846 TAL CHI 9095A Paint Filter SW846 TAL CHI Moisture Percent Moisture EPA TAL CHI 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 Protocol References: EPA = US Environmental Protection Agency 11 SW846 = "Test Methods For Evaluating Solid Waste, Physical/Chemical Methods", Third Edition, November 1986 And Its Updates. 12 Laboratory References: TAL CHI = TestAmerica Chicago, 2417 Bond Street, University Park, IL 60484, TEL (708)534-5200 13 TAL NSH = TestAmerica Nashville, 2960 Foster Creighton Drive, Nashville, TN 37204, TEL (615)726-0177 14 15 Page 5 of 30 TestAmerica Chicago 10/30/2012 Sample Summary 1 Client: Terracon Consulting Eng & Scientists Project/Site: Skinner Park - (A2127030) TestAmerica Job ID: 500-51668-1 2 Lab Sample ID Client Sample ID Matrix 500-51668-1 B-100-WC Solid Collected Received 10/24/12 14:00 10/24/12 15:42 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 Page 6 of 30 TestAmerica Chicago 10/30/2012 Client Sample Results 1 Client: Terracon Consulting Eng & Scientists Project/Site: Skinner Park - (A2127030) TestAmerica Job ID: 500-51668-1 2 Client Sample ID: B-100-WC Lab Sample ID: 500-51668-1 Date Collected: 10/24/12 14:00 Date Received: 10/24/12 15:42 Matrix: Solid 4 Method: 8260B - TCLP Volatiles - TCLP Analyte Result Qualifier Benzene <0.020 0.020 0.010 mg/L 10/29/12 15:07 20 Carbon tetrachloride <0.020 0.020 0.010 mg/L 10/29/12 15:07 20 Chlorobenzene <0.020 0.020 0.010 mg/L 10/29/12 15:07 20 Chloroform <0.020 0.020 0.010 mg/L 10/29/12 15:07 20 1,2-Dichloroethane <0.020 0.020 0.010 mg/L 10/29/12 15:07 20 1,1-Dichloroethene <0.020 0.020 0.010 mg/L 10/29/12 15:07 20 Methyl Ethyl Ketone <0.10 0.10 0.050 mg/L 10/29/12 15:07 20 Tetrachloroethene <0.020 0.020 0.010 mg/L 10/29/12 15:07 20 Trichloroethene <0.020 0.020 0.010 mg/L 10/29/12 15:07 20 Vinyl chloride <0.020 0.020 0.010 mg/L 10/29/12 15:07 20 Surrogate %Recovery Qualifier RL MDL Unit D Limits Prepared Prepared Analyzed Analyzed Dil Fac Dil Fac 1,2-Dichloroethane-d4 (Surr) 109 75 - 131 10/29/12 15:07 20 Toluene-d8 (Surr) 100 80 - 120 10/29/12 15:07 20 97 79 - 120 10/29/12 15:07 20 111 74 - 123 10/29/12 15:07 20 4-Bromofluorobenzene (Surr) Dibromofluoromethane Prepared Analyzed 2-Methylphenol <0.10 0.10 mg/L 10/29/12 08:02 10/30/12 14:31 1 1,4-Dichlorobenzene <0.10 0.10 mg/L 10/29/12 08:02 10/30/12 14:31 1 2,4-Dinitrotoluene <0.10 0.10 mg/L 10/29/12 08:02 10/30/12 14:31 1 Hexachlorobenzene <0.10 0.10 mg/L 10/29/12 08:02 10/30/12 14:31 1 Hexachloro-1,3-butadiene <0.10 0.10 mg/L 10/29/12 08:02 10/30/12 14:31 1 Hexachloroethane <0.10 0.10 mg/L 10/29/12 08:02 10/30/12 14:31 1 Nitrobenzene <0.10 0.10 mg/L 10/29/12 08:02 10/30/12 14:31 1 Pentachlorophenol <0.50 0.50 mg/L 10/29/12 08:02 10/30/12 14:31 1 Pyridine <0.20 0.20 mg/L 10/29/12 08:02 10/30/12 14:31 1 2,4,5-Trichlorophenol <0.50 0.50 mg/L 10/29/12 08:02 10/30/12 14:31 1 2,4,6-Trichlorophenol <0.10 0.10 mg/L 10/29/12 08:02 10/30/12 14:31 1 3 & 4 Methylphenol <0.10 0.10 mg/L 10/29/12 08:02 10/30/12 14:31 1 Surrogate Result Qualifier %Recovery Qualifier RL MDL Unit D Dil Fac Limits Prepared Analyzed 2-Fluorophenol 45 20 - 100 10/29/12 08:02 10/30/12 14:31 1 Phenol-d5 42 20 - 100 10/29/12 08:02 10/30/12 14:31 1 Nitrobenzene-d5 101 41 - 110 10/29/12 08:02 10/30/12 14:31 1 2-Fluorobiphenyl 106 48 - 110 10/29/12 08:02 10/30/12 14:31 1 2,4,6-Tribromophenol 117 50 - 129 10/29/12 08:02 10/30/12 14:31 1 Terphenyl-d14 102 44 - 132 10/29/12 08:02 10/30/12 14:31 1 Dil Fac Method: 8082 - Polychlorinated Biphenyls (PCBs) by Gas Chromatography Analyte Result Qualifier D Prepared Analyzed PCB-1016 <0.020 0.020 mg/Kg ☼ 10/25/12 07:18 10/29/12 19:40 1 PCB-1221 <0.020 0.020 mg/Kg ☼ 10/25/12 07:18 10/29/12 19:40 1 PCB-1232 <0.020 0.020 mg/Kg ☼ 10/25/12 07:18 10/29/12 19:40 1 PCB-1242 <0.020 0.020 mg/Kg ☼ 10/25/12 07:18 10/29/12 19:40 1 PCB-1248 <0.020 0.020 mg/Kg ☼ 10/25/12 07:18 10/29/12 19:40 1 PCB-1254 <0.020 0.020 mg/Kg ☼ 10/25/12 07:18 10/29/12 19:40 1 PCB-1260 <0.020 0.020 mg/Kg ☼ 10/25/12 07:18 10/29/12 19:40 1 Surrogate Tetrachloro-m-xylene 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 Method: 8270C - TCLP Semivolatiles - TCLP Analyte 3 %Recovery Qualifier 75 RL MDL Unit Limits Prepared Analyzed 50 - 116 10/25/12 07:18 10/29/12 19:40 Page 7 of 30 Dil Fac Dil Fac 1 TestAmerica Chicago 10/30/2012 14 15 Client Sample Results 1 Client: Terracon Consulting Eng & Scientists Project/Site: Skinner Park - (A2127030) TestAmerica Job ID: 500-51668-1 2 Client Sample ID: B-100-WC Lab Sample ID: 500-51668-1 Date Collected: 10/24/12 14:00 Date Received: 10/24/12 15:42 Matrix: Solid Percent Solids: 82.8 Method: 8082 - Polychlorinated Biphenyls (PCBs) by Gas Chromatography (Continued) Surrogate %Recovery Qualifier DCB Decachlorobiphenyl 96 Limits Prepared Analyzed 48 - 142 10/25/12 07:18 10/29/12 19:40 Dil Fac 1 Method: 6010B - TCLP Metals (ICP) - TCLP Analyte Result Qualifier Arsenic <0.050 Barium RL 0.050 Prepared Analyzed 0.010 mg/L MDL Unit D 10/29/12 08:30 10/29/12 20:03 Dil Fac 1 <0.50 0.50 0.010 mg/L 10/29/12 08:30 10/29/12 20:03 1 Cadmium <0.0050 0.0050 0.0020 mg/L 10/29/12 08:30 10/29/12 20:03 1 Chromium <0.025 0.025 0.010 mg/L 10/29/12 08:30 10/29/12 20:03 1 Lead <0.050 0.050 0.0050 mg/L 10/29/12 08:30 10/29/12 20:03 1 Selenium <0.050 0.050 0.010 mg/L 10/29/12 08:30 10/29/12 20:03 1 Silver <0.025 0.025 0.0050 mg/L 10/29/12 08:30 10/29/12 20:03 1 Prepared Analyzed 10/29/12 16:00 10/30/12 12:35 Prepared Analyzed Mercury Result Qualifier <0.00020 RL 0.00020 MDL Unit D mg/L Dil Fac 1 General Chemistry Analyte Flashpoint Analyte Sulfide, Reactive Result Qualifier NONE D Degrees F >176 Result Qualifier NONE Unit RL MDL Unit Dil Fac 10/27/12 14:00 D Prepared Analyzed 1 Dil Fac <48 48 mg/Kg 10/30/12 12:07 10/30/12 12:42 1 <0.48 0.48 0.12 mg/Kg 10/25/12 17:00 10/25/12 20:50 1 <60 60 42 mg/Kg 10/25/12 12:52 10/27/12 14:38 1 7.95 0.200 10/29/12 09:30 1 Phenolics, Total Recoverable <0.53 0.53 10/30/12 08:45 1 Paint Filter pass 10/27/12 15:33 1 Cyanide, Reactive Halogens, Extractable Organic pH 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 Method: 7470A - TCLP Mercury - TCLP Analyte 3 0.200 SU mg/Kg mL/100g Page 8 of 30 ☼ ☼ 10/29/12 10:15 TestAmerica Chicago 10/30/2012 12 13 14 15 Definitions/Glossary Client: Terracon Consulting Eng & Scientists Project/Site: Skinner Park - (A2127030) 1 TestAmerica Job ID: 500-51668-1 2 3 Qualifiers GC/MS Semi VOA Qualifier Qualifier Description X Surrogate is outside control limits E Result exceeded calibration range. F MS or MSD exceeds the control limits 4 5 6 General Chemistry Qualifier Qualifier Description J Result is less than the RL but greater than or equal to the MDL and the concentration is an approximate value. 7 8 Glossary Abbreviation These commonly used abbreviations may or may not be present in this report. ☼ Listed under the "D" column to designate that the result is reported on a dry weight basis %R Percent Recovery CNF Contains no Free Liquid DL, RA, RE, IN Indicates a Dilution, Reanalysis, Re-extraction, or additional Initial metals/anion analysis of the sample EDL Estimated Detection Limit EPA United States Environmental Protection Agency MDL Method Detection Limit ML Minimum Level (Dioxin) ND Not detected at the reporting limit (or MDL or EDL if shown) PQL Practical Quantitation Limit QC Quality Control RL Reporting Limit RPD Relative Percent Difference, a measure of the relative difference between two points TEF Toxicity Equivalent Factor (Dioxin) TEQ Toxicity Equivalent Quotient (Dioxin) 9 10 11 12 13 14 Page 9 of 30 15 TestAmerica Chicago 10/30/2012 QC Association Summary 1 Client: Terracon Consulting Eng & Scientists Project/Site: Skinner Park - (A2127030) TestAmerica Job ID: 500-51668-1 2 3 GC/MS VOA Leach Batch: 167486 4 Lab Sample ID Client Sample ID Prep Type Matrix Method 500-51668-1 B-100-WC TCLP Solid 1311 LB 500-167486/1-A LB Method Blank TCLP Solid 1311 Prep Batch 5 6 Analysis Batch: 167637 Lab Sample ID Client Sample ID Prep Type Matrix Method 500-51668-1 B-100-WC TCLP Solid 8260B LCS 500-167637/4 Lab Control Sample Total/NA Solid 8260B MB 500-167637/6 Method Blank Total/NA Solid 8260B Lab Sample ID Client Sample ID Prep Type Matrix Method LB 500-167486/1-A LB Method Blank TCLP Solid 8260B LCS 500-167704/5 Lab Control Sample Total/NA Solid 8260B MB 500-167704/7 Method Blank Total/NA Solid 8260B Prep Batch 167486 7 8 9 Analysis Batch: 167704 Prep Batch 167486 10 11 12 GC/MS Semi VOA Leach Batch: 167581 13 Lab Sample ID Client Sample ID Prep Type Matrix Method Prep Batch 500-51668-1 B-100-WC TCLP Solid 1311 500-51668-1 MS B-100-WC TCLP Solid 1311 LB 500-167581/1-B LB Method Blank TCLP Solid 1311 Lab Sample ID Client Sample ID Prep Type Matrix Method 500-51668-1 B-100-WC TCLP Solid 3510C 167581 500-51668-1 MS B-100-WC TCLP Solid 3510C 167581 LB 500-167581/1-B LB Method Blank TCLP Solid 3510C 167581 LCS 500-167646/2-A Lab Control Sample Total/NA Solid 3510C MB 500-167646/1-A Method Blank Total/NA Solid 3510C Lab Sample ID Client Sample ID Prep Type Matrix Method LB 500-167581/1-B LB Method Blank TCLP Solid 8270C 167646 LCS 500-167646/2-A Lab Control Sample Total/NA Solid 8270C 167646 MB 500-167646/1-A Method Blank Total/NA Solid 8270C 167646 Lab Sample ID Client Sample ID Prep Type Matrix Method 500-51668-1 B-100-WC TCLP Solid 8270C 167646 500-51668-1 MS B-100-WC TCLP Solid 8270C 167646 Lab Sample ID Client Sample ID Prep Type Matrix Method 500-51668-1 B-100-WC Total/NA Solid 3541 LCS 500-167228/3-A Lab Control Sample Total/NA Solid 3541 MB 500-167228/1-A Method Blank Total/NA Solid 3541 14 15 Prep Batch: 167646 Prep Batch Analysis Batch: 167690 Prep Batch Analysis Batch: 167798 Prep Batch GC Semi VOA Prep Batch: 167228 Page 10 of 30 Prep Batch TestAmerica Chicago 10/30/2012 QC Association Summary 1 Client: Terracon Consulting Eng & Scientists Project/Site: Skinner Park - (A2127030) TestAmerica Job ID: 500-51668-1 2 3 GC Semi VOA (Continued) Analysis Batch: 167675 4 Lab Sample ID Client Sample ID Prep Type Matrix Method Prep Batch 500-51668-1 B-100-WC Total/NA Solid 8082 167228 LCS 500-167228/3-A Lab Control Sample Total/NA Solid 8082 167228 MB 500-167228/1-A Method Blank Total/NA Solid 8082 167228 Metals 5 6 7 Leach Batch: 167581 Lab Sample ID Client Sample ID Prep Type Matrix Method Prep Batch 500-51668-1 B-100-WC TCLP Solid 1311 LB 500-167581/1-D LB Method Blank TCLP Solid 1311 LB 500-167581/1-E LB Method Blank TCLP Solid 1311 Lab Sample ID Client Sample ID Prep Type Matrix Method 500-51668-1 B-100-WC TCLP Solid 7470A 167581 LB 500-167581/1-D LB Method Blank TCLP Solid 7470A 167581 LCS 500-167681/8-A Lab Control Sample Total/NA Solid 7470A LCSD 500-167681/10-A Lab Control Sample Dup Total/NA Solid 7470A MB 500-167681/7-A Method Blank Total/NA Solid 7470A 8 9 10 Prep Batch: 167681 Prep Batch 11 12 13 14 Prep Batch: 167682 Lab Sample ID Client Sample ID Prep Type Matrix Method 500-51668-1 B-100-WC TCLP Solid 3010A Prep Batch 167581 LB 500-167581/1-E LB Method Blank TCLP Solid 3010A 167581 LCS 500-167682/2-A Lab Control Sample Total/NA Solid 3010A Lab Sample ID Client Sample ID Prep Type Matrix Method 500-51668-1 B-100-WC TCLP Solid 6010B 167682 LB 500-167581/1-E LB Method Blank TCLP Solid 6010B 167682 LCS 500-167682/2-A Lab Control Sample Total/NA Solid 6010B 167682 Lab Sample ID Client Sample ID Prep Type Matrix Method 500-51668-1 B-100-WC TCLP Solid 7470A 167681 LB 500-167581/1-D LB Method Blank TCLP Solid 7470A 167681 LCS 500-167681/8-A Lab Control Sample Total/NA Solid 7470A 167681 LCSD 500-167681/10-A Lab Control Sample Dup Total/NA Solid 7470A 167681 MB 500-167681/7-A Method Blank Total/NA Solid 7470A 167681 Lab Sample ID Client Sample ID Prep Type Matrix Method 500-51668-1 B-100-WC Total/NA Solid 9023 500-51668-1 MS B-100-WC Total/NA Solid 9023 500-51668-1 MSD B-100-WC Total/NA Solid 9023 LCS 490-30924/1-A Lab Control Sample Total/NA Solid 9023 MB 490-30924/2-A Method Blank Total/NA Solid 9023 Analysis Batch: 167791 Prep Batch Analysis Batch: 167850 Prep Batch General Chemistry Prep Batch: 30924 Page 11 of 30 Prep Batch TestAmerica Chicago 10/30/2012 15 QC Association Summary 1 Client: Terracon Consulting Eng & Scientists Project/Site: Skinner Park - (A2127030) TestAmerica Job ID: 500-51668-1 2 3 General Chemistry (Continued) Analysis Batch: 31571 4 Lab Sample ID Client Sample ID Prep Type Matrix Method Prep Batch 500-51668-1 B-100-WC Total/NA Solid 9023 30924 500-51668-1 MS B-100-WC Total/NA Solid 9023 30924 500-51668-1 MSD B-100-WC Total/NA Solid 9023 30924 LCS 490-30924/1-A Lab Control Sample Total/NA Solid 9023 30924 MB 490-30924/2-A Method Blank Total/NA Solid 9023 30924 Lab Sample ID Client Sample ID Prep Type Matrix Method 500-51668-1 B-100-WC Total/NA Solid 9010B LCS 500-167307/2-A Lab Control Sample Total/NA Solid 9010B MB 500-167307/1-A Method Blank Total/NA Solid 9010B Lab Sample ID Client Sample ID Prep Type Matrix Method 500-51668-1 B-100-WC Total/NA Solid Moisture 500-51668-1 DU B-100-WC Total/NA Solid Moisture Lab Sample ID Client Sample ID Prep Type Matrix Method 500-51668-1 B-100-WC Total/NA Solid 9014 167307 LCS 500-167307/2-A Lab Control Sample Total/NA Solid 9014 167307 MB 500-167307/1-A Method Blank Total/NA Solid 9014 167307 Lab Sample ID Client Sample ID Prep Type Matrix Method 500-51668-1 B-100-WC Total/NA Solid 9095A Lab Sample ID Client Sample ID Prep Type Matrix Method 500-51668-1 B-100-WC Total/NA Solid 1010 Lab Sample ID Client Sample ID Prep Type Matrix Method 500-51668-1 B-100-WC Total/NA Solid Distill/Phenol 500-51668-1 MS B-100-WC Total/NA Solid Distill/Phenol 500-51668-1 MSD B-100-WC Total/NA Solid Distill/Phenol LCS 500-167659/15-A Lab Control Sample Total/NA Solid Distill/Phenol MB 500-167659/14-A Method Blank Total/NA Solid Distill/Phenol Lab Sample ID Client Sample ID Prep Type Matrix Method 500-51668-1 B-100-WC Total/NA Solid 9045C 500-51668-1 DU B-100-WC Total/NA Solid 9045C Lab Sample ID Client Sample ID Prep Type Matrix Method 500-51668-1 B-100-WC Total/NA Solid 9066 167659 500-51668-1 MS B-100-WC Total/NA Solid 9066 167659 500-51668-1 MSD B-100-WC Total/NA Solid 9066 167659 LCS 500-167659/15-A Lab Control Sample Total/NA Solid 9066 167659 MB 500-167659/14-A Method Blank Total/NA Solid 9066 167659 5 6 7 Prep Batch: 167307 Prep Batch 9 10 Analysis Batch: 167392 Prep Batch 11 12 Analysis Batch: 167433 Prep Batch Analysis Batch: 167560 Prep Batch Analysis Batch: 167562 Prep Batch Prep Batch: 167659 Prep Batch Analysis Batch: 167711 Prep Batch Analysis Batch: 167811 Page 12 of 30 8 Prep Batch TestAmerica Chicago 10/30/2012 13 14 15 QC Association Summary 1 Client: Terracon Consulting Eng & Scientists Project/Site: Skinner Park - (A2127030) TestAmerica Job ID: 500-51668-1 2 3 General Chemistry (Continued) Prep Batch: 167833 4 Lab Sample ID Client Sample ID Prep Type Matrix Method Prep Batch 500-51668-1 B-100-WC Total/NA Solid 7.3.4 500-51668-1 MS B-100-WC Total/NA Solid 7.3.4 500-51668-1 MSD B-100-WC Total/NA Solid 7.3.4 LCS 500-167833/2-A Lab Control Sample Total/NA Solid 7.3.4 MB 500-167833/1-A Method Blank Total/NA Solid 7.3.4 Lab Sample ID Client Sample ID Prep Type Matrix Method 500-51668-1 B-100-WC Total/NA Solid 7.3.4 167833 500-51668-1 MS B-100-WC Total/NA Solid 7.3.4 167833 500-51668-1 MSD B-100-WC Total/NA Solid 7.3.4 167833 LCS 500-167833/2-A Lab Control Sample Total/NA Solid 7.3.4 167833 MB 500-167833/1-A Method Blank Total/NA Solid 7.3.4 167833 5 6 7 Analysis Batch: 167852 Prep Batch 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 Page 13 of 30 TestAmerica Chicago 10/30/2012 Surrogate Summary 1 Client: Terracon Consulting Eng & Scientists Project/Site: Skinner Park - (A2127030) TestAmerica Job ID: 500-51668-1 2 3 Method: 8260B - TCLP Volatiles Matrix: Solid Prep Type: Total/NA 4 Percent Surrogate Recovery (Acceptance Limits) 12DCE TOL BFB DBFM (75-131) (80-120) (79-120) (74-123) Lab Control Sample 99 99 98 97 Lab Control Sample 99 99 98 101 MB 500-167637/6 Method Blank 103 98 96 100 MB 500-167704/7 Method Blank 99 98 93 101 Lab Sample ID Client Sample ID LCS 500-167637/4 LCS 500-167704/5 5 6 7 Surrogate Legend 8 12DCE = 1,2-Dichloroethane-d4 (Surr) TOL = Toluene-d8 (Surr) 9 BFB = 4-Bromofluorobenzene (Surr) DBFM = Dibromofluoromethane 10 Method: 8260B - TCLP Volatiles Matrix: Solid Prep Type: TCLP 12 Percent Surrogate Recovery (Acceptance Limits) 12DCE TOL BFB DBFM Lab Sample ID Client Sample ID (75-131) (80-120) (79-120) (74-123) 500-51668-1 B-100-WC 109 100 97 111 LB 500-167486/1-A LB Method Blank 100 98 93 106 11 13 14 Surrogate Legend 15 12DCE = 1,2-Dichloroethane-d4 (Surr) TOL = Toluene-d8 (Surr) BFB = 4-Bromofluorobenzene (Surr) DBFM = Dibromofluoromethane Method: 8270C - TCLP Semivolatiles Matrix: Solid Prep Type: Total/NA Percent Surrogate Recovery (Acceptance Limits) 2FP PHL NBZ FBP TBP TPH (20-100) (20-100) (41-110) (48-110) (50-129) (44-132) Lab Sample ID Client Sample ID LCS 500-167646/2-A Lab Control Sample 58 36 88 94 108 104 MB 500-167646/1-A Method Blank 60 36 93 89 103 101 Surrogate Legend 2FP = 2-Fluorophenol PHL = Phenol-d5 NBZ = Nitrobenzene-d5 FBP = 2-Fluorobiphenyl TBP = 2,4,6-Tribromophenol TPH = Terphenyl-d14 Method: 8270C - TCLP Semivolatiles Matrix: Solid Prep Type: TCLP Percent Surrogate Recovery (Acceptance Limits) 2FP PHL NBZ FBP TBP TPH (20-100) (20-100) (41-110) (48-110) (50-129) (44-132) Lab Sample ID Client Sample ID 500-51668-1 B-100-WC 45 42 101 106 117 102 500-51668-1 MS B-100-WC 60 44 101 113 X 130 X 109 LB 500-167581/1-B LB Method Blank 57 34 96 96 113 97 Page 14 of 30 TestAmerica Chicago 10/30/2012 Surrogate Summary Client: Terracon Consulting Eng & Scientists Project/Site: Skinner Park - (A2127030) 1 TestAmerica Job ID: 500-51668-1 2 3 Surrogate Legend 2FP = 2-Fluorophenol 4 PHL = Phenol-d5 NBZ = Nitrobenzene-d5 5 FBP = 2-Fluorobiphenyl TBP = 2,4,6-Tribromophenol 6 TPH = Terphenyl-d14 7 Method: 8082 - Polychlorinated Biphenyls (PCBs) by Gas Chromatography Matrix: Solid Prep Type: Total/NA 8 Percent Surrogate Recovery (Acceptance Limits) TCX1 DCB1 (50-116) (48-142) Lab Sample ID Client Sample ID 500-51668-1 B-100-WC 75 96 LCS 500-167228/3-A Lab Control Sample 69 106 MB 500-167228/1-A Method Blank 102 107 9 10 11 Surrogate Legend TCX = Tetrachloro-m-xylene 12 DCB = DCB Decachlorobiphenyl 13 14 15 Page 15 of 30 TestAmerica Chicago 10/30/2012 QC Sample Results 1 Client: Terracon Consulting Eng & Scientists Project/Site: Skinner Park - (A2127030) TestAmerica Job ID: 500-51668-1 2 3 Method: 8260B - TCLP Volatiles Lab Sample ID: MB 500-167637/6 Matrix: Solid Analysis Batch: 167637 Client Sample ID: Method Blank Prep Type: Total/NA 5 MB MB Analyte Result Qualifier RL MDL Unit D Prepared Analyzed Dil Fac Benzene <0.0010 0.0010 0.00050 mg/L 10/29/12 09:49 1 Carbon tetrachloride <0.0010 0.0010 0.00050 mg/L 10/29/12 09:49 1 Chlorobenzene <0.0010 0.0010 0.00050 mg/L 10/29/12 09:49 1 Chloroform <0.0010 0.0010 0.00050 mg/L 10/29/12 09:49 1 1,2-Dichloroethane <0.0010 0.0010 0.00050 mg/L 10/29/12 09:49 1 1,1-Dichloroethene <0.0010 0.0010 0.00050 mg/L 10/29/12 09:49 1 Methyl Ethyl Ketone <0.0050 0.0050 0.0025 mg/L 10/29/12 09:49 1 Tetrachloroethene <0.0010 0.0010 0.00050 mg/L 10/29/12 09:49 1 Trichloroethene <0.0010 0.0010 0.00050 mg/L 10/29/12 09:49 1 Vinyl chloride <0.0010 0.0010 0.00050 mg/L 10/29/12 09:49 1 %Recovery Qualifier 1,2-Dichloroethane-d4 (Surr) Toluene-d8 (Surr) 4-Bromofluorobenzene (Surr) Dibromofluoromethane Limits Prepared Analyzed Dil Fac 103 75 - 131 10/29/12 09:49 1 98 80 - 120 10/29/12 09:49 1 96 79 - 120 10/29/12 09:49 1 100 74 - 123 10/29/12 09:49 1 Lab Sample ID: LCS 500-167637/4 Matrix: Solid Analysis Batch: 167637 Client Sample ID: Lab Control Sample Prep Type: Total/NA Spike LCS LCS %Rec. Analyte Added Result Qualifier Unit Benzene 0.0500 0.0458 mg/L 92 74 - 115 Carbon tetrachloride 0.0500 0.0476 mg/L 95 72 - 124 Chlorobenzene 0.0500 0.0440 mg/L 88 80 - 120 Chloroform 0.0500 0.0463 mg/L 93 76 - 117 1,2-Dichloroethane 0.0500 0.0463 mg/L 93 76 - 117 1,1-Dichloroethene 0.0500 0.0434 mg/L 87 58 - 115 Methyl Ethyl Ketone 0.0500 0.0531 mg/L 106 53 - 140 Tetrachloroethene 0.0500 0.0484 mg/L 97 71 - 120 Trichloroethene 0.0500 0.0481 mg/L 96 75 - 120 Vinyl chloride 0.0500 0.0511 mg/L 102 51 - 149 D %Rec Limits LCS LCS Surrogate %Recovery Qualifier Limits 1,2-Dichloroethane-d4 (Surr) 99 75 - 131 Toluene-d8 (Surr) 99 80 - 120 4-Bromofluorobenzene (Surr) 98 79 - 120 Dibromofluoromethane 97 74 - 123 Lab Sample ID: MB 500-167704/7 Matrix: Solid Analysis Batch: 167704 Client Sample ID: Method Blank Prep Type: Total/NA MB MB Analyte Result Qualifier 6 7 8 9 10 11 MB MB Surrogate 4 RL MDL Unit D Prepared Analyzed Dil Fac Benzene <0.0010 0.0010 mg/L 10/29/12 22:47 1 Carbon tetrachloride <0.0010 0.0010 mg/L 10/29/12 22:47 1 Chlorobenzene <0.0010 0.0010 mg/L 10/29/12 22:47 1 Chloroform <0.0010 0.0010 mg/L 10/29/12 22:47 1 1,2-Dichloroethane <0.0010 0.0010 mg/L 10/29/12 22:47 1 Page 16 of 30 TestAmerica Chicago 10/30/2012 12 13 14 15 QC Sample Results 1 Client: Terracon Consulting Eng & Scientists Project/Site: Skinner Park - (A2127030) TestAmerica Job ID: 500-51668-1 2 3 Method: 8260B - TCLP Volatiles (Continued) Lab Sample ID: MB 500-167704/7 Matrix: Solid Analysis Batch: 167704 Client Sample ID: Method Blank Prep Type: Total/NA 5 MB MB Analyte 4 Result Qualifier RL MDL Unit D Prepared Analyzed Dil Fac 6 1,1-Dichloroethene <0.0010 0.0010 mg/L 10/29/12 22:47 1 Methyl Ethyl Ketone <0.0050 0.0050 mg/L 10/29/12 22:47 1 Tetrachloroethene <0.0010 0.0010 mg/L 10/29/12 22:47 1 Trichloroethene <0.0010 0.0010 mg/L 10/29/12 22:47 1 Vinyl chloride <0.0010 0.0010 mg/L 10/29/12 22:47 1 8 Dil Fac 9 MB MB Surrogate %Recovery Qualifier Limits Prepared Analyzed 7 1,2-Dichloroethane-d4 (Surr) 99 75 - 131 10/29/12 22:47 1 Toluene-d8 (Surr) 98 80 - 120 10/29/12 22:47 1 4-Bromofluorobenzene (Surr) 93 79 - 120 10/29/12 22:47 1 101 74 - 123 10/29/12 22:47 1 11 Client Sample ID: Lab Control Sample Prep Type: Total/NA 12 Dibromofluoromethane Lab Sample ID: LCS 500-167704/5 Matrix: Solid Analysis Batch: 167704 Spike LCS LCS 13 %Rec. Analyte Added Result Qualifier Unit Benzene 0.0500 0.0498 mg/L D %Rec 100 74 - 115 Carbon tetrachloride 0.0500 0.0514 mg/L 103 72 - 124 Chlorobenzene 0.0500 0.0479 mg/L 96 80 - 120 Chloroform 0.0500 0.0527 mg/L 105 76 - 117 1,2-Dichloroethane 0.0500 0.0513 mg/L 103 76 - 117 1,1-Dichloroethene 0.0500 0.0475 mg/L 95 58 - 115 Methyl Ethyl Ketone 0.0500 0.0589 mg/L 118 53 - 140 Tetrachloroethene 0.0500 0.0523 mg/L 105 71 - 120 Trichloroethene 0.0500 0.0523 mg/L 105 75 - 120 Vinyl chloride 0.0500 0.0565 mg/L 113 51 - 149 Limits 14 15 LCS LCS Surrogate %Recovery Qualifier Limits 1,2-Dichloroethane-d4 (Surr) 99 75 - 131 Toluene-d8 (Surr) 99 80 - 120 4-Bromofluorobenzene (Surr) 98 79 - 120 101 74 - 123 Dibromofluoromethane Lab Sample ID: LB 500-167486/1-A LB Matrix: Solid Analysis Batch: 167704 Client Sample ID: Method Blank Prep Type: TCLP LB LB RL Analyte Result Qualifier Benzene <0.020 0.020 mg/L 10/29/12 23:35 20 Carbon tetrachloride <0.020 0.020 mg/L 10/29/12 23:35 20 Chlorobenzene <0.020 0.020 mg/L 10/29/12 23:35 20 Chloroform <0.020 0.020 mg/L 10/29/12 23:35 20 1,2-Dichloroethane <0.020 0.020 mg/L 10/29/12 23:35 20 1,1-Dichloroethene <0.020 0.020 mg/L 10/29/12 23:35 20 Methyl Ethyl Ketone <0.10 0.10 mg/L 10/29/12 23:35 20 Tetrachloroethene <0.020 0.020 mg/L 10/29/12 23:35 20 Trichloroethene <0.020 0.020 mg/L 10/29/12 23:35 20 Vinyl chloride <0.020 0.020 mg/L 10/29/12 23:35 20 Page 17 of 30 MDL Unit D Prepared 10 Analyzed Dil Fac TestAmerica Chicago 10/30/2012 QC Sample Results 1 Client: Terracon Consulting Eng & Scientists Project/Site: Skinner Park - (A2127030) TestAmerica Job ID: 500-51668-1 2 3 Method: 8260B - TCLP Volatiles (Continued) Lab Sample ID: LB 500-167486/1-A LB Matrix: Solid Analysis Batch: 167704 Client Sample ID: Method Blank Prep Type: TCLP 5 LB LB Surrogate %Recovery Qualifier 1,2-Dichloroethane-d4 (Surr) Limits Prepared Analyzed Dil Fac 100 75 - 131 10/29/12 23:35 20 Toluene-d8 (Surr) 98 80 - 120 10/29/12 23:35 20 4-Bromofluorobenzene (Surr) 93 79 - 120 10/29/12 23:35 20 106 74 - 123 10/29/12 23:35 20 Dibromofluoromethane Method: 8270C - TCLP Semivolatiles 6 7 8 9 Lab Sample ID: MB 500-167646/1-A Matrix: Solid Analysis Batch: 167690 Client Sample ID: Method Blank Prep Type: Total/NA Prep Batch: 167646 MB MB Analyte Result Qualifier Prepared Analyzed 2-Methylphenol <0.010 0.010 1,4-Dichlorobenzene <0.010 0.010 mg/L 10/29/12 08:02 10/29/12 18:17 1 mg/L 10/29/12 08:02 10/29/12 18:17 1 2,4-Dinitrotoluene <0.010 Hexachlorobenzene <0.010 0.010 mg/L 10/29/12 08:02 10/29/12 18:17 1 0.010 mg/L 10/29/12 08:02 10/29/12 18:17 1 Hexachloro-1,3-butadiene Hexachloroethane <0.010 0.010 mg/L 10/29/12 08:02 10/29/12 18:17 1 <0.010 0.010 mg/L 10/29/12 08:02 10/29/12 18:17 1 Nitrobenzene <0.010 0.010 mg/L 10/29/12 08:02 10/29/12 18:17 1 Pentachlorophenol <0.050 0.050 mg/L 10/29/12 08:02 10/29/12 18:17 1 Pyridine <0.020 0.020 mg/L 10/29/12 08:02 10/29/12 18:17 1 2,4,5-Trichlorophenol <0.050 0.050 mg/L 10/29/12 08:02 10/29/12 18:17 1 2,4,6-Trichlorophenol <0.010 0.010 mg/L 10/29/12 08:02 10/29/12 18:17 1 3 & 4 Methylphenol <0.010 0.010 mg/L 10/29/12 08:02 10/29/12 18:17 1 RL MDL Unit D %Recovery Qualifier Limits Prepared Analyzed 2-Fluorophenol 60 20 - 100 10/29/12 08:02 10/29/12 18:17 1 Phenol-d5 36 20 - 100 10/29/12 08:02 10/29/12 18:17 1 Nitrobenzene-d5 93 41 - 110 10/29/12 08:02 10/29/12 18:17 1 2-Fluorobiphenyl 89 48 - 110 10/29/12 08:02 10/29/12 18:17 1 2,4,6-Tribromophenol 103 50 - 129 10/29/12 08:02 10/29/12 18:17 1 Terphenyl-d14 101 44 - 132 10/29/12 08:02 10/29/12 18:17 1 Lab Sample ID: LCS 500-167646/2-A Matrix: Solid Analysis Batch: 167690 Dil Fac Client Sample ID: Lab Control Sample Prep Type: Total/NA Prep Batch: 167646 Spike LCS LCS %Rec. Analyte Added Result Qualifier Unit 2-Methylphenol 0.0500 0.0351 mg/L 1,4-Dichlorobenzene 0.0500 0.0357 2,4-Dinitrotoluene 0.0500 0.0504 Hexachlorobenzene 0.0500 Hexachloro-1,3-butadiene D %Rec Limits 70 47 - 100 mg/L 71 34 - 100 mg/L 101 68 - 121 0.0463 mg/L 93 70 - 119 0.0500 0.0378 mg/L 76 32 - 110 Hexachloroethane 0.0500 0.0356 mg/L 71 28 - 100 Nitrobenzene 0.0500 0.0412 mg/L 82 54 - 110 Pentachlorophenol 0.0500 <0.050 mg/L 62 42 - 144 Pyridine 0.0500 0.0208 mg/L 42 10 - 110 2,4,5-Trichlorophenol 0.0500 0.0513 mg/L 103 68 - 115 2,4,6-Trichlorophenol 0.0500 0.0504 mg/L 101 64 - 110 Page 18 of 30 10 11 Dil Fac MB MB Surrogate 4 TestAmerica Chicago 10/30/2012 12 13 14 15 QC Sample Results 1 Client: Terracon Consulting Eng & Scientists Project/Site: Skinner Park - (A2127030) TestAmerica Job ID: 500-51668-1 2 3 Method: 8270C - TCLP Semivolatiles (Continued) Lab Sample ID: LCS 500-167646/2-A Matrix: Solid Analysis Batch: 167690 Client Sample ID: Lab Control Sample Prep Type: Total/NA Prep Batch: 167646 Spike LCS LCS %Rec. Analyte Added Result Qualifier Unit 3 & 4 Methylphenol 0.0500 0.0329 mg/L D %Rec 66 Limits %Recovery Qualifier 7 Limits 2-Fluorophenol 58 20 - 100 Phenol-d5 36 20 - 100 Nitrobenzene-d5 88 41 - 110 2-Fluorobiphenyl 94 48 - 110 2,4,6-Tribromophenol 108 50 - 129 Terphenyl-d14 104 44 - 132 8 9 10 Lab Sample ID: LB 500-167581/1-B LB Matrix: Solid Analysis Batch: 167690 Client Sample ID: Method Blank Prep Type: TCLP Prep Batch: 167646 LB LB Analyte Prepared Analyzed 2-Methylphenol <0.10 0.10 mg/L 10/29/12 08:02 10/29/12 19:00 1 1,4-Dichlorobenzene <0.10 0.10 mg/L 10/29/12 08:02 10/29/12 19:00 1 2,4-Dinitrotoluene <0.10 0.10 mg/L 10/29/12 08:02 10/29/12 19:00 1 Hexachlorobenzene <0.10 0.10 mg/L 10/29/12 08:02 10/29/12 19:00 1 Hexachloro-1,3-butadiene <0.10 0.10 mg/L 10/29/12 08:02 10/29/12 19:00 1 Hexachloroethane <0.10 0.10 mg/L 10/29/12 08:02 10/29/12 19:00 1 Nitrobenzene <0.10 0.10 mg/L 10/29/12 08:02 10/29/12 19:00 1 Pentachlorophenol <0.50 0.50 mg/L 10/29/12 08:02 10/29/12 19:00 1 Pyridine <0.20 0.20 mg/L 10/29/12 08:02 10/29/12 19:00 1 2,4,5-Trichlorophenol <0.50 0.50 mg/L 10/29/12 08:02 10/29/12 19:00 1 2,4,6-Trichlorophenol <0.10 0.10 mg/L 10/29/12 08:02 10/29/12 19:00 1 3 & 4 Methylphenol <0.10 0.10 mg/L 10/29/12 08:02 10/29/12 19:00 1 Result Qualifier RL MDL Unit D Dil Fac LB LB Surrogate %Recovery Qualifier Limits Prepared Analyzed 2-Fluorophenol 57 20 - 100 10/29/12 08:02 10/29/12 19:00 1 Phenol-d5 34 20 - 100 10/29/12 08:02 10/29/12 19:00 1 Nitrobenzene-d5 96 41 - 110 10/29/12 08:02 10/29/12 19:00 1 2-Fluorobiphenyl 96 48 - 110 10/29/12 08:02 10/29/12 19:00 1 113 50 - 129 10/29/12 08:02 10/29/12 19:00 1 97 44 - 132 10/29/12 08:02 10/29/12 19:00 1 2,4,6-Tribromophenol Terphenyl-d14 Lab Sample ID: 500-51668-1 MS Matrix: Solid Analysis Batch: 167798 Dil Fac Client Sample ID: B-100-WC Prep Type: TCLP Prep Batch: 167646 Sample Sample Analyte Result Qualifier Spike Added 5 6 43 - 110 LCS LCS Surrogate 4 MS MS Result Qualifier %Rec. Unit 2-Methylphenol <0.10 0.500 0.434 mg/L 1,4-Dichlorobenzene <0.10 0.500 0.433 2,4-Dinitrotoluene <0.10 0.500 0.563 Hexachlorobenzene <0.10 0.500 Hexachloro-1,3-butadiene <0.10 Hexachloroethane D %Rec Limits 87 47 - 100 mg/L 87 34 - 100 mg/L 113 68 - 121 0.460 mg/L 92 70 - 119 0.500 0.432 mg/L 86 32 - 110 <0.10 0.500 0.428 mg/L 86 28 - 100 Nitrobenzene <0.10 0.500 0.443 mg/L 89 54 - 110 Pentachlorophenol <0.50 0.500 0.524 mg/L 105 42 - 144 Page 19 of 30 TestAmerica Chicago 10/30/2012 11 12 13 14 15 QC Sample Results 1 Client: Terracon Consulting Eng & Scientists Project/Site: Skinner Park - (A2127030) TestAmerica Job ID: 500-51668-1 2 3 Method: 8270C - TCLP Semivolatiles (Continued) Lab Sample ID: 500-51668-1 MS Matrix: Solid Analysis Batch: 167798 Client Sample ID: B-100-WC Prep Type: TCLP Prep Batch: 167646 Sample Sample Analyte Result Qualifier Spike MS MS Added %Rec. Result Qualifier 1.03 E F Unit D %Rec Limits Pyridine <0.20 0.500 mg/L 206 10 - 110 2,4,5-Trichlorophenol <0.50 0.500 0.532 mg/L 106 68 - 115 2,4,6-Trichlorophenol <0.10 0.500 0.516 mg/L 103 64 - 110 3 & 4 Methylphenol <0.10 0.500 0.444 mg/L 89 43 - 110 %Recovery Qualifier 5 6 7 8 MS MS Surrogate 4 Limits 2-Fluorophenol 60 20 - 100 Phenol-d5 44 20 - 100 Nitrobenzene-d5 101 41 - 110 2-Fluorobiphenyl 113 X 48 - 110 2,4,6-Tribromophenol 130 X 50 - 129 Terphenyl-d14 109 44 - 132 9 10 11 12 Method: 8082 - Polychlorinated Biphenyls (PCBs) by Gas Chromatography Lab Sample ID: MB 500-167228/1-A Matrix: Solid Analysis Batch: 167675 Client Sample ID: Method Blank Prep Type: Total/NA Prep Batch: 167228 MB MB Analyte Result Qualifier RL PCB-1016 <0.017 0.017 PCB-1221 <0.017 0.017 PCB-1232 <0.017 PCB-1242 MDL Unit D Prepared Analyzed Dil Fac mg/Kg 10/25/12 07:18 10/29/12 19:12 1 mg/Kg 10/25/12 07:18 10/29/12 19:12 1 0.017 mg/Kg 10/25/12 07:18 10/29/12 19:12 1 <0.017 0.017 mg/Kg 10/25/12 07:18 10/29/12 19:12 1 PCB-1248 <0.017 0.017 mg/Kg 10/25/12 07:18 10/29/12 19:12 1 PCB-1254 <0.017 0.017 mg/Kg 10/25/12 07:18 10/29/12 19:12 1 PCB-1260 <0.017 0.017 mg/Kg 10/25/12 07:18 10/29/12 19:12 1 MB MB Surrogate %Recovery Qualifier Limits Prepared Analyzed Tetrachloro-m-xylene 102 50 - 116 10/25/12 07:18 10/29/12 19:12 1 DCB Decachlorobiphenyl 107 48 - 142 10/25/12 07:18 10/29/12 19:12 1 Lab Sample ID: LCS 500-167228/3-A Matrix: Solid Analysis Batch: 167675 Dil Fac Client Sample ID: Lab Control Sample Prep Type: Total/NA Prep Batch: 167228 Spike Analyte Added LCS LCS Result Qualifier %Rec. Unit D %Rec Limits PCB-1016 0.167 0.145 mg/Kg 87 59 - 110 PCB-1260 0.167 0.173 mg/Kg 104 69 - 120 LCS LCS Surrogate Tetrachloro-m-xylene DCB Decachlorobiphenyl %Recovery Qualifier Limits 69 50 - 116 106 48 - 142 Page 20 of 30 TestAmerica Chicago 10/30/2012 13 14 15 QC Sample Results 1 Client: Terracon Consulting Eng & Scientists Project/Site: Skinner Park - (A2127030) TestAmerica Job ID: 500-51668-1 2 3 Method: 6010B - TCLP Metals (ICP) Lab Sample ID: LCS 500-167682/2-A Matrix: Solid Analysis Batch: 167791 Client Sample ID: Lab Control Sample Prep Type: Total/NA Prep Batch: 167682 Spike Analyte Added Arsenic 0.100 Barium LCS LCS %Rec. Result Qualifier Unit 0.0914 mg/L D %Rec 91 80 - 120 Limits 2.00 1.91 mg/L 95 80 - 120 Cadmium 0.0500 0.0473 mg/L 95 80 - 120 Chromium 0.200 0.195 mg/L 98 80 - 120 Lead 0.100 0.0976 mg/L 98 80 - 120 Selenium 0.100 0.0845 mg/L 84 80 - 120 0.0500 0.0472 mg/L 94 80 - 120 Silver Lab Sample ID: LB 500-167581/1-E LB Matrix: Solid Analysis Batch: 167791 7 8 9 LB LB Result Qualifier Arsenic <0.050 Barium RL MDL Unit 0.050 D Prepared Analyzed 0.010 mg/L 10/29/12 08:30 10/29/12 16:55 1 Dil Fac <0.50 0.50 0.010 mg/L 10/29/12 08:30 10/29/12 16:55 1 Cadmium <0.0050 0.0050 0.0020 mg/L 10/29/12 08:30 10/29/12 16:55 1 Chromium <0.025 0.025 0.010 mg/L 10/29/12 08:30 10/29/12 16:55 1 Lead <0.050 0.050 0.0050 mg/L 10/29/12 08:30 10/29/12 16:55 1 Selenium <0.050 0.050 0.010 mg/L 10/29/12 08:30 10/29/12 16:55 1 Silver <0.025 0.025 0.0050 mg/L 10/29/12 08:30 10/29/12 16:55 1 Method: 7470A - TCLP Mercury Lab Sample ID: MB 500-167681/7-A Matrix: Solid Analysis Batch: 167850 Client Sample ID: Method Blank Prep Type: Total/NA Prep Batch: 167681 MB MB Analyte Mercury Result Qualifier <0.00020 RL MDL Unit 0.00020 D mg/L Lab Sample ID: LCS 500-167681/8-A Matrix: Solid Analysis Batch: 167850 Prepared Analyzed 10/29/12 16:00 10/30/12 11:45 Dil Fac 1 Client Sample ID: Lab Control Sample Prep Type: Total/NA Prep Batch: 167681 Spike Analyte Added Mercury 0.00200 LCS LCS %Rec. Result Qualifier 0.00187 Unit D mg/L Lab Sample ID: LCSD 500-167681/10-A Matrix: Solid Analysis Batch: 167850 %Rec 94 Limits 80 - 120 Client Sample ID: Lab Control Sample Dup Prep Type: Total/NA Prep Batch: 167681 Spike Analyte Added Mercury 0.00200 LCSD LCSD Result Qualifier 0.00189 %Rec. Unit D mg/L %Rec 94 Lab Sample ID: LB 500-167581/1-D LB Matrix: Solid Analysis Batch: 167850 RPD Limits RPD Limit 1 20 80 - 120 Client Sample ID: Method Blank Prep Type: TCLP Prep Batch: 167681 LB LB Analyte Mercury Result Qualifier <0.00020 RL 0.00020 Page 21 of 30 MDL Unit mg/L D 5 6 Client Sample ID: Method Blank Prep Type: TCLP Prep Batch: 167682 Analyte 4 Prepared Analyzed 10/29/12 16:00 10/30/12 11:49 Dil Fac 1 TestAmerica Chicago 10/30/2012 10 11 12 13 14 15 QC Sample Results 1 Client: Terracon Consulting Eng & Scientists Project/Site: Skinner Park - (A2127030) TestAmerica Job ID: 500-51668-1 2 3 Method: 7.3.4 - Reactive Sulfide Lab Sample ID: MB 500-167833/1-A Matrix: Solid Analysis Batch: 167852 Client Sample ID: Method Blank Prep Type: Total/NA Prep Batch: 167833 MB MB Analyte Result Qualifier Sulfide, Reactive RL <50 MDL Unit 50 D mg/Kg Lab Sample ID: LCS 500-167833/2-A Matrix: Solid Analysis Batch: 167852 Prepared Analyzed 10/30/12 11:50 10/30/12 12:40 Analyte LCS LCS Added Sulfide, Reactive Result Qualifier 168 162 Unit D mg/Kg %Rec 96 Result Qualifier Sulfide, Reactive Spike MS MS Added <48 %Rec. Result Qualifier 161 161 Unit D mg/Kg %Rec 100 Lab Sample ID: 500-51668-1 MSD Matrix: Solid Analysis Batch: 167852 Result Qualifier Sulfide, Reactive Spike MSD MSD Added <48 %Rec. Result Qualifier 164 152 Unit D mg/Kg %Rec 93 RPD Limits RPD Limit 6 20 75 - 125 Method: 9014 - Reactive Cyanide Lab Sample ID: MB 500-167307/1-A Matrix: Solid Analysis Batch: 167433 Client Sample ID: Method Blank Prep Type: Total/NA Prep Batch: 167307 MB MB Analyte Cyanide, Reactive Result Qualifier RL 0.215 J MDL Unit 0.50 D 0.13 mg/Kg Lab Sample ID: LCS 500-167307/2-A Matrix: Solid Analysis Batch: 167433 Prepared Analyzed 10/25/12 17:00 10/25/12 20:47 Dil Fac 1 Client Sample ID: Lab Control Sample Prep Type: Total/NA Prep Batch: 167307 Spike Analyte LCS LCS Added Cyanide, Reactive %Rec. Result Qualifier 5.00 4.86 Unit D mg/Kg %Rec 97 Limits 80 - 120 Method: 9023 - Organic Halides, Extractable (EOX) Lab Sample ID: MB 490-30924/2-A Matrix: Solid Analysis Batch: 31571 Client Sample ID: Method Blank Prep Type: Total/NA Prep Batch: 30924 MB MB Analyte Halogens, Extractable Organic Result Qualifier <50 RL 50 Page 22 of 30 7 8 MDL Unit mg/Kg D 10 11 12 Limits 75 - 125 Client Sample ID: B-100-WC Prep Type: Total/NA Prep Batch: 167833 Sample Sample 6 9 Limits 80 - 120 Client Sample ID: B-100-WC Prep Type: Total/NA Prep Batch: 167833 Sample Sample 5 %Rec. Lab Sample ID: 500-51668-1 MS Matrix: Solid Analysis Batch: 167852 Analyte 1 Client Sample ID: Lab Control Sample Prep Type: Total/NA Prep Batch: 167833 Spike Analyte Dil Fac 4 Prepared Analyzed 10/25/12 08:00 10/27/12 14:38 Dil Fac 1 TestAmerica Chicago 10/30/2012 13 14 15 QC Sample Results 1 Client: Terracon Consulting Eng & Scientists Project/Site: Skinner Park - (A2127030) TestAmerica Job ID: 500-51668-1 2 3 Method: 9023 - Organic Halides, Extractable (EOX) (Continued) Lab Sample ID: LCS 490-30924/1-A Matrix: Solid Analysis Batch: 31571 Client Sample ID: Lab Control Sample Prep Type: Total/NA Prep Batch: 30924 Spike Analyte LCS LCS Added Halogens, Extractable Organic %Rec. Result Qualifier 1040 992 Unit D mg/Kg %Rec 95 Lab Sample ID: 500-51668-1 MS Matrix: Solid Analysis Batch: 31571 Limits Analyte Result Qualifier Halogens, Extractable Organic <60 Spike MS MS Added 1060 Unit D %Rec mg/Kg ☼ 84 Lab Sample ID: 500-51668-1 MSD Matrix: Solid Analysis Batch: 31571 Sample Sample Result Qualifier Halogens, Extractable Organic <60 Spike MSD MSD Added %Rec. Result Qualifier 1260 1140 Unit D %Rec mg/Kg ☼ 91 RPD Limits RPD Limit 7 20 70 - 130 11 12 14 Lab Sample ID: 500-51668-1 DU Matrix: Solid Analysis Batch: 167711 Client Sample ID: B-100-WC Prep Type: Total/NA Sample Sample Analyte DU DU Result Qualifier pH RPD Result Qualifier 7.95 8.170 Unit D RPD SU Limit 3 Method: 9066 - Phenolics, Total Recoverable Lab Sample ID: MB 500-167659/14-A Matrix: Solid Analysis Batch: 167811 Client Sample ID: Method Blank Prep Type: Total/NA Prep Batch: 167659 MB MB Analyte Result Qualifier Phenolics, Total Recoverable RL <0.50 MDL Unit 0.50 D mg/Kg Lab Sample ID: LCS 500-167659/15-A Matrix: Solid Analysis Batch: 167811 Prepared Analyzed 10/29/12 10:15 10/30/12 08:43 Dil Fac 1 Client Sample ID: Lab Control Sample Prep Type: Total/NA Prep Batch: 167659 Spike Analyte Added Phenolics, Total Recoverable 10.0 LCS LCS Result Qualifier 9.24 %Rec. Unit D mg/Kg %Rec 92 Lab Sample ID: 500-51668-1 MS Matrix: Solid Analysis Batch: 167811 Limits 90 - 110 Client Sample ID: B-100-WC Prep Type: Total/NA Prep Batch: 167659 Sample Sample Phenolics, Total Recoverable 10 13 Method: 9045C - pH Analyte 8 9 Limits 70 - 130 Client Sample ID: B-100-WC Prep Type: Total/NA Prep Batch: 30924 Analyte 7 %Rec. Result Qualifier 1260 5 6 90 - 110 Client Sample ID: B-100-WC Prep Type: Total/NA Prep Batch: 30924 Sample Sample 4 Result Qualifier <0.53 Spike Added 10.7 MS MS Result Qualifier 9.99 Page 23 of 30 %Rec. Unit D %Rec mg/Kg ☼ 93 Limits 75 - 125 TestAmerica Chicago 10/30/2012 15 QC Sample Results 1 Client: Terracon Consulting Eng & Scientists Project/Site: Skinner Park - (A2127030) TestAmerica Job ID: 500-51668-1 2 3 Method: 9066 - Phenolics, Total Recoverable (Continued) Lab Sample ID: 500-51668-1 MSD Matrix: Solid Analysis Batch: 167811 Client Sample ID: B-100-WC Prep Type: Total/NA Prep Batch: 167659 Sample Sample Analyte Phenolics, Total Recoverable Result Qualifier <0.53 Spike Added 10.7 MSD MSD Result Qualifier 11.0 %Rec. Unit D %Rec mg/Kg ☼ 103 Limits 75 - 125 RPD RPD Limit 9 20 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 Page 24 of 30 TestAmerica Chicago 10/30/2012 Lab Chronicle 1 Client: Terracon Consulting Eng & Scientists Project/Site: Skinner Park - (A2127030) TestAmerica Job ID: 500-51668-1 2 Client Sample ID: B-100-WC Lab Sample ID: 500-51668-1 Date Collected: 10/24/12 14:00 Date Received: 10/24/12 15:42 Matrix: Solid Batch Batch Prep Type Type Method Dilution Batch Factor Number or Analyzed TCLP Leach 1311 TCLP Analysis 8260B 167486 167637 TCLP Leach TCLP Prep 1311 3510C TCLP Analysis 8270C Total/NA Prep 3541 Total/NA Analysis 8082 TCLP Leach 1311 TCLP Prep 3010A TCLP Analysis 6010B TCLP Prep 7470A TCLP Analysis 7470A Total/NA Prep 9023 Total/NA Analysis 9023 1 Total/NA Analysis Moisture 1 Total/NA Prep 9010B Total/NA Analysis 9014 Total/NA Analysis 9095A Run Prepared Analyst Lab 10/26/12 13:00 MP TAL CHI 10/29/12 15:07 LM TAL CHI 167581 10/27/12 23:08 PFK TAL CHI 167646 10/29/12 08:02 SCH TAL CHI 167798 10/30/12 14:31 DA TAL CHI 167228 10/25/12 07:18 STW TAL CHI 167675 10/29/12 19:40 PG TAL CHI 167581 10/27/12 23:08 PFK TAL CHI 167682 10/29/12 08:30 LAH TAL CHI 167791 10/29/12 20:03 TDS TAL CHI 167681 10/29/12 16:00 BJB TAL CHI 167850 10/30/12 12:35 BJB TAL CHI 30924 10/25/12 12:52 SS TAL NSH 31571 10/27/12 14:38 CLJ TAL NSH 167392 10/26/12 08:34 CMV TAL CHI 167307 10/25/12 17:00 EAT TAL CHI 1 167433 10/25/12 20:50 EAT TAL CHI 1 167560 APW TAL CHI APW TAL CHI CLM TAL CHI 20 1 1 1 1 (Start) 10/27/12 15:33 (End) 10/27/12 15:40 Total/NA Analysis 1010 1 167562 (Start) 10/27/12 14:00 (End) 10/27/12 15:00 Total/NA Analysis 9045C 1 167711 (Start) 10/29/12 09:30 (End) 10/29/12 09:33 Total/NA Prep Distill/Phenol Total/NA Analysis 9066 Total/NA Prep 7.3.4 Total/NA Analysis 7.3.4 1 1 167659 10/29/12 10:15 MTB TAL CHI 167811 10/30/12 08:45 MTB TAL CHI 167833 10/30/12 12:07 CLM TAL CHI 167852 10/30/12 12:42 CLM TAL CHI Laboratory References: TAL CHI = TestAmerica Chicago, 2417 Bond Street, University Park, IL 60484, TEL (708)534-5200 TAL NSH = TestAmerica Nashville, 2960 Foster Creighton Drive, Nashville, TN 37204, TEL (615)726-0177 Page 25 of 30 TestAmerica Chicago 10/30/2012 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 Certification Summary Client: Terracon Consulting Eng & Scientists Project/Site: Skinner Park - (A2127030) 1 TestAmerica Job ID: 500-51668-1 2 Laboratory: TestAmerica Chicago 3 All certifications held by this laboratory are listed. Not all certifications are applicable to this report. Authority Program EPA Region Certification ID Expiration Date Alabama State Program 4 40461 04-30-13 California NELAC 9 01132CA 04-30-13 Georgia State Program 4 N/A 04-30-13 Georgia State Program 4 939 04-30-13 Hawaii State Program 9 N/A 04-30-13 Illinois NELAC 5 100201 04-30-13 Indiana State Program 5 C-IL-02 04-30-13 Iowa State Program 7 82 05-01-14 Kansas NELAC 7 E-10161 10-31-12 Kentucky State Program 4 90023 12-31-12 Kentucky (UST) State Program 4 66 04-11-13 L-A-B DoD ELAP L2304 01-06-13 L-A-B ISO/IEC 17025 L2304 01-06-13 Louisiana NELAC 6 30720 06-30-13 Massachusetts State Program 1 M-IL035 06-30-13 Mississippi State Program 4 N/A 04-30-13 North Carolina DENR State Program 4 291 12-31-12 North Dakota State Program 8 R-194 04-30-13 Oklahoma State Program 6 8908 08-31-13 South Carolina State Program 4 77001 04-30-13 Texas NELAC 6 T104704252-09-TX 02-28-13 USDA Federal P330-12-00038 02-06-15 Virginia NELAC 3 460142 06-14-13 Wisconsin State Program 5 999580010 08-31-13 Wyoming State Program 8 8TMS-Q 04-30-13 Certification ID Expiration Date 0453.07 12-31-13 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 Laboratory: TestAmerica Nashville All certifications held by this laboratory are listed. Not all certifications are applicable to this report. Authority Program A2LA ISO/IEC 17025 EPA Region Alabama State Program 4 41150 05-31-13 Alaska (UST) State Program 10 UST-087 07-24-13 Arizona State Program 9 AZ0473 05-05-13 Arkansas DEQ State Program 6 88-0737 04-25-13 California NELAC 9 1168CA 10-31-12 Canadian Assoc Lab Accred (CALA) Canada 3744 03-08-14 Colorado State Program 8 N/A 02-28-13 Connecticut State Program 1 PH-0220 12-31-13 Florida NELAC 4 E87358 06-30-13 Illinois NELAC 5 200010 12-09-12 Iowa State Program 7 131 05-01-14 Kansas NELAC 7 E-10229 10-31-12 Kentucky State Program 4 90038 12-31-12 Kentucky (UST) State Program 4 19 09-15-13 Louisiana NELAC 6 LA120025 12-31-12 Louisiana NELAC 6 30613 06-30-13 Maryland State Program 3 316 03-31-13 Massachusetts State Program 1 M-TN032 06-30-13 Minnesota NELAC 5 047-999-345 12-31-12 Mississippi State Program 4 N/A 06-30-13 Montana (UST) State Program 8 NA 01-01-15 Nevada State Program 9 TN00032 07-31-13 Page 26 of 30 TestAmerica Chicago 10/30/2012 Certification Summary Client: Terracon Consulting Eng & Scientists Project/Site: Skinner Park - (A2127030) 1 TestAmerica Job ID: 500-51668-1 2 Laboratory: TestAmerica Nashville (Continued) 3 All certifications held by this laboratory are listed. Not all certifications are applicable to this report. Authority Program EPA Region Certification ID Expiration Date New Hampshire NELAC 1 2963 10-09-13 New Jersey NELAC 2 TN965 06-30-13 New York NELAC 2 11342 04-01-13 North Carolina DENR State Program 4 387 12-31-12 North Dakota State Program 8 R-146 06-30-13 Ohio VAP State Program 5 CL0033 01-19-14 Oklahoma State Program 6 9412 08-31-13 Oregon NELAC 10 TN200001 04-30-13 Pennsylvania NELAC 3 68-00585 06-30-13 Rhode Island State Program 1 LAO00268 12-30-12 South Carolina State Program 4 84009 (001) 02-28-13 South Carolina State Program 4 84009 (002) 02-23-14 Tennessee State Program 4 2008 02-23-14 Texas NELAC 6 T104704077-09-TX 08-31-13 USDA Federal S-48469 11-02-13 Utah NELAC 8 TAN 06-30-13 Virginia NELAC 3 460152 06-14-13 Washington State Program 10 C789 07-19-13 West Virginia DEP State Program 3 219 02-28-13 Wisconsin State Program 5 998020430 08-31-13 Wyoming (UST) A2LA 8 453.07 12-31-13 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 Page 27 of 30 TestAmerica Chicago 10/30/2012 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 Page 28 of 30 10/30/2012 1 Login Sample Receipt Checklist 2 Client: Terracon Consulting Eng & Scientists Job Number: 500-51668-1 Login Number: 51668 List Source: TestAmerica Chicago List Number: 1 3 4 5 Creator: Lunt, Jeff T Question Answer Radioactivity wasn't checked or is </= background as measured by a survey meter. True The cooler's custody seal, if present, is intact. N/A Sample custody seals, if present, are intact. True The cooler or samples do not appear to have been compromised or tampered with. True Samples were received on ice. True Cooler Temperature is acceptable. True Cooler Temperature is recorded. True COC is present. True COC is filled out in ink and legible. True COC is filled out with all pertinent information. True Is the Field Sampler's name present on COC? True There are no discrepancies between the containers received and the COC. True Samples are received within Holding Time. True Sample containers have legible labels. True Containers are not broken or leaking. True Sample collection date/times are provided. True Appropriate sample containers are used. True Sample bottles are completely filled. True Sample Preservation Verified. True There is sufficient vol. for all requested analyses, incl. any requested MS/MSDs True Containers requiring zero headspace have no headspace or bubble is <6mm (1/4"). True Multiphasic samples are not present. True Samples do not require splitting or compositing. True Residual Chlorine Checked. N/A 6 Comment 7 8 9 4.4 10 11 12 13 14 15 TestAmerica Chicago Page 29 of 30 10/30/2012 1 Login Sample Receipt Checklist 2 Client: Terracon Consulting Eng & Scientists Job Number: 500-51668-1 Login Number: 51668 List Source: TestAmerica Nashville List Number: 1 List Creation: 10/25/12 10:55 AM Creator: Himelick, John Question Answer Radioactivity wasn't checked or is </= background as measured by a survey meter. True The cooler's custody seal, if present, is intact. True Sample custody seals, if present, are intact. True The cooler or samples do not appear to have been compromised or tampered with. True Samples were received on ice. True Cooler Temperature is acceptable. True Cooler Temperature is recorded. True COC is present. True COC is filled out in ink and legible. True COC is filled out with all pertinent information. True Is the Field Sampler's name present on COC? True There are no discrepancies between the containers received and the COC. True Samples are received within Holding Time. True Sample containers have legible labels. True Containers are not broken or leaking. True Sample collection date/times are provided. True Appropriate sample containers are used. True Sample bottles are completely filled. True Sample Preservation Verified. N/A There is sufficient vol. for all requested analyses, incl. any requested MS/MSDs True Containers requiring zero headspace have no headspace or bubble is <6mm (1/4"). True Multiphasic samples are not present. True Samples do not require splitting or compositing. True Residual Chlorine Checked. N/A 4 5 6 Comment 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 TestAmerica Chicago Page 30 of 30 3 10/30/2012 SECTION 02318 ACCEPTANCE OF BACKFILL, TOP SOIL & CU STRUCTURAL SOIL PART 1 - GENERAL 1.1 APPLICABILITY: A. 1.2 This specification is for the historical review, collection and laboratory analysis of representative samples, and presentation of information for all off-site fill (cohesive and granular) sources to be utilized at the project site. DEFINITIONS A. Agency means Illinois Environmental Protection Agency (IEPA). B. Backfill means any granular or cohesive material used to fill an excavation or bring property to design grade as specified in the Architect/Engineer drawings and specifications. C. CU Structural Soil means a uniformly blended mixture of crushed stone, clay, loam and hydrogel by weight consisting of approximately 83% crushed limestone (3/4 to 1.5 inch, highly angular with no fines), 17% clay loam and hydrogel (1 oz. per 200 pounds of stone). D. IEPA means Illinois Environmental Protection Agency E. Owner: Chicago Park District. F. Owner’s Authorized Representative means the person designated as the official representative of the owner in connection with a project. H. Environmental Consultant (EC) means the entity with overall responsibility for the direction and control of the environmental investigations, assessments, designs, and supervision of remediation work typically hired by the Public Building Commission. I. RCRA 8: Resource Conservation Recovery Act (RCRA) 8 metals: Arsenic, Barium, Cadmium, Chromium, Lead, Mercury, Selenium, Silver. J. TACO: 35 Illinois Administrative Code 742: TIERED APPROACH TO CORRECTIVE ACTION OBJECTIVES (TACO). K. Top Soil means any soils placed to design grade and used to promote vegetative growth and which meets Top Soil criteria (percentages of organic matter, inorganic matter (silt, clay, and sand)), deleterious material, pH, and mineral and plant-nutrient content as referenced in the contract specifications and drawings. L. Tier 1 SROs: Means Tier 1 SROs for the most restrictive values for residential properties use as listed in PART 742, APPENDIX B, TABLE A; TIERED APPROACH TO CORRECTIVE ACTION OBJECTIVES (TACO): 35 ILL. ADM. CODE 742. For inorganic Rev. 07/29/2013 Park # 569 02318 - 1 BACKFILL, TOPSOIL ENV REQUIREMENTS parameters over background values shown for metropolitan properties in Appendix A, TABLE G, SROs must additionally meet pH-Specific values provided in Appendix B, TABLE C. RCRA 8 Inorganics tested with SPLP must meet values shown for Class II groundwater in 742 Appendix B TABLE E. 1.4 SUBMITTALS A. Copies of environmental analytical results of all backfill material, top soil and CU Structural Soil verifying that these materials do not exceed APPENDIX B, SECTION 742, TABLE A; TIERED APPROACH TO CORRECTIVE ACTION OBJECTIVES (TACO): 35 ILL. ADM. CODE 742 values for 35 ILL. ADM CODE 740 APPENDIX A Target Compound List (TCL) parameters, Total Petroleum Hydrocarbons (TPH-GRO+DRO), and SPLP Testing for RCRA 8 metals. For Target Compound Listed parameters known as PNAs, Appendix A TABLE H (Concentrations of Polynuclear Hydrocarbon Chemicals in background Soils) values may be used. For samples from virgin sources, if no letter certifying virgin material is received, one representative sample must be analyzed for 35 ILL. ADM CODE 740 APPENDIX A Target Compound List (TCL) parameters, Total Petroleum Hydrocarbons (TPH-GRO+DRO), and SPLP Testing for RCRA 8 metals. For inorganic parameters over background values shown for metropolitan properties in Appendix A, TABLE G, SROs must additionally meet pH-Specific values provided in Appendix B, TABLE C. RCRA 8 Inorganics tested with SPLP must meet values shown for Class II groundwater in 742 Appendix B TABLE E. No recycled stone/concrete will be permitted. A copy of the analytical results shall be submitted at least one week prior to depositing backfill or top soil on site. The date of the analysis shall be within 60 days of importing such material to the project. All material types must obtain samples at a rate of one approved sample per 1,000 imported cubic yards. B. For granular materials originating from a licensed stone quarry (virgin source) a source certification letter from the quarry owner/operator may be substituted instead of laboratory analysis, at the sole discretion of the owner. C. A summary of the sample collection and data analysis. The report should include a tabulation of sampling results compared to applicable Tier 1 remediation objectives for residential properties. For inorganic parameters over background values for metropolitan properties in 742 Appendix A, TABLE G, a table should be provided to show that the SROs additionally meet pH-Specific values provided in Appendix B, TABLE C. RCRA 8 Inorganics tested with SPLP must meet values shown for Class II groundwater in 742 Appendix B TABLE E. D. Name, Address and Telephone number of the analytical testing laboratory that will be used by the Contractor to perform the environmental analytical testing for backfill, top soil and CU Structural Soil samples prior to starting work. The laboratory performing the analysis must be an IEPA-accredited laboratory. E. Name, Company, Address and Telephone number of environmental consultant who performed sampling analysis and their specific handling criteria for each sample collected. Consultant to provide soil classification for each homogeneous volume encountered at source site, source site visit notes as it relates to observing potential source of contamination surrounding the potential source site. F. Source of all imported materials including but not limited to the address of the source site, latitude/longitude of source material locations on 10-acre plot, the name of the owner of the source materials, the location where the source materials derived from at the source site, phone number of the owner contact of the source materials, history of the site usage (i.e. farm, residential, industrial/commercial, etc.) Rev. 07/29/2013 Park # 569 02318 - 2 BACKFILL, TOPSOIL ENV REQUIREMENTS 1.5 G. Report defining the current and historic uses of the clean soil source material to determine if the potential for any source contamination is present. Report to include regulatory environmental database search of site and surrounding properties. H. Copies of all daily reports, transport records and receipts to the owner Authorized Representative on a daily basis. SUBMITTAL REVIEW A. Review of submittals or any comments made does not relieve the Contractor from compliance with the requirements of the drawings and specifications. The purpose of this check is to review for general conformance with the design concept of the project and general compliance with the information given in the contract documents. The Contractor is responsible for confirming and correlating all quantities and dimensions; electing techniques of construction; coordinating the Work; and performing the Work in a safe and satisfactory manner. B. The Contractor must not begin any Work applicable to this section until all required submittals have been reviewed and accepted by the owner Authorized representative. PART 2 - PRODUCTS 2.1. BACKFILL, TOP SOIL, CU STRUCTURAL SOIL A. The contractor shall supply only backfill, top soil and CU Structural Soil that does not exceed APPENDIX B, SECTION 742, TABLE A; TIERED APPROACH TO CORRECTIVE ACTION OBJECTIVES (TACO): 35 ILL. ADM. CODE 742 values for 35 ILL. ADM CODE 740 APPENDIX A Target Compound List (TCL) parameters, Total Petroleum Hydrocarbons (TPH-GRO+DRO), and SPLP Testing for RCRA 8 metals. For Target Compound Listed parameters known as PNAs, Appendix A TABLE H (Concentrations of Polynuclear Hydrocarbon Chemicals in background Soils) values may be used. For samples from virgin sources, if no letter certifying virgin material is received, one representative sample must be analyzed for 35 ILL. ADM CODE 740 APPENDIX A Target Compound List (TCL) parameters, Total Petroleum Hydrocarbons (TPH-GRO+DRO), and SPLP Testing for RCRA 8 metals. For inorganic parameters over background values shown for metropolitan properties in Appendix A, TABLE G, SROs must additionally meet pH-Specific values provided in Appendix B, TABLE C. RCRA 8 Inorganics tested with SPLP must meet values shown for Class II groundwater in 742 Appendix B TABLE E. No recycled stone/concrete will be permitted. A copy of the analytical results shall be submitted at least one week prior to depositing backfill or top soil on site. The date of the analysis shall be within 60 days of importing such material to the project. All material types must obtain samples at a rate of one approved sample per 1,000 imported cubic yards. B. A summary of the sample collection and data analysis. The report should include a tabulation of sampling results compared to applicable Tier 1 remediation objectives for residential properties, including pH-specific values for inorganics and SPLP testing for RCRA 8 metals. Rev. 07/29/2013 Park # 569 02318 - 3 BACKFILL, TOPSOIL ENV REQUIREMENTS PART 3 - EXECUTION 3.1 3.2 3.3 AUTHORIZATIONS A. Haulers for transportation of backfill, top soil or CU Structural Soil shall hold and present upon request a current, valid Commercial Driver’s License (CDL). B. Contractor shall have written approval from the owner Authorized Representative prior to importing any backfill, top soil, or CU Structural Soil to the site. MATERIAL SAMPLING A. The Contractor shall collect sufficient amount of representative (no composite samples) backfill, top soil and CU Structural Soil sample(s) for analytical testing sufficient to verify that these materials do not exceed APPENDIX B, SECTION 742, TABLE A; TIERED APPROACH TO CORRECTIVE ACTION OBJECTIVES (TACO): 35 ILL. ADM. CODE 742 values for 35 ILL. ADM CODE 740 APPENDIX A Target Compound List (TCL) parameters, Total Petroleum Hydrocarbons (TPH-GRO+DRO), and SPLP Testing for RCRA 8 metals. For Target Compound Listed parameters known as PNAs, Appendix A TABLE H (Concentrations of Polynuclear Hydrocarbon Chemicals in background Soils) values may be used. For samples from virgin sources, if no letter certifying virgin material is received, one representative sample must be analyzed for 35 ILL. ADM CODE 740 APPENDIX A Target Compound List (TCL) parameters, Total Petroleum Hydrocarbons (TPH-GRO+DRO), and SPLP Testing for RCRA 8 metals. For inorganic parameters over background values shown for metropolitan properties in Appendix A, TABLE G, SROs must additionally meet pH-Specific values provided in Appendix B, TABLE C. RCRA 8 Inorganics tested with SPLP must meet values shown for Class II groundwater in 742 Appendix B TABLE E. The contractor is responsible for payment of all backfill, top soil and CU Structural Soil sampling and analytical fees. B. The EC may collect backfill, top soil or CU Structural Soil samples for laboratory analysis on behalf of the contractor at no additional cost to the project. C. The EC may need to collect samples for laboratory analysis or field Photo-ionization Detector (PID) screening, or liquid samples for laboratory analysis (as required by the owner in special circumstances.) The Contractor shall provide the necessary equipment and manpower to assist the EC to collect materials to be sampled at no additional cost to the project and in compliance with OSHA and all other Rules and Regulations. HAULING A. The Contractor shall not create dust and shall maintain adequate dust suppression equipment on site if conditions warrant. B. The Contractor shall maintain streets clean and free of mud and dirt. Rev. 07/29/2013 Park # 569 02318 - 4 BACKFILL, TOPSOIL ENV REQUIREMENTS C. 3.4 TRANSPORTATION A. B. C. 3.5 The Contractor shall place backfill, top soil and CU Structural Soil to ensure minimum interference with roads; streets, walks and other adjacent occupied and used facilities. Do not close or obstruct streets, walks or other occupied or used facilities without permission from the applicable governing agency and the owner Authorized Representative. Provide alternate routes around closed or obstructed traffic ways if required by the governing agency. The Contractor shall provide and complete copies of all daily reports, weight tickets and receipts (as applicable) for transportation and ultimate placement of the backfill, top soil, and CU Structural Soil to the owner Authorized Representative, Project Manager and/or EC for review and signature within seven (7) calendar days or as directed by the owner Authorized Representative. The Contractor shall maintain all applicable or potentially affected streets from their operations clean and free of mud and dirt. The Contractor shall schedule placement of backfill, top soil, and CU Structural Soil to ensure minimum interference with roads; streets, walks and other adjacent occupied and used facilities. Do not close or obstruct streets, walks or other occupied or used facilities without permission from the applicable governing agency and the Owner. Provide alternate routes around closed or obstructed traffic ways if required by the governing agency. BACKFILL A. The backfill material shall be granular or cohesive material that meets the project specified requirements. B. For each off-site source of backfill materials, the Contractor shall provide to the owner Authorized Representative, Project Manager and/or EC as required, environmental laboratory analyses and certification that the imported backfill does not exceed APPENDIX B, SECTION 742, TABLE A; TIERED APPROACH TO CORRECTIVE ACTION OBJECTIVES (TACO): 35 ILL. ADM. CODE 742 values for 35 ILL. ADM CODE 740 APPENDIX A Target Compound List (TCL) parameters, Total Petroleum Hydrocarbons (TPH-GRO+DRO), and SPLP Testing for RCRA 8 metals. For Target Compound Listed parameters known as PNAs, Appendix A TABLE H (Concentrations of Polynuclear Hydrocarbon Chemicals in background Soils) values may be used. For samples from virgin sources, if no letter certifying virgin material is received, one representative sample must be analyzed for 35 ILL. ADM CODE 740 APPENDIX A Target Compound List (TCL) parameters, Total Petroleum Hydrocarbons (TPHGRO+DRO), and SPLP Testing for RCRA 8 metals. For inorganic parameters over background values shown for metropolitan properties in Appendix A, TABLE G, SROs must additionally meet pH-Specific values provided in Appendix B, TABLE C. RCRA 8 Inorganics tested with SPLP must meet values shown for Class II groundwater in 742 Appendix B TABLE E. No recycled stone/concrete will be permitted. A copy of the analytical results shall be submitted at least one week prior to depositing backfill or top soil on site. The date of the analysis shall be within 60 days of importing such material to the project. All material types must obtain samples at a rate of one approved sample per 1,000 imported cubic yards. C. The contractor shall not import and/or place backfill material without approval of the owner Authorized Representative. If the Contractor imports backfill material and/or backfills the excavation area without obtaining approval from the owner Authorized Rev. 07/29/2013 Park # 569 02318 - 5 BACKFILL, TOPSOIL ENV REQUIREMENTS Representative, the backfill materials shall be excavated and disposed off site as per project specifications Section 02316, if required, at the Contractor’s expense. 3.6 3.7 TOP SOIL A. The Top Soil material shall meet the project specified requirements as referenced in Div 2 Section 02900 ”Plantings”. B. For each off-site source of top soil, the Contractor shall provide to the owner Authorized Representative as required, environmental laboratory analyses and certification that the imported top soil does not exceed APPENDIX B, SECTION 742, TABLE A; TIERED APPROACH TO CORRECTIVE ACTION OBJECTIVES (TACO): 35 ILL. ADM. CODE 742 values for 35 ILL. ADM CODE 740 APPENDIX A Target Compound List (TCL) parameters and SPLP Testing for RCRA 8 metals. For Target Compound Listed parameters known as PNAs, Appendix A TABLE H (Concentrations of Polynuclear Hydrocarbon Chemicals in background Soils) values may be used. For samples from virgin sources, if no letter certifying virgin material is received, one representative sample must be analyzed for 35 ILL. ADM CODE 740 APPENDIX A Target Compound List (TCL) parameters, Total Petroleum Hydrocarbons (TPH-GRO+DRO), and SPLP Testing for RCRA 8 metals. For inorganic parameters over background values shown for metropolitan properties in Appendix A, TABLE G, SROs must additionally meet pHSpecific values provided in Appendix B, TABLE C. RCRA 8 Inorganics tested with SPLP must meet values shown for Class II groundwater in 742 Appendix B TABLE E. No recycled stone/concrete will be permitted. A copy of the analytical results shall be submitted at least one week prior to depositing backfill or top soil on site. The date of the analysis shall be within 60 days of importing such material to the project. All material types must obtain samples at a rate of one approved sample per 1,000 imported cubic yards. C. The contractor shall not import and/or place top soil without approval of the owner Authorized Representative. If the Contractor imports and/or places top soil without obtaining approval from the owner Authorized Representative, the top soil shall be excavated and disposed off site as per project specifications Section 02316, if required, at the Contractor’s expense. CU STRUCTURAL SOIL A. CU Structural Soil shall consist of a uniformly blended mixture of crushed stone, clay, loam and hydrogel by weight consisting of approximately 83% crushed limestone (3/4 to 1.5 inch, highly angular with no fines), 17% clay loam and hydrogel (1 oz. per 200 pounds of stone). B. For each off-site source of CU Structural Soil, the Contractor shall provide to the owner Authorized Representative, Project Manager and/or EC, as required, environmental laboratory analyses and certification that the imported materials do not exceed APPENDIX B, SECTION 742, TABLE A; TIERED APPROACH TO CORRECTIVE ACTION OBJECTIVES (TACO): 35 ILL. ADM. CODE 742 values for 35 ILL. ADM CODE 740 APPENDIX A Target Compound List (TCL) parameters, Total Petroleum Hydrocarbons (TPH-GRO+DRO), and SPLP Testing for RCRA 8 metals. For Target Compound Listed parameters known as PNAs, Appendix A TABLE H (Concentrations of Polynuclear Hydrocarbon Chemicals in background Soils) values may be used. For samples from virgin sources, if no letter certifying virgin material is received, one representative sample must be analyzed for 35 ILL. ADM CODE 740 APPENDIX A Rev. 07/29/2013 Park # 569 02318 - 6 BACKFILL, TOPSOIL ENV REQUIREMENTS Target Compound List (TCL) parameters, Total Petroleum Hydrocarbons (TPHGRO+DRO), and SPLP Testing for RCRA 8 metals. For inorganic parameters over background values shown for metropolitan properties in Appendix A, TABLE G, SROs must additionally meet pH-Specific values provided in Appendix B, TABLE C. RCRA 8 Inorganics tested with SPLP must meet values shown for Class II groundwater in 742 Appendix B TABLE E. No recycled stone/concrete will be permitted. A copy of the analytical results shall be submitted at least one week prior to depositing backfill or top soil on site. The date of the analysis shall be within 60 days of importing such material to the project. All material types must obtain samples at a rate of one approved sample per 1,000 imported cubic yards. C. 3.8 3.9 The contractor shall not import and/or place CU Structural Soil without approval of the owner Authorized Representative. If the Contractor imports and/or places CU Structural Soil without obtaining approval from the owner Authorized Representative, the CU Structural Soil shall be excavated and disposed off site as per project specifications Section 02316, if required, at the Contractor’s expense. DUST CONTROL A. The Contractor shall control dust by all necessary means, including but not limited to covering trucks, stockpiles and open materials, watering haul roads, sweeping paved roads, and limiting the speed of all on-site vehicles. B. The Contractor shall prevent vehicles from tracking mud off site. Contractor shall perform all necessary activities to keep roadways clean throughout each day and for the duration of the project. QUALITY CONTROL A. The Contractor shall take all necessary precautions to protect structures, equipment, pavement, walks and utilities against movement or settlement during the course of work. B. Damages: Promptly replace or repair any damage caused to adjacent pavement, utilities or facilities by removal operations at no additional cost. Work shall be performed to the satisfaction of the OWNER Authorized Representative. C. Utility Services: Maintain existing utilities and protect against damage during placement of backfill, top soil and CU Structural Soil. D. Visual Inspections: Perform visual inspections of each load of imported material to ensure that it is in conformance with the approved source and reject any material that has not been approved. E. Submittal Timeframe Compliance: Ensure that approved source data submitted is in compliance with time frames specified. F. Imported Material Inspections: Perform periodic checks of fill source locations to identify any change in material characteristics, as applicable. END OF SECTION 02318 Rev. 07/29/2013 Park # 569 02318 - 7 BACKFILL, TOPSOIL ENV REQUIREMENTS SECTION 02440 ARTIFICIAL TURF 1.01 WORK INCLUDED A. Furnish all labor, materials, tools and equipment necessary to install all artificial grass turf as indicated on the plans and as specified herein. The installation of all new materials shall be performed in strict accordance with the manufacturer’s installation instructions and in accordance with all approved shop drawings. B. Perimeter edge details required for the system shall be as detailed and recommended by the Manufacturer, and as approved by the Owner. If applicable, supply and installation of these details will be under the scope of work of the contractor (see Section 02720- Aggregate Base Course: Sub-base material), not that of the artificial turf Installer. 1.02 RELATED SECTIONS A. Section 02310 - Site Grading. B. Section 02300 – Excavation and Earthwork D. Section 02720- Aggregate Base Course E. Section 12001 - Site Furnishings 1.03 REFERENCES A. FM P7825 - Approval Guide; Factory Mutual Research Corporation; current edition B. ASTM Standard Test Methods: D1577 D5848 D418 D1338 D1682 D5034 - Standard Test Method for Linear Density of Textile Fiber - Standard Test Method for Mass Per Unit Area of Pile Yarn Floor Covering - Standard Test Method for Testing Pile Yarn Floor Covering Construction - Standard Test Method for Tuft Bind of Pile Yarn Floor Coverings - Standard Method of Test for Breaking Load and Elongation of Textile Fabrics - Standard Test Method of Breaking Strength and Elongation of Textile Fabrics (Grab Test) F1015 - Standard Test Method for Relative Abrasiveness of Synthetic Turf Playing Surfaces D4491 - Standard Test Methods for Water Permeability of Geo-textiles by Permittivity D2859 - Standard Test Method for Ignition Characteristics of Finished Textile Floor Covering Materials F355 - Standard Test Method for Shock-Absorbing Properties of Playing Surfaces. F1936 - Standard Test Method for Shock-Absorbing Properties of North American Football Field Playing Systems as Measured in the Field C. NCAA and/or National Federation Football Rules and Interpretations; FIFA Rules of the Game; FIH Rules Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA ARTIFICIAL TURF 02440-1 1.04 SUBMITTALS A. Prior to the Architect approval of a specified artificial turf system, the Manufacturer shall specify in writing that bidding their turf system does not violate any other manufacturers’ patents, patents allowed or patents pending and by so stating agrees to hold the Owner harmless and defend against any legal actions undertaken as a result of patent litigation. C. Submit the following with the Bid/Proposal: 1. Submit two samples, 6x6 inch in size, illustrating details of finished product. 2. A letter and specification sheet certifying that the products of this section meet or exceed specified requirements. 3. Certified copies of independent (third-party) laboratory reports on ASTM tests as follows: a) Pile Height & Total Fabric Weight, ASTM D418 or D5848 b) Primary & Secondary Backing Weights, ASTM D418 or D5848 4. A sand infill field in play for at least 8 years in the United States. 5. The Turf Contractor and the turf Manufacturer (if different from the company) shall provide a evidence—either in the form of an executed Policy (not a sample policy or Certificate) or a certified letter from the insurance carrier --that it offers an eight (8) year pre-paid, non-cancelable warranty insurance policy underwritten by a Best A rated carrier (or a Warranty Bond) for a minimum annual aggregate of $5,000,000. The policy must cover catastrophic failure of the turf area. 6. The Turf Manufacturer shall show certified evidence that it has in place a minimum $500,000 in cash in a separate warranty reserve account (not a accounting line item) for small Warranty repairs. D. Prior to ordering of materials: 1. The Contractor shall submit Shop Drawings indicating: a) Turf Layout b) Roll/Seaming Layout d) Methods of attachment, field openings and perimeter conditions. 2. The turf Manufacturer must submit the fiber manufacturer's name, type or design of fiber, composition of fiber, and cross-section of the fiber. E. Prior to Final Acceptance, the Contractor shall submit to the Owner: 1. Three (3) copies of Maintenance Manuals, which will include all necessary instructions for the proper care and preventative maintenance of the synthetic turf system, including painting and markings. 2. Project Record Documents: Record actual locations of seams, drains or other pertinent information. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA ARTIFICIAL TURF 02440-2 3. Warranty: Submit Manufacturer Warranty and ensure that forms have been completed in Owner's name and registered with Manufacturer and insurance carrier. 1.05 QUALITY ASSURANCE A. Manufacturer Qualifications: Company specializing in manufacturing products specified in this section. The Turf Manufacturer shall also act as turf installer. 1. Must be experienced in the manufacture and installation of this specific type of synthetic infill grass system for at least 8 years. 2. Must have a NCAA division 1 football field in play for at least 5 seasons. 3. Must have a football field in league play in the NFL for at least 4 seasons. 4. Must have a sand/rubber infill field in play for at least 8 years in the United States. 5. Must have installed a minimum of 5 Turf areas or more in the United States in the past two years with the same fiber manufacturer and product; and the same infill system, that is being proposed for this field B. Installer Qualifications: Company specializing in performing the work of this section. 1. The Turf Contractor must provide competent workmen skilled in this specific type of synthetic grass installation. 2. The designated Supervisory Personnel on the project must be certified, in writing by the turf Manufacturer, as competent in the installation of this material, including sewing seams and proper installation of the infill mixture. 3. The Manufacturer shall act as the turf installer. 4. The installation team must be skilled in sewing seams and installing inlaid markings by means of shearing and hot melting turf fabric. Glued seams and inlays cut into the backing and glued to reinforcing tape are not acceptable. C. Prior to the beginning of installation, the Installer of the synthetic turf shall inspect the sub-base. The installer will accept the sub-base in writing when the owner provides test results for compaction, a survey detailing planarity and tests on permeability that are in compliance with the synthetic turf manufacturer’s specifications or guidelines. The Installer shall have the dimensions of the field and locations for markings measured by a registered surveyor to verify conformity to the specifications and applicable standards. D. The Turf Contractor shall provide the necessary testing data to the owner that the finished field meets the required shock attenuation, as per ASTM F1936. 1.06 PRE-INSTALLATION MEETING A. Convene one week before starting work of this section. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA ARTIFICIAL TURF 02440-3 1.07 DELIVERY, STORAGE, AND PROTECTION A. Deliver products to project site in wrapped condition. B. Store products under cover and elevated above grade. 1.08 WARRANTIES A. See Section 01700 – Project Closeout for additional warranty requirements. B. The turf Manufacturer shall provide a Warranty to the owner that covers defects in materials and workmanship of the turf for a period of 8 years from the date of Substantial Completion. The turf manufacturer must verify that their work conforms to the manufacturer’s requirements. C. The Manufacturer’s Warranty shall include general wear and damage caused from UV degradation. The warranty shall specifically exclude vandalism, and acts of God beyond the control of the owner or the manufacturer, abuse and neglect. D. The turf Manufacturer's Warranty must be supported by a prepaid, non-cancelable insurance policy for the full eight (8) year period, or an 8 year Warranty Bond. The policy must be underwritten by a Best A Rated insurance carrier or better and must have and annual aggregate of $5,000,000 and a per claim minimum of at least $600,000 to provide for full removal and replacement of the turf, if failure occurs. E. The Turf Manufacturer shall provide a Warranty to the owner that covers defects in the installation workmanship, and further warrant that the installation was done in accordance with its recommendations and other written directives of the Manufacturer’s onsite representative. F. The artificial turf must maintain an ASTM 355 G-max of between 110-200 for the life of the Warranty. The initial installation must have a Gmax of less than 135 G’s upon completion, per ASTM F 1936. 1.09 MAINTENANCE SERVICE A. The Turf Contractor will train the Owner's facility maintenance staff in the use of the turf Manufacturer's recommended sweeper and groomer. PART 2 PRODUCTS 2.01 MANUFACTURERS A. Approved manufacturers are as follows: 1. FieldTurf International Inc. 5211 Mitchell Bridge Road Dalton, GA 30721 USA Tel: (800)…724-2969 Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA ARTIFICIAL TURF 02440-4 Model: Field Turf Duraspine Or approved equal. 2.02 MATERIALS A. The component materials of the artificial grass field turf System consist of: 1. A Carpet made of “spined” monofilament polyethylene fibers tufted into a fibrous, nonperforated, porous backing. 2. An Infill that has at least two distinct layers: a. a controlled, homogeneous mixture of graded silica sand. Note: A bottom layer of pure silica sand is permissible, even preferred. 3. Glue, thread, paint, seaming fabric and other materials used to install and mark the artificial grass field turf. B. The installed artificial grass field turf shall have the following properties: Standard ---- Property Fiber type Specification Polyethylene (extruded through a spinneret), thickness to be nominal 120 microns through center of fiber “vein” or “spine”. Flat monofilaments are not acceptable. ASTM D1577 ASTM D418/D5848 ASTM D418/D5848 Fiber Denier Pile Height Pile Weight >9000 nominal 2 1/2” nominal Nominal 36 (+/- 2) oz./sq. ASTM D1335 ASTM D1682/D5034 ASTM D1682/D5034 ASTM F1015 ASTM D4491 ASTM F355/F1936 Tuft Bind Grab Tear (width) Grab Tear (length) Relative Abrasiveness Index Carpet Permeability Impact Attenuation, Gmax 7-8 lbs. (with infill) 200 lbs/force 200 lbs/force <25 >15 inches/hour =<135 at installation =<200 over field life yd. C. The Carpet shall consist of fibers tufted into a primary backing with a secondary coating. 1. The Carpet shall be furnished in 15’ wide rolls. Rolls shall be long enough to run from sideline to sideline without splicing. The perimeter white line shall be tufted into the individual sideline rolls. Head seams, other than at sidelines, will not be acceptable 2. The Carpet’s primary backing shall be a double-layered polypropylene fabric treated with UV inhibitors. The secondary coating shall consist of an application of porous, heat-activated urethane to permanently lock the fiber tufts in place. Perforated (i.e. with punched or burned holes) backed carpet shall not be acceptable 3. The fiber shall be 9,000 denier, low friction, UV-resistant fiber measuring not less than 2 ½ inches in finished height. The same fiber from the above listed projects (Section 1.04, art. C. 5) must be used on this project. Systems with less than a 2 ½ - inch fiber and/or shock pad enhancements will not be accepted as equivalent. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA ARTIFICIAL TURF 02440-5 4. The fiber cross-section shall be such that a thicker “spine” shall run through the center of the fiber, providing additional resilience and memory to the fiber. 5. The fiber must be a true monofilament, extruded through a spinneret, and developed specifically for outdoor sports fields, not landscape applications. Fiber shall have a center spine that is larger that the flat outer portions of the fiber. D. The Infill materials shall be approved by the Manufacturer. The Infill shall consist of a resilient layered granular system, comprising selected and graded dust-free silica sand and cryogenically processed SBR rubber granules. Artificial Grass products without a mix of silica sand and cryogenically processed rubber—and a finish application of straight rubber cryogenically processed--will not be acceptable. The sand component of the infill must represent a minimum of 60% or more of the total infill, by weight. E. Non-tufted or inlaid lines and markings shall be painted with paint approved by the synthetic turf Manufacturer. F. Thread for sewing seams of turf shall be as recommended by the synthetic turf Manufacturer. G. Glue and seaming fabric for inlaying lines and markings shall be as recommended by the synthetic turf Manufacturer. All turf roll seams must be sewn. Inlays shall be installed without cutting into the backing of the turf—they shall be sheared and applied using special hot melt adhesive. H. Systems that do not have a 2 ½ inch pile height and a sand and rubber Infill (as described in Section 2.02, Item D) are not acceptable. If the Infill system contains less than 60% sand, by weight, and at least 3 pounds per square foot of rubber, then the turf must be placed over a separate, shock-absorbing pad. Shock pad shall be an elastic layer pad, no less than 25 mm in thickness. PART 3 EXECUTION 3.01 GENERAL A. The installation shall be performed in full compliance with approved Shop Drawings. B. Only trained technicians, skilled in the installation of athletic caliber synthetic turf systems working under the direct supervision of the approved installer supervisors, shall undertake any cutting, sewing, gluing, shearing, topdressing or brushing operations. C. The designated Supervisory personnel on the project must be certified, in writing by the turf Manufacturer, as competent in the installation of this material, including sewing seams and proper installation of the Infill mixture. 3.02 EXAMINATION A. Verify that all sub-base, drainage and leveling is complete prior to installation. B. The surface to receive the synthetic turf shall be inspected by the Installer, and prior to the beginning of installation, the Installer must accept the sub-base in writing. The acceptance may Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA ARTIFICIAL TURF 02440-6 depend on the owner providing the installer with test results indicating that compaction, planarity and permeability are in compliance with the synthetic turf manufacturer’s specifications. The surface must be perfectly clean as installation commences and shall be maintained in that condition throughout the process. C. If applicable, the compaction of the aggregate base shall be 95%, according to the Modified Proctor procedure (ASTM D1557), and the surface tolerance shall not exceed 0-1/4 inch over 10 feet and 0-½" from design grade. Owner or site contractor shall furnish evidence of same for the field prior to commencement of the turf installation. 3.03 INSTALLATION A. Install in accordance with Manufacturer's instructions. The Turf Installer shall strictly adhere to the installation procedures outlined under this section. Any variance from these requirements must be accepted in writing, by the Manufacturer’s onsite representative, and submitted to the Architect/Owner, verifying that the changes do not in any way affect the warranty. Infill materials shall be approved by the Manufacturer and installed in accordance with the Manufacturer’s standard procedures. B. The carpet rolls are to be installed directly over the properly prepared aggregate base or other suitable base. Extreme care should be taken to avoid disturbing the aggregate base, both in regard to compaction and planarity. It is suggested that a 2-5 ton static roller is on site and available to repair and properly compact any disturbed areas of the aggregate base. C. The full width rolls shall be laid out across the field. Turf shall be of sufficient length to permit full cross-field installation from sideline to sideline. No head or cross seams will be allowed in the main playing area between the sidelines. Utilizing standard state of the art sewing procedures, each roll shall be sewn properly to the next. When all of the rolls of the playing surface have been installed, the sideline areas shall be installed at right angles to the playing field turf. These rolls shall be sewn as well. D. This is a basically sewn installation. Gluing of roll seams shall not be acceptable. Minimum gluing will only be permitted to repair problem areas, corner completions, and to install any logos or inlaid lines as required by the specifications. All seams shall be sewn using double bagger stitches and polyester thread or adhered using seaming tape and high grade adhesive (per the manufacturer’s standard procedures). Seams shall be flat, tight, and permanent with no separation or fraying. E. Infill materials shall be applied in numerous thin lifts. The turf shall be brushed as the mixture is applied. The infill material shall be installed to a depth determined by the Manufacturer. F. The Infill materials shall be installed to fill the voids between the fibers and allow the fibers to remain vertical and non-directional. The Infill installation consists of a base layer of sand. The Infill shall be placed so that there is a void of ¾” to the top of the fibers. G. Synthetic turf shall be attached to the perimeter edge detail in accordance with the Manufacturer’s standard procedures. 3.04 CLEANING A. Protect installed Turf from subsequent construction operations. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA ARTIFICIAL TURF 02440-7 B. Do not permit traffic over unprotected floor surface. C. Contractor shall provide the labor, supplies, and equipment as necessary for final cleaning of surfaces and installed items. D. All usable remnants of new material shall be come the property of the Owner. E. The Contractor shall keep the area clean throughout the project and clear of debris. F. Surfaces, recesses, enclosures, etc., shall be cleaned as necessary to leave the work area in a clean, immaculate condition ready for immediate occupancy and use by the Owner. END OF SECTION 02440 Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA ARTIFICIAL TURF 02440-8 SECTION 02510 WATER DISTRIBUTION PART 1 – GENERAL 1.1 RELATED DOCUMENTS A. B. 1.2 SUMMARY A. 1.3 Drawings Book 1: Project Information, Instructions to Bidders, and Execution Documents This section includes the requirements for the installation of water services 1-inch in diameter as shown on the Drawings and specified here. REFERENCES A. B. C. D. E. F. G. H. I. J. K. L. M. N. O. P. Q. R. S. T. U. V. W. X. Y. AWWA C104 - Cement Mortar Lining for Ductile Iron Pipe and Fittings. AWWA C105 - Polyethylene Encasement for Ductile-Iron Pipe Systems. AWWA C110 - Ductile-Iron and Gray-Iron Fittings. AWWA C111 - Rubber Rubber-Gasket Joints for Ductile-Iron Pressure Pipe and Fittings. AWWA C115 - Flanged Ductile-Iron Pipe with Ductile-Iron or Gray-Iron Threaded Flanges. AWWA C116 - Protective Fusion-Bonded Epoxy Coatings Int. and Ext. Surf. DuctileIron/Gray-Iron Fittings. AWWA C150 - Thickness Design of Ductile-Iron Pipe. AWWA C151 - Ductile Iron Pipe, Centrifugally Cast. AWWA C153 - Ductile Iron Compact Fittings for Water Service. ASME/ANSI B16.1 - Flanges and Flanged Fittings. ANSI B16.21 - Metallic Gaskets for Pipe Flanges. ASME B18.2.1 - Square and Hex Bolts and Screws. ASME B18.2.2 - Square and Hex Nuts. ASTM A123 – Zinc (Hot Dip Galvanized) Coatings on Iron and Steel Products. ASTM A153 - Zinc Coating (Hot Dip) on Iron and Steel. ASTM A240 – Chromium and Chromium-Nickel Stainless Steel Plate, Sheet and Strip, for Pressure Vessels and for General Applications. ASTM A307 - Carbon Steel Bolts and Studs. ASTM A536 - Ductile Iron Castings. ASTM A767 – Zinc Coated (galvanized) Steel. ASTM A775 – Epoxy Coated Steel. ASTM A780-93 – Repair of Zinc Coated (Galvanized) Steel. ASTM B308 – Stainless Steel Alloy Standard Structural Shapes, Rolled, or Extruded. ASTM C564 - Rubber Gaskets for Cast Iron Soil Pipe and Fittings. ANSI A21.5/AWWA C105 - Polyethylene Encasement. City of Chicago Plumbing Code. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA WATER DISTRIBUTION 02510 - 1 Z. 1.4 1.5 1.6 Follow latest edition of the above references, unless noted by year of issue. SUBMITTALS A. Shop Drawings, Product Data, Records and Samples are to be submitted by the Contractor. B. The Contractor shall give notice in writing to the Owner, sufficiently in advance of contractor’s intention to purchase or place a special order for any pipe required to be installed under this contract. Fully dimensioned drawings and/or manufactures catalog cuts are to be submitted for review. C. The Contractor shall submit certified copies of all test reports for test conducted on the pipe by the manufacturer. D. The Contractor shall provide a notarized statement that all tests have been made and met as specified. QUALITY ASSURANCE A. Each manufacturer supplying pipe for water mains under this contract shall furnish all facilities, personnel, and materials to conduct tests required as applicable to the type of pipe being supplied. The cost of all plant tests required as proof of the acceptability of the water main pipe will be considered incidental to the Work and no additional payment will be allowed. B. The Work performed on joining all pipe and fittings, shall be performed by a plumber licensed in the State of Illinois or the City. This Work shall include, but not be limited to, joining all pipe and fittings, installing joint gaskets, assembling all joints, installing continuity wedges, and tightening all gland nuts and bolts, as applicable for the installation. NOTIFICATION AND LIMITATIONS OF WATER MAIN SHUT DOWNS A. Whenever an existing water main or a section thereof is to be shut down during the course of construction, every individual consumer shall be notified at least seventy-two (72) hours prior to the shut down. The Contractor shall never operate, under any circumstances, an existing valve for a shut down or other purpose without first notifying and obtaining approval from the Commissioner. B. The time for a consumer shut down shall not exceed eight (8) hours. Absolutely no shut downs will be permitted before 8:00 AM without approval from the Commissioner. C. In case of emergency shut downs, the Contractor shall notify customers immediately. Notification may be verbal on a door-to-door basis. However, if a consumer cannot be contacted, a written notice shall be placed at the property site showing all pertinent information regarding the shut down. The notice shall show a telephone number the consumer may call for information or to express any problem that the consumer may have with the shut down. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA WATER DISTRIBUTION 02510 - 2 D. If a consumer cannot withstand a planned shut down due to a dialysis machine being present or other medical reason, the Commissioner shall be notified immediately. PART 2 – PRODUCTS 2.1 2.2 2.2 DRINKING FOUNTAIN A. Design is based upon “Most Dependable Fountains, Inc.” Model: 2008SM, triple bubbler manufactured by Most Dependable Fountains, Inc., 5705 Commander Drive, Arlington, TN 38002. Telephone: 800.552.6331 ; 901.867.0039; Fax: 901.867.0159 B. Color: Black C. Pipe and fittings to be Type K copper unless shown otherwise on plans. Insure that a slope is consistently applied to all piping to ensure positive gravity-assisted drainage or the entire system. Ensure all fittings are secured to close openings (off season) to protect water entry back into the piping system. COPPER PIPE, TYPE K A. Seamless copper water tube shall meet the requirements of ASTM B 88, Type K wall. B. Seamless copper pipe shall meet the requirements of ANSI H26.1, ASTM B 42, FS WWP-377d, or ASME SB-42. C. Threadless copper pipe shall meet the requirements of ANSI H26.2 or ASTM B 302. D. Seamless copper tube shall meet the requirements of ANSI H23.3, ASTM B 75, or FS WW-T-797c. E. Copper drainage tube, Type DWV shall meet the requirements of ANSI H23.6, ASTM B 306, or CS 229-60. F. Copper water tube, Types K, L, and M shall meet the requirements of ANSI H23.1, ASTM B 88, FS WW-T-799b-1970, or FSWW-T-799b-1963. DUCTILE IRON PIPE A. Ductile iron pipe shall conform to the requirements of AWWA C151 and with the additions or substitutions specified in this Section. B. Pipe bells shall be designed to provide a watertight joint without leakage and shall be capable of withstanding pressures exceeding those that will rupture pipe of this class and thickness without requiring additional jointing material. C. Electrical conductivity shall be provided at each joint on all push-on and mechanical jointed pipe 16-inches in diameter and smaller, to facilitate thawing of frozen pipe and building water services. Conductivity is to be accomplished by installing serrated silicon wedges as recommended or supplied by the pipe manufacture. The use of lead tip gaskets will not be allowed. Wedges are to be installed in accordance with the requirements of paragraph C in Articles 3.6 of this specification. D. All pipes shall be manufactured so that where a cut is made at any point along the barrel, the cut end will fit properly into a standard mechanical joint bell and be drip tight at Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA WATER DISTRIBUTION 02510 - 3 hydrostatic test pressure. 2.3 2.4 E. Exterior of pipe shall be coated with a petroleum asphaltic material in conformance with AWWA C110, Section 10-10. Interior of pipe shall be cement lined in accordance with AWWA C104. F. Pipe thickness and classes shall conform to standards shown in Table A. JOINTS A. LEAD JOINTS ARE NOT TO BE USED UNDER ANY CIRCUMSTANCES. B. Pipe joints shall be push-on type joints unless otherwise noted. Push-on type joints shall conform to AWWA C111. C. Flanged joints, shall conform to the following: 1. Flanged joints shall conform to AWWA C115. Flanges shall be the long hub type, screwed on the threaded end of the pipe in the shop. There shall be no leakage through the pipe threads. The flanges shall be designed to prevent corrosion of the threads from the outside. 2. Flanges shall be drilled according to the requirements of ANSI/ASME B16.1, Class 125 unless special drilling is called for on the Drawings. Bolt holes shall be equally spaced, drilled smooth and true. When stud bolts are used flanges shall be drilled and tapped to accommodate the studs. 1. The face of the screwed-on flange and plain-end of the pipe shall be accurately refaced together, at right angles to the pipe axis. After facing and drilling, the face of the screwed-on flange shall immediately be covered with an appropriate rust-preventive coating. 2. Flanged joints shall be secured with either bolts and nuts, or stud bolts with a nuts. Bolts, stud bolts, and nuts shall meet the requirements of ASTM A307, Grade B. Bolts and stud bolts shall conform to ANSI/ASME B18.2.1. Nuts shall conform to ANSI/ASME B18.2.2. All bolts, stud bolts, and nuts shall be primed with bitumastic paint after the bolts and nuts have been installed and tightened. 5. Gaskets shall conform to Section 2.4 of this specification. FITTINGS A. Fittings to be furnished and installed as specified or shown on the Drawings shall be mechanical joint, ductile iron in accordance with AWWA C110. Laying length of mechanical joint castings shall be as shown in AWWA C110. Wall thickness and allowable variation in the thickness of mechanical joint castings shall conform to AWWA C110 and have a 250-psi pressure rating. B. Compact fittings may not be used unless otherwise approved by the Architect. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA WATER DISTRIBUTION 02510 - 4 2.5 2.6 C. Plain ends of mechanical joint fittings shall be beveled and gauged to properly seat in push-on joint bells. D. The fittings shall be smooth and free from defects of every nature that would make them unfit for the use that they were intended. Plugging of fittings is not allowed. Repairing of defects by welding will be allowed if such repairs will not adversely affect the serviceability of the fittings or their ability to meet the strength requirements of the referenced AWWA standards. E. All castings shall be coated inside and outside with a petroleum asphaltic material in conformance with Section 4.3 of AWWA C110. A cement-mortar lining is not required. F. Flanged fittings shall conform to AWWA C110, and have a 150-pound per square inch pressure rating. GASKETS A. All gaskets for pipe, fittings and appurtenances shall be vulcanized natural or vulcanized synthetic rubber, non-porous, free of foreign materials and visible defects. Recycled rubber may not be used. B. When soil conditions do not permit the use of natural or synthetic rubber gaskets all gaskets for pipe, fittings and appurtenances shall be Nitrile (acrylonitrile butadiene), nonporous, free of foreign materials and visible defects. C. Gaskets for flanged joints shall be of the ring type, 1/16-inch thick, and meet the requirements of ANSI Standard B16.21. Acceptable manufactures for gaskets type as manufactured by the Crane Company; Garlock Packing Company; or U.S. Rubber Company. D. Gaskets shall be stored in a cool place and protected from light, heat, oil, or grease until installed. Any gasket showing signs of cracking, weathering, abrasion or other deterioration will be rejected. POLYETHYLENE ENCASEMENT A. Polyethylene encasement material shall be 4-mil, cross-laminated, high-density polyethylene tubing in accordance with AWWA C105. PART 3 - EXECUTION 3.1 INSTALLATION A. All ductile iron pipe, fittings, and appurtenances shall be installed in accordance with the manufacturer’s recommendations and requirements. B. All pipe, fittings, and accessories shall be delivered, unloaded, strung, and laid as specified here. C. The water service pipe shall be laid with depths of cover as indicated under Article 3.10 of this specification, unless otherwise shown on the drawings. The pipes Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA WATER DISTRIBUTION 02510 - 5 shall be laid true to line and grade. D. 3.2 3.3 Fittings as specified shall be used where shown on the drawings and where grade or alignment changes require offsets greater than those recommended by the pipe manufacturer. TRANSPORTATION AND DELIVERY A. Every precaution shall be taken to prevent damage to the pipe during transportation and delivery. Extreme care shall be taken in loading and unloading the pipe and fittings. Such work shall be done slowly with skids or suitable power equipment and the pipe shall be under complete control at all times. Under no conditions may the pipe be dropped, bumped, dragged, pushed, or moved in any way that will cause damage to the pipe. When handling the pipe with a crane, a suitable pipe hook or rope sling around the pipe shall be used. Under no condition may the sling be allowed to pass through the pipe unless adequate measures are taken to prevent damage to the pipe ends and lining. B. If in the process of transportation, handling, or installation, any pipe or fitting is damaged, such pipe or fitting shall be replaced by the Contractor and be considered incidental to the construction and no additional payment will be allowed. C. The Contractor shall prevent the pipe from rolling. The procedures used to prevent rolling shall be approved by the Architect. PREPARATION FOR LAYING PIPE A. Materials, coatings, and linings shall be as specified herein, shown on drawings, or directed by the Owner. Water services shall be installed where shown on the drawings. Installation shall be in accordance with standards as recommended by the pipe manufacturer, and as specified herein. B. Proper and suitable tools and appliances for the safe and convenient cutting, handling, and laying of the pipe and fittings shall be used. C. Before lying, all pipe and fittings shall be thoroughly examined for defects and no piece may be installed which is known to be defective. If defects are discovered after pipe or fittings have been installed, the Contractor shall remove the defective pipe and/or fitting and replace it with a sound one at his expense and to the satisfaction of the Owner. D. The pipe and fittings shall be thoroughly cleaned before they are laid and shall be kept clean until they are accepted in the finished work. Care shall be exercised to avoid leaving bits of wood, dirt, rock and other foreign particles in the pipe. If any such materials are discovered before the final acceptance of the work, they shall be removed and the pipe and fittings replaced, if necessary. All pipes shall be kept absolutely clean during construction and shall be stopped off with night plugs at the end of each day's work. Exposed ends of uncompleted lines and existing water mains and services cut and not abandoned shall be capped or otherwise temporarily sealed at all times when pipe laying is not in progress. E. When cutting ductile iron pipe, it shall be neatly cut perpendicular to the longitudinal axis of the pipe without damaging the pipes lining or coating or jointing surface area. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA WATER DISTRIBUTION 02510 - 6 3.4 3.5 3.6 LAYING WATER SERVICE PIPE A. All pipelines shall be laid in trench excavations on bedding or other foundations, as shown on the drawings or specified herein. The pipe shall be properly secured against movement and pipe joints shall be made in the excavation as required. Pipes shall have solid bearing throughout their entire length. B. Polyethylene encasement is to be installed on all new water service pipe and fittings before pipe is installed and braced against movement. Care shall be taken so as not to damage the polyethylene encasement during the installation or blocking of the pipe and fittings. If damage occurs, the Contractor shall repair or replace the polyethylene encasement at his expense to the satisfaction of the Owner. C. Pipe lying will be permitted only in dry trenches having a stable bottom. Groundwater or water from other sources shall be removed as per Section 02240 – Dewatering. If the trench bottom is unsuitable for the pipes foundation, Contractor is to stabilize the trench bottom to the satisfaction of Owner. D. If the Contractor has failed to obtain an acceptably dry trench bottom using conventional methods of dewatering, the Owner may order the Contractor to excavate below the intended grade and to place sufficient sub-grade material as may be suitable over the trench bottom in accordance with Section 02300 – Excavation and Earthwork and Section 02222 - Trench Backfill. E. The Contractor shall also take such required precautions to prevent flotation of the new pipeline. ASSEMBLY OF FLANGED JOINTS A. Flanged joints shall be made with bolts or bolt studs with nuts as specified in Section 2.2 of this specification. B. Tighten flange bolts as recommended by the gasket manufacturer to ensure an evenly compressed gasket and leak tight joint. C. After the bolts and nuts have been properly installed, tightened, and cleaned, prime them with bitumastic paint. ASSEMBLY OF PUSH-ON RUBBER GASKET JOINTS A. Thoroughly brush the gasket seat in the bell with a wire brush and wipe the gasket and gasket seat with a cloth. Place the gasket in the socket with the large round end entering first so that the groove fits over the bead in the seat. Apply a thin film of NSF 61 approved joint lubricant to the inside surface of the gasket that will come into contact with the entering pipe. B. Thoroughly brush the plain end of the pipe with a wire brush and placed it in alignment with the bell of the pipe to which it is to be joined. Make up the joint by exerting sufficient force on the entering pipe so that its plain end is moved past the gasket until it makes contact with the base of the socket. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA WATER DISTRIBUTION 02510 - 7 C. Joints are to be made up to provide electrical continuity from one pipe to another by installing wedges as specified in Article 2.1, paragraph C of this specification and are to be installed in the following manner: 1. 3.7 TEMPORARY BULKHEADS A. 3.8 All cast and ductile iron pipe and fittings shall be encased in polyethylene tubing before being installed, blocked, or braced. USE OF DAMAGED, DEFECTIVE, OR NON-SPECIFIED CASTINGS AND FITTINGS A. 3.10 At ends of constructed sections where adjoining water mains or structures have not been completed and are not ready to be connected, temporary bulkheads shall be used. ENCASING DUCTILE IRON PIPE IN POLYETHYLENE A. 3.9 Use two (2) wedges per joint for 3-inch to 12-inch diameter pipes. Wedges shall be placed on opposite sides of the joint at an equal distance apart (9 and 3 o’clock positions) around the joint. All construction castings and pipe fittings that are determined to be damaged, defective or do not meet these specifications and are stored within the Work area shall be marked for non-use and removed and replaced with fittings that conform to these Specifications. DEPTH OF PIPE COVER A. Unless otherwise shown on the Plans, all water services shall be installed so a minimum pipe cover is achieved as shown in Table D. TABLE D – MINIMUM DEPTH OF COVER FOR WATER SERVICES Size of Pipe 3/4 to 3-inches 3.11 ABANDONMENT OF EXISTING WATER SERVICE PIPES A. 3.12 Depth of Cover 5-ft 6-inches + 3-inches All openings on abandoned pipe or conduit are to be sealed with a concrete mortar plug of a minimum of one (1) foot in length within the pipe. DISINFECTION OF PIPE AND FITTINGS A. Protect new and existing pipe and fittings from water, debris and foreign materials as specified in Section 02300 – “Excavation and Earthwork”. B. All new pipe, fittings, and valves shall be disinfected in accordance with “Disinfection and Testing of Water Mains”, as detailed in the latest edition of “Design Guidelines for Watermain Installation” of the City of Chicago, Department of Water Management and Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA WATER DISTRIBUTION 02510 - 8 the requirements of the Bureau of Water Quality which may be contacted at 312.744.8190. C. 3.13 SEPARATION BETWEEN WATER SERVICE AND SEWER A. 3.14 Swab all pipe and fittings that will not be pressure tested or chlorinated with a chlorine solution during installation. Extra precautions shall be taken to prevent debris or ground water from entering the section of water main to be swabbed. Incorporate untested section of water main into the flushing routine when the work is necessitated, or part of, a water main replacement project. When connecting pipes to the existing city water system use normal operating pressure to visually inspect for leaks. If feasible, inspect for leaks prior to backfilling the excavation. Comply with all standards and requirements of the Bureau of Water Quality. Water Service and Sewer shall have a clear vertical separation of 18 inches. If this separation is found to be less than 18 inches then the contractor is to immediately notify the Owner. TEST FOR CONTROL A. The Contractor shall perform water lines work to the requirement of DWM and obtain clearance approval from Department of Water Management (DWM) for the water distribution work performed by the Contractor, this may include water sample testing in the laboratory, leakage, etc. END OF SECTION 02510 Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA WATER DISTRIBUTION 02510 - 9 SECTION 02511 HOT-MIX ASPHALT PAVING PART 1 - GENERAL 1.1 RELATED DOCUMENTS A. B. 1.2 SUMMARY A. 1.3 Drawings Book 1: Project Information, Instructions to Bidders, and Execution Documents Section includes hot-mix asphalt paving and pavement markings required to complete the project. SUBMITTALS A. Product Data: Submit manufacturers’ product data for demonstrating compliance with specified requirements. B. Material Certificates: Provide copies of materials certificates signed by material producer and contractor, certifying that each material item complies with, or exceeds, specified requirements. C. LEED Submittals: 1. 2. 1.4 LEED Credit MR: Submit product data for products having recycled content, documentation indicating percentages by weight of post-consumer and preconsumer recycled content. a. Include statement indicating costs for each product having recycled content. LEED Credit MR: Submit product data for products that have extracted, harvested, or recovered, as well as manufactured within 500 miles of the Project site. a. Include a statement indicating the percentage by weight which is extracted, harvested, or recovered within 500 miles of the Project site. REFERENCES A. Specified references, or cited portions thereof, current at date of bidding documents unless otherwise specified, govern the work. B. Asphalt Institute (AI) : 1. ES-11 Asphalt Surface Treatments - Specifications. 2. ES-12 Asphalt Surface Treatments - Construction Techniques. 3. MS-1 Thickness Design - Asphalt Pavements for Highways and Streets. 4. MS-2 Mix Design Methods for Asphalt Concrete and Other Hot-Mix Types. 5. MS-5 Introduction to Asphalt. 6. MS-10 Soils Manual. 7. MS-14 Asphalt Cold-Mix Manual. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA HOT MIX ASPHALT PAVING 02511-1 8. 9. 1.5 MS-17 Asphalt Overlays for Highway and Street Rehabilitation. MS-22 Construction of Hot-Mix Asphalt Pavements. C. The American Society of Testing and Materials (ASTM): 1. ASTM D698 - Tests for Moisture-Density Relationship of Soils and SoilAggregate Mixtures, Using 5 Lb. Rammer and 12 in. Drop. D. Illinois Department of Transportation: 1. Standard Specifications for Road and Bridge Construction, January 2007, including all addenda. 2. Manual of Instructions for Bituminous Proportioning and Testing. TESTING & INSPECTION A. Testing and inspection of bituminous concrete mixes and testing of placed stabilized base course and bituminous concrete pavement will be performed by an independent testing laboratory employed by the Contractor. B. Allow testing laboratory access to mixing plant for verification of weights or proportions, character of materials used and determination of temperatures used in preparation of bituminous concrete mix. C. When requested, testing laboratory shall perform tests on proposed bituminous pavement mixes to determine conformity with specifications. D. Testing laboratory shall perform one series of compaction tests for stabilizing base course and for each bituminous pavement course. The Contractor shall pay for all costs of additional testing due to improper performance of work. E. When stabilizing base course, or portion thereof, has been placed and compacted in accord with specifications, notify testing laboratory to perform density tests. Do not place bituminous concrete pavement until satisfactory results have been verified and base course approved in writing by Owner. F. When compaction test results indicate nonconforming work, remove defective work, replace and retest. G. Observe the proof-rolling of the subgrade prior to placing base course materials. H. Check base course materials for conformance to specifications. I. Perform extraction analysis on samples of bituminous concrete mixes to check for conformance to the Illinois Department of Transportation Class I requirements. PART 2 - PRODUCTS 2.1 MATERIALS A. Stabilizing Base Course: Comply with IDOT, 2012 for gradation CA-6, and Section 02720. B. Hot-Mix Asphalt Paving Materials: Comply with IDOT 2012, Section 406: Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA HOT MIX ASPHALT PAVING 02511-2 1. 2. 3. Hot-mix asphalt surface course: Article 1030, Mix “E”, N30; IL 9.5, PG 64-22. Hot-mix asphalt binder course: Article 1030, N30; IL 19.0, PG 64-22. Bituminous Materials: Article 1032. C. Pavement Marking: 1. Comply with requirements of Section 02783 Pavement Marking. D. LEED Requirements: 1. See Section 01352 for LEED requirements. PART 3 - EXECUTION 3.1 INSTALLATION A. 3.2 PLACEMENT OF STABILIZING BASE COURSE A. 3.3 3.4 Provide all items and perform all preparation and work in accord with IDOT 2012, referenced Sections: 1. Subgrade: Comply with IDOT 2012, Section 301. 2. Granular Base: Comply with IDOT 2012, Section 311. Refer Part 3 of Section 02720 Aggregate base course. PRIMING PREPARED STABILIZED BASE COURSE A. Ensure stabilized base course is dry and free of loose or foreign material before priming. B. Apply primer over prepared stabilizing base course at a uniform rate of 0.3 gallon/sq. yd. Ensure primer is at temperature recommended by manufacturer. Use clean natural sand to blot excess primer. C. Similarly prime surfaces of curbs and gutters which will be in contact with bituminous pavement. D. Coat surfaces of manholes and catch basins that are to remain free of asphalt with oil to prevent asphalt adhesion. PLACEMENT OF BITUMINOUS PAVEMENT A. Place bituminous pavement within twenty-four (24) hours of priming stabilizing base course. B. Place binder course to compacted depth as shown on Drawings. C. Place surface course to compacted depth as shown on Drawings. D. Do not place bituminous pavement when surface temperature is 40 F. or lower. E. Compact each bituminous paving course to specified density, with approved rolling equipment. Start compaction as soon as pavement will bear equipment without checking or undue displacement. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA HOT MIX ASPHALT PAVING 02511-3 3.5 F. Execute compaction in three operations in pass sequence. Ensure each pass of roller overlaps previous passes to ensure smooth surface, free of roller marks. Keep roller wheels sufficiently moist not to pick up material. G. Hand tamp in areas not accessible to rolling equipment. H. Ensure joints made during paving operations are straight, clean, vertical and free of broken or loose material. Prime vertical surfaces of joints to ensure tight bond. I. Ensure surface of completed bituminous pavement is true to lines, profiles and elevations indicated, and are free from depressions exceeding 1/4 in. when measured with a 10 ft. straightedge. J. Do not allow vehicular traffic on newly paved areas until surface coat has cooled to ambient atmospheric temperature. PAVEMENT MARKINGS A. Install pavement markings as shown on the drawings and as per the requirements of Section 02783. END OF SECTION 02511 Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA HOT MIX ASPHALT PAVING 02511-4 SECTION 02542 METER VAULT PART 1 – GENERAL 1.1 RELATED DOCUMENTS A. B. 1.2 SUMMARY A. 1.3 Drawings Book 1: Project Information, Instructions to Bidders, and Execution Documents This Section includes requirements for construction and/or adjustment of Water meter vaults using precast concrete. REFERENCES A. ASTM A48 - Standard Specification for Gray Iron Castings B. ASTM A185 - Standard Specification for Steel Welded Wire Reinforcement, Plain, for Concrete Reinforcement C. ASTM A197 - Standard Specification for Cupola Malleable Iron D. ASTM A536 - Standard Specification for Ductile Iron Castings E. ASTM A615 - Standard Specification for Deformed and Plain Billet-Steel Bars for Concrete Reinforcement F. ASTM C55 - Standard Specification for Concrete Building Brick G. ASTM C443 - Standard Specification for Joints for Concrete Pipe and Manholes Using Rubber Gaskets H. ASTM C478 - Standard Specification for Precast Reinforced Concrete Manhole Sections I. ASTM C857 – Standard Practice for Minimum Structural Design Loading for Underground Precast Concrete Utility Structures K. ASTM C858 – Standard Specification for Underground Precast Concrete Utility Structures. L. ASTM C990 - Standard Specification for Joints for Concrete Pipe, Manholes and Precast Box Sections Using Preformed Flexible Joint Sealants. M. IDOT Standard Specification for Road and Bridge Construction (SSRBC) N. American Association of State Highway Transportation Officials, Standard Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA METER VAULT 02542-1 Specifications for Highway (AASHTO) O. 1.4 Follow the latest edition of the above references. SUBMITTALS A. Refer to Book 1 for submittal requirements and procedures for Shop Drawings, Product Data, Records and Samples. B. Shop Drawings: When not indicated on the Contract Drawings in sufficient detail or definition, submit detailed drawings of precast concrete utility structures and related metal work. C. Product Data: Submit manufacturers' product data for standard manufactured precast concrete sections and structures, for metal gratings and covers, and for other, related miscellaneous metal items. PART 2 - PRODUCTS 2.1 2.2 2.3 PRECAST CONCRETE STRUCTURES A. Fabrication standards - Circular precast concrete base and riser sections furnished for manholes, valve basins and other structures must conform to ASTM C478. Non-circular precast concrete monolithic and sectional structures for meter vaults, riser manholes and other structures must conform to ASTM C858. B. Furnish riser sections in various heights, including an offset tapered section, as detailed on the Drawings. JOINT SEALANTS A. Rubber gaskets must conform to ASTM C443. B. Preformed butyl rubber flexible rope type gaskets must conform to ASTM C990. ADJUSTING RINGS A. Adjusting rings are to be precast concrete in conformance with ASTM C478. B. Meeting Faces: 1. 2. 3. Smooth Parallel Free from cracks, chips, spalls or casting irregularities interfering with watertight mating to structure top or casting. 4. Provide grooves in faces to contain extrudible preformed gasket material when Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA METER VAULT 02542 - 2 possible. 2.4 2.5 CASTINGS A. Iron castings are to be ductile iron castings conforming to ASTM A536, Grade 60-40-18, or gray iron conforming to ASTM A48, free from blowholes, shrinkage, cracks and other defects. B. Allowance for shrinkage must be made in the patterns to meet the specified thickness. Frames and lids are to seat at all points. C. Malleable castings are to conform to ASTM A197. D. All castings are to be made accurately to dimensions shown on the plans, and planed, filed, or ground where otherwise necessary to secure flat and true surfaces. STEPS A. 2.6 MORTAR A. 2.7 Steps anchored to the wall are to be provided as noted on the drawings. Mortar for brickwork is to be composed of one (1) part Portland cement and two (2) parts screened sand. 1. Portland cement must conform to the requirements of Section 1001 of the SSRBC. 2. Sand must be class A quality and gradation FA-9 as specified in Article 1003.02 of the SSRBC. B. The cement and sand must be proportioned by volume and thoroughly mixed in a tight box. C. After the initial mixing, water is to be added gradually and the ingredients mixed until the mortar is of proper consistency. The amount of water must be no more than necessary to produce a workable, plastic mortar. D. Prepare only a sufficient amount of mortar for immediate use and any mortar that has begun to set must not be retempered or used in any way in the Work VAULT COVERS AND LIDS A. Dimensions of the cover must be as noted on the standard detail and from Neenah Foundry Manufacturer. PART 3 – EXECUTION Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA METER VAULT 02542-3 3.1 3.2 3.3 DESCRIPTION A. Excavate backfill and compact in accordance with Section 02300 - Excavation, and Earthwork. B. All brick must be thoroughly wetted immediately before being laid. C. Old brickwork must be thoroughly cleaned and wetted before new work is jointed thereto. D. No masonry work is to be done when the temperature is below 33º F unless otherwise approved, and then only under conditions for protecting it from frost. PRE-CAST STRUCTURE INSTALLATION A. Carefully place precast sections for all structures on prepared bedding so as to fully and uniformly support the structure and allow pipes to be laid to proper grade. B. All lift holes on precast sections must be completely filled with mortar, smoothed on both inside and outside surfaces. C. Seal joints between riser sections with approved mastic sealant or rubber gaskets, or as directed by the Owner. D. Place one adjusting ring (only) on manhole top. Select thickness of adjusting ring to bring completed structure to required elevation. E. Seal joints between adjusting rings and frames with approved mastic sealant before backfilling structures. F. Install manhole frame and cover. MASONRY STRUCTURE INSTALLATION A. Install precast concrete or cast in place base as shown on the Drawings. B. Lay brick courses to the line, straight and parallel, breaking joints with those in adjacent courses. C. Lay brick radially as headers in a full bed of mortar with joints not exceeding 3/8-inch in thickness. D. Fill joints with mortar. Interior joints must be trowel-struck. E. Fresh masonry must be plastered inside and outside and must be protected from damage of all kinds. F. New work, unless immediately covered with earth or brick backing, or an approved form of curing compound, must be kept moist until the mortar has hardened. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA METER VAULT 02542 - 4 G. 3.4 3.5 Install manhole frame and cover. FINAL ADJUSTMENT OF STRUCTURES A. After the base course and binder course have been placed, and prior to placing the surface course, the structures must be adjusted to match the final pavement elevation. B. Remove the binder and base course adjacent to and for a distance not exceeding 12inches outside the base of the castings. C. Adjust the castings to final pavement elevation with adjusting rings set in mortar. D. Fill the space around the casting with Class SI concrete to the elevation of the surface of the binder course. ABANDONMENT OF VALVE BASINS AND OTHER STRUCTURES. A. For Valve basins and other structures being abandoned, the Contractor must remove the existing frame and lid and return it the City as requested by the Owner. The remaining parts of the structure are to be removed to a depth of 36-inch below grade and filled with fine graded aggregate or controlled low strength material (CLSM) flowable fill, as appropriate, or directed by the Owner. CLSM flowable material must meet standards specified in City of Chicago’s Dept of Water Management, Section 31 23 10 Excavation, Trenching and Backfilling. END OF SECTION 02542 Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA METER VAULT 02542-5 SECTION 02601 STORM SEWER PART 1 – GENERAL 1.1 RELATED DOCUMENTS A. B. 1.2 Drawings Book 1: Project Information, Instructions to Bidders, and Execution Documents SUMMARY A. Furnish and install all labor, materials, tools and equipment required for furnishing and installing Storm and Sanitary Sewer(s) including, but not necessarily limited to trench excavation and disposal of all unsuitable material; special fabrication and field installation of pipe; connections to existing catch basins, inlets and manholes; modifications of existing sewers; bedding, backfilling of trenches with suitable trench excavated material; and other appurtenant or related work associated with the construction of storm sewers. B. 1.3 1.4 Except as modified herein, the work shall conform to City of Chicago – Department of Water Management 2012 Regulations for Sewer Construction and Stormwater Management. REFERENCES A. City of Chicago – Department of Water Management 2012 Regulations for Sewer Construction and Stormwater Management. B. Municipal Code of City of Chicago 2011. C. Standard Specifications for Road and Bridge Construction (SSRBC), January 1, 2007 (Illinois Department of Transportation) D. ASTM C-144 – Standard Specification for Aggregate for Masonry Mortar E. ASTM C-150 – Standard Specification for Portland Cement F. ASTM C-700 – Standard Specification for Vitrified Clay Pipe, Extra Strength, Standard Strength, and Perforated. G. Compression joints for Vitrified Clay Pipe shall conform to ASTM C-425. SUBMITTALS A. Submit the following 1. Samples and/or Product Data a. 2. Product Data Tests Reports a. Submit test reports necessary to show compliance with the Contract Chicago Park District: Park No.569DFA STORM SEWER 02601 - 1 Documents. 3. Manufacturer’s Certification a. Submit certification that product(s) meet(s) or exceed(s) the specified requirements. PART 2 - PRODUCTS 2.1 MATERIALS A. GENERAL 1. B. The pipe shall be the type and class called for on the Plans and shall be in accordance with requirements of this section. PIPE 1. Sewers constructed in sizes 21 inches in diameter and smaller shall be ESVCP, ASTM Designation C-700 with C-425 joints; DIP, class 52 or equivalent, with push on self-contained, pre-lubricated gaskets or mechanical joints; or CIP, with hot poured pure lead firmly packed with oakum or hemp. See Section 18-29-702.3 and 18-29-1102.4 of the Municipal Code of Chicago. 2. CIP or DIP shall be used under building structures. If the sewer size is less than 24 inches in diameter and the cover is less than 3 feet, then Class 52 or equivalent pressure DIP shall be used. 3. DIP encased in polyethylene wrap is the only type of iron pipe allowed for City sewers. Other means of corrosion protection for iron pipe may be considered for private sewers. 4. In new streets, the horizontal clearance between a waterline and sewer shall be 10 feet center to center. If a sewer and waterline (i.e., main or water service) have less than 10 feet of horizontal clearance, then DIP shall be used if the sewer is less than 18 inches below the waterline. Furthermore, if the sewer is above the waterline, DIP shall be used regardless of vertical clearance. CIP is not allowed in the right-of-way. 5. RCP shall be used for sewers 24 inches in diameter and larger, unless prior approved by the DWM. ASTM Designation C-76, Class-III, Wall-B with O-ring type joints is the minimum requirement for this type of pipe. If self-lubricating gaskets are used, the physical properties of the gaskets shall conform to ASTM C-361. RCP may not be used for pipe 21 inches in diameter and smaller, inside or outside the private property. 6. No plastic pipe may be used for any underground sewer or drain inside or outside the property, except as specifically allowed by the Municipal Code of Chicago. The Municipal Code of Chicago, Section 18-29-702.3 and 18-29-1102.5, Subsoil Drain Pipe, allows (1) PVC pipe - ASTM D2729 (type Sewer Pipe, PS25, PS50 and PS 100); or (2) PVC perforated subsurface drain pipe, ASTM F 891 with nylon sock, filter fabric, ASTM D 3034, SDR 35 (4 inch to 15 inch). No corrugated pipe is allowed. Chicago Park District: Park No.569DFA STORM SEWER 02601 - 2 7. All inlet connections shall be eight-inch (8") Extra Strength Vitrified Clay Pipe or Ductile Iron Pipe. All catch basin connections shall be eight-inch (8") inch pipe of the type and quality specified herein. Catch basin half-traps on proposed catch basins will not be measured for payment but considered incidental to the item CATCH BASIN. Where required, catch basin half-traps shall be constructed of ductile iron pipe and be furnished with fittings conforming to ANSI A21.51, Class 52 Specification, with 0.33-inch wall thickness and have a push-on type bell end. Ductile iron pipe joints shall be push-on type except that, when required and so shown on the plans, joints shall be mechanical type and approved by the Owner. 8. All drain connection replacements and extensions shall match the existing drain size, type and quality. 9. The pipe foundation shall consist of moist, well compacted bedding material of at least 4 inches in depth below the pipe and so placed that at least the lower half of the pipe will be uniformly supported for its entire length. The cost of furnishing, placing and compacting the bedding material shall be considered as incidental work, and no additional compensation will be allowed. 10. After installing the sewer pipe, trenches shall be backfilled in accordance with Article 550.07 of the Standard Specifications, Section 2.1 A of 02222 and Section 02310. The method chosen will be subject to the approval of the Owner. Backfill material shall be sand conforming to Section 1003 of the Standard Specifications and have a gradation meeting FA-6. The cost of furnishing, placing and compacting trench backfill material will be considered as incidental work. 11. Unless otherwise directed by the Owner, all excavated material not needed on the work shall be legally disposed of beyond the limits of the improvement within 24 hours. 12. For any proposed excavation 12 feet or greater below grade, the Contractor shall design an Earth Retention System subject to approval by the Owner. It is the Contractor’s responsibility to provide shop drawings sealed by a Licensed Structural Engineer in Illinois and design calculations for temporary earth retention and associated members, which shall be approved before this work may start. However, the Owner’s approval shall not relieve the Contractor from his/her sole responsibility for the successful design, installation and functioning of the temporary earth retention system (sheeting or shoring). The Contractor shall also provide temporary support for any adjacent structures and utilities during construction per details prepared, signed and sealed by a Licensed Structural Engineer registered in Illinois. 13. Where a sewer or drain connection is to be made to a proposed ESVCP sewer, a manufactured Y or T branch shall be installed in the sewer at this junction. Where a sewer or drain connection is to be made to a proposed RCP sewer, a pipe section with a pre-drilled hole of the proper diameter shall be installed at this junction. The junction of the proposed sewers shall be constructed as shown on the Detail Construction Standards. 14. Except as specified hereinafter, when a sewer or drain connection is to be made to an existing sewer, a “T” or "Y” saddle shall be installed per the Detail Construction Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA STORM SEWER 02601-3 Standards. The circular opening in the existing sewer shall be core drilled to the same size as the external diameter of the proposed sewer or drain connection. The protrusion of the proposed sewer into the existing sewer shall not exceed a maximum of one inch (1"). Edge of core holes shall be a minimum of 1.5 feet from the edge of pipe and a minimum distance of 5 feet horizontally between holes. Holes shall not be drilled higher than 10 and 2 o'clock. The joint between the existing sewer and the proposed sewer shall be completely sealed with brick and mortar as shown in the Standard of City of Chicago – Department of Water Management 2012 Regulations for Sewer Construction and Stormwater Management. 15. If the existing sewer pipe is cracked, broken or otherwise damaged by the Contractor in making this cored opening, the Contractor shall replace this section of pipe with a pipe equal to and similar in all respects to the pipe of the existing sewer. The Contractor shall do this work in a careful, workmanlike manner without extra compensation, so as not to disturb the adjoining sections of existing pipe. The junction of the proposed and existing sewers shall be constructed as shown on the Standard of City of Chicago – Department of Water Management 2012 Regulations for Sewer Construction and Stormwater Management. 16. The brick (Grade S.W. Building Brick) shall be laid in mortar as specified for Brick Masonry under Article 602.05 of the Standard Specifications. 17. Flow in the sewers shall not be interrupted unless adequate provisions, acceptable to the Owner, are made to continue service. A temporary flume pipe shall be installed at the end of each day between the existing and proposed sewers at locations where an existing sewer is being replaced. 18. Care shall be taken to prevent mud, sand or other obstructing materials from entering the sewer. All such materials which enter the sewer shall be removed and the sewer left clean and unobstructed upon completion of the work. This shall include all debris created in making the circular opening in existing sewers for purposes of storm sewer connections and all materials employed to seal the joints. 19. Where broken tile in the existing sewer is determined, the Contractor shall replace the broken tile at no additional cost. 20. The Contractor shall, when directed by the Owner, place riser pipes for future laterals from their connection with the sewer to such a height as directed. 21. After installation of the proposed sewer is complete, existing and private drains shall be connected to the new sewer. Upon completing the connection of existing drains and private drains to the new sewer, the existing sewer and/or portions thereof shall be abandoned. The existing sewer shall be bulk headed and grouted as directed by the Owner. This work will not be paid separately but shall be considered incidental to the work. 22. Abandoned sewers and drains, as designated by the Owner, shall be plugged with Class SI concrete or brick and suitable mortar to the satisfaction of the Owner. This work will not be paid for separately, but shall be considered as included in the Contract unit price for the Storm Sewer items. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA STORM SEWER 02601-4 23. New opening or enlargements of existing openings in existing manholes that are required to accommodate the proposed sewers will not be measured for payment but shall be considered incidental to the work. 24. Manufacturers: Subject to compliance with requirements, provide products by one of the following for clay pipes: 1. 2. 3. Can O Lok Pipe The Logan Clay Products Company Superior Clay Corp. PART 3 - EXECUTION 3.1 PLACEMENT A. 3.2 3.3 Sewers shall be laid to the lines and grades shown on the Contract Drawings and in accordance to City of Chicago – Department of Water Management 2012 Regulations for Sewer Construction and Stormwater Management. EQUIPMENT A. All equipment necessary and required for the proper construction of storm drains will be on the Project, in first-class working condition, and approved by OWNER before construction is permitted to start. B. The Contractor shall provide appropriate hoisting equipment to handle the pipe while unloading and placing it in the final position without damage to the pipe. C. The Contractor shall provide vibratory means to obtain the required compaction of the pipe bedding and backfill as specified in Section 02222 of these Specifications. EXCAVATION A. The width of the pipe trench shall be sufficient to permit satisfactory jointing of the pipe and thorough tamping of the bedding material under and around the pipe, but shall not be less than the external diameter of the pipe plus one (1) foot on each side. The trench walls shall be approximately vertical except where safety considerations require benching of the trench walls. B. The Contractor shall bear all risk as to the quality of the excavation, its condition as to the presence or absence of water, and all contingencies attending the Work. The Contractor shall review the geo-technical information provided in the Contract Documents. C. The Contractor shall conduct dewatering as defined in Section 02240, as necessary to maintain the water table level below the trench bottom prior to and during pipe laying, jointing, and backfilling. The dewatering operation, however accomplished, shall be carried out so that it does not destroy or weaken the strength of the soil under or alongside the trench. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA STORM SEWER 02601-5 3.4 D. Where rock, hardpan, or other unyielding material is encountered, it shall be removed below the foundation grade for a depth of at least 8 inches. The excavation below grade shall be backfilled with trench stabilization stone in accordance with Section 02222 of these Specifications. E. Where a firm foundation is not encountered at the grade established, due to soft, spongy, or other unstable soil, the unstable soil shall be removed and replaced with Trench Stabilization Stone as defined by Section 02222 of these Specifications for the full trench width. F. The excavation for pipes that are placed in embankment fill shall not be made until the embankment has been completed to a height above the top of the pipe as shown on the Plans. G. The description of soil classifications, including contaminated materials, and their disposal are contained in Section 02300 of these Specifications. H. The Contractor shall construct such trench bracing, sheathing, or shoring necessary to perform and protect the excavation as required for safety and conformance to governing laws. The bracing, sheathing, or shoring shall not be removed in one operation but shall be done in successive stages to prevent overloading of the pipe during backfilling operations. The cost of bracing, sheathing, or shoring, and the removal of same, shall be considered incidental to the work. I. Open-cut trenches shall be supported as required to fully protect life, existing utilities, adjacent structures, pavements, and the Work. Trench support is an integral part of the Contractor’s means and methods. The Contractor shall employ the services of a registered (Illinois) Structural Engineer, registered (Illinois) Professional Engineer, Geotechnical Engineer, and other professionals as necessary to prepare designs of support systems. The support systems shall conform to Federal laws, State laws and municipal ordinances. The minimum protection shall conform to the recommendations in O.S.H.A. Safety and Health Standards for Construction. BEDDING A. 3.5 The pipe bedding shall conform to the details as shown on the Plans and in accordance with Section 02222 - Trench Backfill. LAYING PIPE A. Pipe in Trench 1. Laying of pipe shall be accomplished to line and grade in the trench only after it has been dewatered and the bedding and Trench Stabilization Stone (if required) have been prepared in accordance with Section 02222 of these Specifications. The pipe shall be laid so that it will be uniformly supported with the entire length of its pipe barrel fully bearing on the bedding material. Mud, silt, gravel, and other foreign material shall be kept out of the pipe and off joint surfaces. All pipe laid shall be retained in position so as to maintain alignment and joint closure until sufficient backfill has been completed to adequately hold the pipe in place. 2. Pipe alignment shall not deviate by more than 0.5 inch or 0.25 inch per foot of diameter, whichever is greater, from true vertical alignment; or 2.0 inches or 0.5 Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA STORM SEWER 02601-6 inch per foot of diameter, whichever is greater, from true horizontal alignment, prior to and following placement and compaction of backfill. Sewers found to vary from these alignment criteria will be excavated and re-layed or otherwise corrected. No blocking of any kind will be permitted to adjust the pipe to grade. Contractor shall check line and grade of each pipe Section installed 3.6 3. The pipe laying shall begin at the lowest point of the trench and precede upgrade. The lower segment of the pipe shall be in contact with the bedding throughout its full length. Bell or groove ends of rigid pipes shall be placed facing upgrade. 4. Pipe shall not be laid on frozen ground. The Contractor shall provide for the temporary diversion of flows in order to permit the installation of the pipe under dry conditions. 5. Following installation, the pipe shall be backfilled in accordance with Section 02222 of these Specifications and as shown on the Drawings. JOINING PIPE A. ESVCP 1. 3.7 ESVCP joints shall be made to form a flexible watertight seal. Gaskets shall be installed according to the manufacturer’s requirements. The method of joining pipe Sections shall be such that the ends are fully entered and the inner surfaces are reasonably flush and even. CONNECTION TO STRUCTURES AND PIPES A. Where the Plans show connections to existing or proposed pipe or structures, these connections shall be watertight and made so that a smooth uniform flow line will be obtained throughout the drainage system. B. Connections to existing ESVCP sewers shall be made with a vitrified clay wye junction or a properly sized saddle. No break-in connections will be allowed o existing clay, concrete sewers or lined brick sewers. Connections to existing concrete sewers shall be cored. All connections to brick sewers which comprise one-half or more of the brick sewer’s diameter require a reinforced concrete collared structural detail, approved by a Licensed Structural Engineer. City standard connections as shown in Appendices A-20 toA-26 shall be made. C. All branch sewer connections shall meet the structural, jointing, and water-tightness requirements for the mainline pipe to which they are made. Break-in-connections will not be allowed. Connections of pipe, 18-inches in diameter or smaller to RCP may be made using cast-in or cored-in flexible couplings meeting ASTM C-923, or pre-cast wye or tee fittings Connections of pipe larger than 18-inches in diameter to RCP will be with pre-cast wye or tee fittings. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA STORM SEWER 02601-7 3.8 3.9 3.10 3.11 BACKWATER VALVE A. Install components in accordance with manufacturer’s instructions and approved product data submittals. B. Set plumb, level and rigid. BACKFILLING A. Pipes shall be inspected before any backfill is placed; any pipes found to be out of alignment, unduly settled, or damaged shall be removed and relaid or replaced at the Contractor’s expense. Trenches shall be backfilled in accordance with Section 02222 - Trench Backfill. B. Backfilling shall be started and completed as quickly as possible after the pipe has been assembled and placed on its bed. CLEANING AND RESTORATION OF SITE A. After the backfill is completed, the Contractor shall dispose of all surplus material, dirt, and rubbish from the site. The Contractor shall restore disturbed landscape areas to their original condition. Where the original condition is grass, sod shall be used for restoration. All costs for restoration shall be included in the Contract. Any future settlement of trenches shall be restored at the Contractor’s expense. B. After all the work is completed, the Contractor shall remove all tools and other equipment, leaving the entire site free, clear and in good condition. INSPECTION A. The Contractor shall conduct infiltration testing of each manhole-to-manhole Section of pipe after the pipe is installed and backfilled. Infiltration tests shall be made by measuring the flow of infiltrating water over a calibrated weir set up in the invert of the sewer. All labor, equipment, material and water, including gauges and meters, necessary for infiltration testing shall be furnished by the Contractor. No additional pipe will be laid until the infiltration test on each manhole/junction chamberto-manhole/junction chamber Section of pipe meets the following specified infiltration limit: 100 gallons per day per inch of pipe diameter per mile of sewer No visible leaks will be permitted that endanger the pipe or surrounding bedding/backfill. B. If the specified infiltration limit is exceeded, the Contractor shall immediately make all repairs and/or replacements necessary to achieve the specified infiltration limit. After all repairs are made, the Contractor shall again perform an infiltration test. All costs for testing and pipe repair or replacement shall be borne by the Contractor at no additional cost. C. For pipes smaller than 72-inches in diameter, an internal television inspection shall be performed following the completion of open-cut sewer installation, infiltration testing, and backfill compaction testing. The television camera used shall be high-resolution color, shall be equipped with a revolving head, and shall be equipped with a footage counter which Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA STORM SEWER 02601-8 records on the videotape. Videotapes in DVD format will be made of the internal inspections and given to OWNER. The costs associated with televising shall be considered incidental and no additional payment will be made for this work. D. Inspection of Sewers: In conjunction with sewer inspection(s), the Contractor is required to furnish a videotape of a televised inspection of the interior of all existing and/or proposed main sewers affected by various work performed under this Contract. The videotape of existing and/or proposed main sewers shall be recorded under the supervision of OWNER, and the cost of producing and furnishing same shall be incidental to the Contract. The videotape is considered a critical item. Videotaping of the sewer shall be performed as soon as practical and submit a detail report with recommendations of any damaged sewers for replacement or as directed by OWNER. The Contractor shall submit at the preconstruction meeting the name, phone number, and contact person of the firm that is scheduled to perform the videotaping of the sewer. The sewer shall be cleaned prior to videotaping. The final acceptance of the sewer will be based on the sewer videotape. All deficiencies exposed on the videotape shall be corrected by the Contractor within 30 calendar days of notification. All costs incurred by the Contractor to make the required repairs shall be borne solely by the Contractor. Pavement sections requiring removal shall be full panel sections and pavement anchors will be required for pavement restoration. The Contractor is then required to re-videotape the sewer to verify that the deficiencies noted on any previous videotape have been corrected to the satisfaction of OWNER. All costs to re-videotape the sewer, regardless of the number of times required, shall be borne solely by the Contractor. Every effort shall be made by the Contractor to correct all deficiencies prior to the placement of the final wearing surface. If, in the opinion of OWNER, the Contractor has delayed in submitting the videotape, the placement of the final wearing surface will be suspended. No time extension will be granted due to this suspension. OWNER will be sole judge as to any delays. All videotape submittals shall include location maps, pipe routes, legends and descriptions. END OF SECTION 02601 Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA STORM SEWER 02601-9 SECTION 02603 PIPE UNDERDRAINS AND CLEANOUTS PART 1 - GENERAL 1.1 RELATED DOCUMENTS A. B. 1.2 1.3 1.4 SUMMARY A. Furnish and install all Pipe Underdrains in accordance with these Specifications and in conformity with the lines and grades shown on the Plans. B. Furnish and install cleanouts in accordance with these specifications and in reasonably close uniformity with the requirements shown on the Plans. REFERENCES A. ASTM D1785– Standard Specification for Perforated PVC Pipe B. ASTM A-536 – Ductile Iron frame and cover SUBMITTALS, A. 1.5 Drawings Book 1: Project Information, Instructions to Bidders, and Execution Documents Submit the following: 1. Shop Drawings 2. Samples and/or Product Data 3. Submit test reports necessary to show compliance with the Contract Documents. 4. Submit Manufacturer’s Certification that product(s) meet(s) or exceed(s) the specified requirements. QUALITY CONTROL A. Contractor Qualifications: Installation of pipe underdrains and cleanouts shall be performed only by a qualified Installer. The term qualified means experienced in performing the Work required by this Section. The Contractor shall have a minimum of five (5) years documented experience in Projects similar in size and scope to this Project. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA PIPE UNDERDRAINS AND CLEANOUTS 02603-1 PART 2 - PRODUCTS 2.1 MATERIALS A. PIPE 1. PVC perforated subsurface drain pipe, Schedule 40 –ASTM D 3034, SDR 35. 2. Manufacturers: Subject to compliance with requirements, provide products by one of the following for clay pipes: a. b. c. B. Northern Pipe Products North American Pipe Corp. National Pipe & Plastics, Inc. CLEANOUT 1. Ductile Iron frame and Brass cover for cleanout – ASTM A-536 and proof loaded as per AASHTO M 306. 2. Manufacturers: Subject to compliance with requirements, provide products by one of the following for clay pipes: a. C. MORTAR 1. D. Plumbing Supply or approved equal. Mortar shall consist of one part Portland Cement and two parts sand. The Portland Cement shall conform to the requirements of ASTM C 150, Type 1. The sand shall conform to the requirements of ASTM C 144. POROUS BACKFILL 1. Porous backfill shall be washed CA-7, and must conform to the gradation in the table below when tested in accordance with ASTM C 136. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA PIPE UNDERDRAINS AND CLEANOUTS 02603-2 Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA PIPE UNDERDRAINS AND CLEANOUTS 02603-3 PART 3 - EXECUTION 3.1 3.2 3.3 INSPECTION A. Verify job site conditions prior to delivery and installation of any of the items. Any discrepancies or variations in related Work that may affect the proper installation of the items shall be reported to the Architect and corrected to the satisfaction of ARCHITECT before any installation Work is started. B. Before commencing installation, examine substrate surfaces to determine that they are free of conditions which might be detrimental to proper and timely completion of the Work. Start of Work shall indicate acceptance of the substrate. EXCAVATION A. The width of the pipe trench shall be sufficient to permit satisfactory jointing of the pipe and thorough tamping of the bedding material under and around the pipe, but will not be less than the external diameter of the pipe plus 6 inches on each side. The trench walls shall be approximately vertical. B. Where rock, hardpan, or other unyielding material is encountered, it shall be removed below the bottom of foundation grade for a depth of at least 4 inches. The excavation below grade shall be backfilled with approved fill in accordance with Section 02222 Trench Backfill. C. Where a firm foundation is not encountered at the grade established, due to soft, spongy, or other unstable soil, the unstable soil shall be removed and replaced with approved fill in accordance with Section 02222 - Trench Backfill for the full trench width. The Owner’s Testing lab shall determine the depth of removal necessary. The granular material shall be compacted to provide adequate support for the pipe. D. Excavated material not required or acceptable for backfill shall be disposed of by the Contractor. E. The excavation will not be carried below the required depth; when this is done, the trench shall be backfilled at the Contractor's expense with material approved by the Owners Testing Lab and compacted to the density of the surrounding earth material. F. The bed for the pipe shall be so shaped that at least the lower quarter of the pipe shall be in continuous contact with the bottom of the trench. Spaces for the pipe bell shall be excavated accurately to size to clear the bell so that the barrel supports the entire weight of the pipe. G. The Contractor shall do such trench temporary earth retention systems as necessary to perform and protect the excavation as required for safety and conformance to governing laws. Unless otherwise provide, the temporary earth retention systems shall be removed by the Contractor after the completion of the backfill to at least 12 inches over the top of the pipe. The sheathing or shoring shall be pulled as the granular backfill is placed and compacted to avoid any unfilled spaces between the trench wall and the backfill material. LAYING AND INSTALLING PIPE Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA PIPE UNDERDRAINS AND CLEANOUTS 02603-4 3.4 3.5 A. The laying of the pipe in the finished trench shall be started at the lowest point and laid upgrade. When bell and spigot pipe is used, the bells shall be laid upgrade. If tongue and groove pipe is used, the groove end shall be laid upgrade. Holes in perforated pipe shall be placed up, unless otherwise shown on the Plans. The pipe shall be firmly and accurately set to line and grade so that the invert shall be smooth and uniform. Pipe will not be laid on frozen ground. B. Pipe which is not true in alignment, or which shows any settlement after laying, shall be taken up and relaid without extra compensation. C. The upgrade end of pipelines, not terminating in a structure, shall be plugged or capped D. Unless otherwise shown on the Plans, a 4-inch bed of granular backfill material shall be spread in the bottom of the trench throughout the entire length under all perforated pipe underdrains. E. Pipe outlets for the underdrains shall be constructed when required or shown on the Plans. The pipe shall be laid with tight-fitting joints. Porous backfill is not required around or over pipe outlets for underdrains. All connections to other drainage pipes or structures shall be made as required and in a satisfactory manner. If connections are not made to other pipes or structures, the outlets shall be protected and constructed as shown on the Plans. F. Geotextile Fabric shall be installed in conjunction with perforated pipe underdrains as shown on the Drawings and in accordance with Section 02073 - Geotextiles. INSTALLING CLEANOUTS A. Cleanouts for underdrain systems shall be installed at the locations shown on the Plans to the details shown on the Plans. B. The castings for the cleanout frames and covers shall be tough, close-grained, free from blowholes, shrinkage and cold shuts and shall be sound, smooth, clean and free from blisters and all defects. The covers shall be true and shall seat within the ring at all points. MORTAR A. 3.6 The mortar shall be of the desired consistency for making connections to other pipes or to structures only. Mortar that is not used within 45 minutes after water has been added shall be discarded. Retempering of mortar will not be permitted. BACKFILLING A. Granular Material - The placement of granular backfill in the trench and about the pipe shall be as shown on the Plans. Special care shall be taken in placing the backfill. The granular backfill as defined in Section 02222 shall not contain foreign matter, nor shall earth from the sides of the trench or from the windrow be allowed to filter into the backfill. The backfill shall be placed in loose layers not exceeding 6 inches in depth and compacted by hand and pneumatic tampers to the requirements as given for earth backfill. Backfilling shall be done in a manner to avoid injurious top or side pressure on the pipe or damage to the filter fabric. B. When perforated pipe is specified, granular backfill material shall be placed along the full length of the pipe. The position of the granular material shall be as shown on the details in the Plans. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA PIPE UNDERDRAINS AND CLEANOUTS 02603-5 3.7 C. When porous backfill is to be placed in paved or adjacent areas prior to the completion of grading or subgrade operations, the backfill material shall be placed immediately after laying the pipe. The depth of this granular backfill will be not less than 12 inches, measured from the top of the underdrain. During subsequent construction operations, this minimum backfill of 12 inches of depth will not be disturbed until such time as the underdrains are to be completed. When the underdrains are to be completed, the unsuitable material shall be removed until the porous backfill is exposed. That part of the porous backfill which contains objectionable material shall be removed and replaced with suitable material. The cost of removing and replacing any such unsuitable material shall be borne by the Contractor. D. Whenever a granular subbase blanket course is to be used under pavements which extend several feet beyond the edge of paving to the outside edge of the underdrain trench, the granular backfill material over the underdrains shall be placed in the trench up to an elevation of 2 inches above the bottom surface of the granular subbase blanket course. Immediately prior to the placing of the granular subbase blanket course, the Contractor shall blade this excess trench backfill from the top of the trench onto the adjacent subgrade where it can be incorporated into the granular subbase blanket course. Any unsuitable material which remains over the underdrain trench shall be removed and replaced. The subbase material shall be placed to provide clean contact between the subbase material and the underdrain granular backfill material for the full width of the underdrain trench. CONNECTIONS A. 3.8 When the Plans call for connections to existing or proposed pipe or structures, these connections shall be watertight and made so that a smooth uniform flow line shall be obtained throughout the drainage system. CLEAN-UP A. After the backfill is completed, the Contractor shall dispose of legally all surplus material, dirt, and rubbish from the site in accordance with Section 02316. The Contractor shall restore all disturbed areas to their original condition. END OF SECTION 02603 Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA PIPE UNDERDRAINS AND CLEANOUTS 02603-6 SECTION 02621 CATCH BASINS PART 1 – GENERAL 1. 1.2 1.3 1.4 RELATED DOCUMENTS A. Drawings B. Book 1: Project Information, Instructions to Bidders, and Execution Documents SUMMARY A. Furnish and install Manholes and Catch Basins in accordance with these Specifications at the specified locations and conforming to the lines, grades, and dimensions shown on the Plans. All work must conform to Section 602 of the Standard Specifications for Road and Bridge Construction (SSRBC), latest edition by the Illinois Department of Transportation (IDOT) and Standard Specifications for Water and Sewer Main Construction in Illinois. B. Install products and materials (furnished in other Sections) as shown on the Drawings and as specified herein. REFERENCE A. ASTM C478 - Standard Specification for Precast Reinforced Concrete Manhole Sections B. ASTM C857 – Standard Practice for Minimum Structural Design Loading for Underground Precast Concrete Utility Structures C. ASTM C858 – Standard Specification for Underground Precast Concrete Utility Structures. D. ASTM C990 - Standard Specification for Joints for Concrete Pipe, Manholes using Preformed Flexible Joint Sealants SUBMITTALS A. Submit the following 1. Product Data: a. Catalog cuts of frame and grates for catch basins and manholes. b. Catalog cuts for pre-cast catch basins and manholes, including accessories. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA CATCH BASINS 02621-1 2. Test Reports a. Submit test reports necessary to show compliance with the Contract Documents. 3. Manufacturer’s Certification a. Submit certification that products meet or exceed the specified requirements. PART 2 - PRODUCTS 2.1 MATERIALS A. PRECAST CONCRETE STRUCTURES 1. Fabrication standards - Circular precast concrete base and riser sections furnished for manholes, valve basins and other structures must conform to ASTM C478. Noncircular precast concrete monolithic riser manholes and other structures must conform to ASTM C858. 2. Furnish riser sections in various heights, including an offset tapered section, as detailed on the Drawings. 3. Joint Sealants 4. a. Rubber gaskets must conform to ASTM C443. b. Preformed butyl rubber flexible rope type gaskets must conform to ASTM C990. Adjusting Rings a. Adjusting rings are to be precast concrete in conformance with ASTM C478. b. Meeting Faces: 1. Smooth 2. Parallel 3. Free from cracks, chips, spalls or casting irregularities interfering with watertight mating to structure top or casting. 4. 5. Provide grooves in faces to contain extrudible preformed gasket material when possible. Manufacturers: Subject to compliance with requirements, provide products by one of the following for precast concrete manholes and catch basins: a. b. c. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA Welch Brothers National Concrete Pipe Co. Concrete Specialities Co. CATCH BASINS 02621-2 B. MORTAR 1. C. The mortar must be composed of 1 part of Portland cement and 2 parts of mortar sand by volume. The Portland cement must conform to the requirements of AASHTO M 85. The sand must conform to the requirements of AASHTO M 45. Hydrated lime may be added to the mixture of sand and cement in an amount not to exceed 15% of the weight of cement used. The hydrated lime must meet the requirements of ASTM C 206. The water must be clean and free of deleterious amount of acids, alkalis, or organic material. If the water is of questionable quality, it must be tested by the contractor in accordance with AASHTO T 26. FRAMES, COVERS, AND GRATES 1. Manhole Frames and covers: ASTM A-48, Class 35B, cast gray iron and per current city code. Include indented top design with lettering cast into cover. a) b) D. 2. Castings for use at locations must conform to the requirements for Cast Iron castings and requirements of ASTM, and must be proof loaded as per AASHTO M 306. Acceptable manufacturers are Urban Accessories, Neenah Foundry Company, East Jordan Iron Works, Inc. and Campbell Foundry. 3. All castings must conform to the dimensions shown on the Plans and must be designed to support the loadings specified. 4. Prior to shipment, all castings must be thoroughly cleaned. After fabrication, structure steel units must be galvanized to meet the requirements of AASHTO M 111. STEPS 1. E. Pre-cast concrete grade rings must meet the requirements of ASTM C478. STEEL REINFORCEMENT 1. G. The steps or ladder bars must be gray aluminum. The steps must be the size, length, and shape shown on the Plans. GRADE RINGS 1. F. Sanitary Sewerage Piping Systems: Raised flush letters per current city code. Storm Drainage Piping Systems: Raised flush letters per current city code Reinforcing bars must conform to the requirements of ASTM A 615, Grade 60. NON-SHRINK GROUT 1. Non-shrink grout must conform to the requirements of Section 1024 of IDOT’s Standard Specifications for Road and Bridge Construction (latest edition) and meet the approval of the Owner. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA CATCH BASINS 02621-3 H. EPOXY CONCRETE ADHESIVE 1. I. The epoxy concrete adhesive must conform to the requirements of Article 1025.01 of IDOT’ s SSRBC (latest edition) and meet the approval of the Owner. BEDDING MATERIAL 1. Bedding under bases or foundations must be fine aggregate trench backfill in accordance with Section - Trench Backfill. PART 3 - EXECUTION 3.1 3.2 GENERAL A. The Contractor must do all excavation of structures and structures footings to the lines and grades or elevations shown on the Contract Documents. The excavation must be of sufficient size to permit the placing of the full width and length of the structure or structure footing shown. B. Boulders, logs, or any other objectionable material encountered in excavation must be removed. All rock or other hard foundation material must be cleaned of all loose material and cut to a firm surface. Rock or other unsuitable material must be removed and replaced with fine aggregate trench backfill. The foundation for the structure must be undisturbed ground with a minimum of 6 inches of fine aggregate trench backfill. C. The Contractor must furnish and install all temporary earth retention necessary to implement and protect the excavation and the structures as required for safety or conformance to governing laws. The temporary earth retention system will be included in this work. D. Unless otherwise provided, temporary earth retention system involved in the construction of this item must be removed by the Contractor after the completion of the structure. Removal must be effected in a manner which will not disturb or mar finished masonry. PRE-CAST REINFORCED CONCRETE STRUCTURES A. 3.3 Pre-cast reinforced concrete structures must be installed on prepared or previously constructed slab foundations and must conform to the dimensions and locations shown on the Contract Documents. All pre-cast reinforced concrete sections necessary to build a complete structure must be furnished. The different sections must fit together readily, and all jointing and connections must be cemented with mortar. The top of the upper precast concrete member must be suitably formed and dimensioned to receive the metal frame and cover or grate, or other cap, as required. Provision must be made for any connections for lateral pipe, including drops and leads that may be precast in the structure. The steps which are embedded or built into the side walls must be aligned and placed at vertical intervals at 16 inches on center or as indicated in the Plans. INLET AND OUTLET PIPES A. Inlet and outlet pipes must extend through the walls of the structure for a sufficient distance beyond the outside surface to allow for connection but must be cut off flush with the wall on the inside surface, unless otherwise directed. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA CATCH BASINS 02621-4 3.4 3.5 PLACEMENT AND TREATMENT OF CASTINGS, FRAMES, AND FITTINGS A. All castings, frames, and fittings must be placed in the positions indicated on the Plans or as directed by Owner, and must be set true to line and to correct elevation, all anchors or bolts must be in place and position before the concrete or mortar is placed. The unit will not be disturbed until the mortar or concrete has set. B. When frames or fittings are to be placed upon previously constructed masonry, the bearing surface or masonry must be brought true to line and grade and must present an even bearing surface in order that the entire face or back of the unit must come in contact with the masonry. The unit must be set in mortar beds and anchored to the masonry as indicated on the Contract Documents or as directed and approved by Owner. All units must be set firm and secure. C. After the frames or fittings have been set in final position and the concrete or mortar has been allowed to harden for 7 days, then the grates or covers must be placed and fastened down. D. When pre-cast concrete grade rings are used to reset frames to a new elevation, no more than four rings may be used. Total adjustment must be less than 12 inches. INSTALLATION OF STEPS A. 3.6 3.7 When steps are required with pre-cast concrete structures, they must be cast into the sides of the concrete structures at the time the sections of the structure are manufactured or the steps may be set in place after the structure is erected by drilling holes in the concrete and cementing the steps in place. BACKFILLING A. After a structure has been completed, backfill in accordance with the requirements of the detailed Drawings and Section 02222 - Trench Backfill. B. Backfilling must not be placed against any structure until tests made by the Owners testing laboratory establish that the concrete has attained or exceeded the strength requirements stated within these Specifications in order to provide a factor of safety against damage or strain in withstanding any pressure created by the backfill or the methods used in placing it. C. Backfill will be considered as a subsidiary obligation of the Contractor for the structure involved. GENERAL CLEAN-UP A. All rubbish and debris resulting from the Work of this Section must be collected, removed from the site and disposed of legally and in accordance with section 02316. B. All work areas must be left in a broom clean condition. END OF SECTION 02621 Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA CATCH BASINS 02621-5 SECTION 02714 CONCRETE PAVEMENTS PART 1 – GENERAL 1.1 RELATED DOCUMENTS A. B. 1.2 SUMMARY A. 1.3 Furnish and install all Concrete Pavement work as shown on the Contract Documents, and as specified herein, including but not limited to the following: 1. Concrete side walks, driveways, curbs, curbs and gutters, concrete pads, etc. 2. Curing and sealing concrete. 3. Expansion and contraction joints. B. Install colored concrete pavements at locations shown on the drawings. C. Install products and materials (furnished in other Sections) as shown on the Drawings, and as specified. REFERENCES A. 1.4 Drawings Book 1: Project Information, Instructions to Bidders, and Execution Documents (Not Used) SUBMITTALS A. Submit the following 1. 2. Samples and/or Product Data a. Product Data b. Samples (1) Joint filler, 12" length of each type. (2) Concrete Mix Design. Test Reports a. The Contractor shall employ an approved Quality Control (QC) testing laboratory which must make tests and perform inspection in accordance with these Specifications: (1) Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA Laboratory Test Report for the tests listed below in Section 1.5. CONCRETE PAVEMENTS 02714-1 3. Manufacturer’s Certification a. Submit certification that products meet or exceed the specified requirements. 1.5 QUALITY CONTROL A. Concrete Quality 1. Contractor must submit the mix designs prepared by the Concrete supplier to an independent Quality Control (QC) testing laboratory, employed by the Contractor, meeting the requirements of ASTM C1077. The testing laboratory must test and verify the mix designs prepared by Concrete Supplier for compliance with the Specifications and drawings. 2. No concrete must be placed until mix designs of 7 and 28 day test results from the Concrete supplier are submitted by the Contractor and accepted by the Owner. 3. The adequacy of a design must be verified by QC tests on a minimum of 6 cylinders; 2 tested at 3 days, 2 tested at 7 days and 2 at 28 days, in accordance with ASTMC 192 and C-39; by slump test in accordance with ASTM C 143, air test in accordance with ASTM C 231, and temperature test in accordance with ASTM C 1064. The number of tests required must be one (1) set of specimens for each day’s placement of each 100 cu yards of concrete, or fraction thereof. The Contractor must make and initially cure and store the test specimens in accordance with ASTM C31. The Contractor’s technician preparing the specimens must be currently certified to perform the required concrete sampling and testing. The Contractor must transport and deliver the test specimens to the testing laboratory for testing. The Contractor must be responsible for developing a system of recording the initial curing temperatures and this data must be kept by the Contractor and furnished on demand by the Owner. The Laboratory will make the actual tests on the specimens in accordance with ASTM C39. 4. If at anytime during construction the concrete resulting from the approved mix design proves to be unsatisfactory for any reason, such as lack of workability, of insufficient strength, the Contractor must immediately notify the Owner. The concrete supplier must verify the deficiency with additional testing and modify the design, subject to the Owner's approval, until a satisfactory concrete is obtained. If any retesting is required, the Contractor must pay the additional costs for retesting until the required results are achieved. The Contractor shall cooperate with the Testing Laboratory in every respect. 5. Strength requirements of concrete must be as noted on the Drawings. Concrete must be proportioned to achieve an average strength of 500 psi higher than design strength shown. If no design strength is shown, the design strength of the concrete must be 3500 psi at 28 days. 6. In cases where 28 day strength of cylinders falls below the required strength, the Owner will have the right to require core tests to be made on portions of concrete poured represented by the cylinders, at the Contractor's expense. Any portion of concrete work failing to meet required core tests must be removed and replaced with satisfactory work at no additional cost to the Owner. In all cases where strength of Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA CONCRETE PAVEMENTS 02714-2 the laboratory control cylinders, shown by these tests for any portion of concrete poured falls below the minimum ultimate compressive strengths specified, the Owner will have the right to order a change in mix or in water content for remaining portions of pavement and to require conditions of temperature and moisture necessary to secure required strengths. B. 7. When an approved water reducing admixture is used in accordance with manufacturer's recommendations, cement requirements may be reduced. Mix designs must indicate use of admixtures. 8. Slump must be 3 inches plus or minus 1 inch for footings and foundation walls, and 3 inches plus or minus 1-1/2 inches for balance of concrete work. Slump for Portland Cement Concrete (PCC) pavement must be ¾ inch to 1-1/2 inches; except that a slump above 1-1/2” may be used, up to a maximum of 3 inches, provided that the mixture’s water/cement ratio does not exceed 0.42. Concrete mixes containing plasticizers must have a maximum slump of 8”. The testing laboratory will have the right to reject any concrete which arrives at job site in excess of specified slump. No water will be added to design mix unless as directed in writing by Owner's representative. Slump must be determined in accordance with ASTM C 143. 9. All concrete exposed to weather or in contact with earth or backfill must be airentrained. Air-entrained concrete must be made with an air-entraining admixture. Air content must be within limits of 5 to 8 percent, net at time of placement. Air content must be determined in accordance with ASTM C 231. 10. Minimum cement content for PCC pavement must be 5.65 cwt per cu. yd. of central mixed concrete. Fine aggregate will not be less than 1/3, nor more than ½ of total aggregate. 11. A plasticizing admixture may be used when approved by the Owner for the purpose of reducing water requirements for a given consistency and strength of concrete and for increasing workability. Mixture must be used in accordance with manufacturer’s recommendations. A maximum reduction in cement content of ½ sack of cement per cubic yard may be made provided all other requirements are met. 12. The temperature of the mixed concrete must not be less than 50 degrees F and not more than 90 degrees F at the time of placement. Temperature must be determined in accordance with ASTM C 1064. Perform Work in accordance with the latest edition, of the appropriate divisions, of the following: 1. ACI 311 "Recommended Practice for Concrete Inspection". 2. ACI 304 "Recommended Practice for Measuring, Mixing, Transporting and Placing Concrete", except minimum cement content must be herein specified. 3. CSI "Manual of Standard Practice" 4. ACI 318 "Building Code Requirements for Reinforced Concrete". Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA CONCRETE PAVEMENTS 02714-3 5. ASTM C 94 "Specifications for Ready Mixed Concrete". 6. ACI 305 "Recommended Practice for Hot Weather Concreting". 7. ACI 306 "Recommended Practice for Cold weather Concreting". 8. "Standard Specifications for Road and Bridge Construction" prepared by the Illinois Department of Transportation latest edition is a separate book. The "Standard Specifications for Road and Bridge Construction" is referred to in the following articles as the Standard Specifications" and except as may be otherwise stated, the work to be done under this Section must conform to the requirements of said "Standard Specifications". Contractor's field office and laboratory is not a requirement. a. Where the "Standard Specification" refers to the "Engineer”, it must be understood to mean "Owner”, except in cases where it is deemed to be QC testing by the Contractor. b. Unless otherwise noted on Drawings or specified, the applicable articles of the following Sections of the "Standard Specifications" must govern: c. Sections 420, 423 and 424. (Note: Articles of the SSRBC covering method of measurement and basis of payment are not applicable.) 1.6 SPECIAL REQUIREMENTS A. Temperatures 1. When hot weather conditions as defined in ACI 305 exist, place and cure concrete in accordance with same. 2. When cold weather conditions as defined in ACI 306 exist, place and cure concrete in accordance with requirements of same. PART 2 - PRODUCTS 2.1 MATERIALS A. Portland Cement - ASTM C 150, Type I cement; or Type III (high-early strength cement) B. Aggregate for Normal Weight Concrete - All fine and coarse aggregate must conform to IDOT SSRBC Articles 1003.02 and 1004.02, respectively. 1. Fine Aggregates - Natural hard clean sand. 2. Coarse Aggregates - Crushed stone or gravel. C. Water - Clean, fresh, potable. D. Welded Wire Fabric - ASTM Al 85. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA CONCRETE PAVEMENTS 02714-4 E. Admixtures - Concrete admixtures must comply with ASTM C 494 (Water reducing) or ASTM C 260 (Air Entraining), produced by recognized manufacturer subject to Owner's approval. 1. Air Entraining Admixture - ASTM C 260, "Air Mix" (The Euclid Chemical Company); "MB-VR" (Master Builders); “Darex" (W.R. Grace & Co.); "Sika AER" (Sika Chemical Company): Add only to normal Portland cement concrete to meet requirements specified for air content. 2. Water Reducing Admixture - ASTM C 494, Type A, and not containing any; chloride ions added during manufacture, "Eucon WR-75" (The Euclid Chemical Company); "Pozzolith" 122N (Master Builders); "WRDA with Hycol" (W.R. Grace & Co.); "Plastocrete" (Sika Chemical Company). 3. Water Reducing, Retarding Admixture - ASTM C 494, Type D. When high temperatures, placing or humidity conditions dictate, "Eucon Retarder-75" (The Euclid Chemical Company); "Pozzolith 100-XR" (Master Builders); "Daratard HC" (W.R. Grace & Co.); "Plastiment" (Sika Chemical Company). 4. Plasticizing Admixture - "Pozzolith-N" (Master Builders)- "WRDA" (W.R. Grace & Co.); 'Plastiment" (Sika Chemical Company); or approved equal. When ambient temperature is expected to exceed 80 degrees F during placing and finishing operations, use "Pozzolith - R" (Master Builders); "Daratard" (W.R. Grace & Co.). 5. Calcium chloride must not be used. F. Bonding Agent - Epoxy type, 100 per cent solids "Euco Epoxy #452 (dry surface), #463" (dry or damp surface), (The Euclid Chemical Company); "Sikadur Hi-Mod" (dry or damp surface) (Sika Chemical Co.); "Duralbond 102" (dry or damp surface), (Dural International Corp.). G. Patching and Surfacing Compound - Epoxy type, 100 per cent solids, "Euco Epoxy #456 Mortar (dry surface), #460 (dry or damp surface)", (The Euclid Chemical Company); "Sikadur Lo-Mod Mortar” (dry or damp surface) (Sika Chemical Co.); "Duraltex" (dry or damp surface), (Dural International Corp.). H. Surface Retardant - (Exposed Aggregate finish): 1. 2. 3. "Lithochrome - Top Surface Grade" (L.M.Scofield Co.). “MBT REVEAL” – BASF, The Chemical Company “TOP-STOP” - W.R. MEADOWS, INC. I. Form Material - Provide metal or wood templates and forms conforming to profiles, lines and dimensions as shown, of substantial design and construction to maintain position and shape when concrete is placed. All forms must be subject to the acceptance of the Owner. J. Form Oil - Suitable for the type of forms used and the conditions of use. K. Expansion Joint Filler - ASTM D994 - "Asphalt Expansion Joint Filler” W.R. Meadows. Expansion Joint must be full depth of joint. L. Construction Joints - Between all concrete pours suspended for thirty (30) minutes or more, must be a construction joint as shown and detailed on the Plans. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA CONCRETE PAVEMENTS 02714-5 M. Curing Materials 1. Absorptive Cover - Burlap cloth made from jute or kenaf, weighing approximately 9 oz. per sq. yd., complying with ASSHO M 182, Class 3 or cotton mats complying with ASTM C 440. 2. Moisture-Retaining Cover - One of the following: 3. 2.2 a. Waterproof Paper - ASTM C 171, Type 1 or Type 11. b. Polyethylene Sheeting - AASHO M 171. c. Polyethylene-coated burlap. Liquid Membrane Curing Compound - ASTM C 309, Type 1, resin type, clear, unless otherwise directed, for vertical and horizontal surfaces, "Horn Clear-Seal" (W. R. Grace & Co.); "Acri Seal S" Toch Brothers Division, (Carboline Company); "Kure-N-Seal" (Sonneborn-Contech). MIXING CONCRETE A. Concrete for this Project must be ready-mix concrete; must be batched and delivered from a plant approved by Owner and in strict accordance with the requirements set forth in ASTM C 94, subject to all provisions specified herein regarding materials, strength, proportioning, consistency and delivery time. Delete the references for allowing additional water to be added to the batch for material with insufficient slump. Additional amounts of water to the batch, either at the plant or at the Job site will not be permitted, except upon specific approval of Owner in each instance and only if confirmed by calculations utilizing batch weights performed by the Contractor’s QC to not exceed the design water to cement ratio. B. The rate of delivery of the ready mixed concrete must be such that the interval between placing of successive batches must be 30 minutes or less to prevent "cold joints". The elapsed time between the introduction of mixing water to the cement and aggregate and completion of discharge must not exceed one (1) hour. C. Minimum mixing for each batch must be that required to produce a uniform mixture of materials but in no case less than 70 revolutions after all materials are in the mixer, including water. D. The ready-mixed concrete producer must submit duplicate delivery tickets, one (1) for the Contractor and one (1) for Owner, with each load of concrete delivered to the job. Delivery tickets must provide the following information: 1. Date. 2. Name of ready-mix concrete plant. 3. Contractor. 4. Job Location. 5. Type (Standard or High Early Strength) and brand of cement. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA CONCRETE PAVEMENTS 02714-6 6. Cement content in bags per cubic yard of cement. 7. Truck number. 8. Time dispatched and time unloaded. 9. Amount of concrete in load in cubic yards. 10. Admixtures in concrete, if any. 11. Type and maximum size of aggregate. 12. Water added at job, if any. 13. Name of person who authorized addition of water. E. Close control of mixing time must be maintained for air-.entrained concrete. F. The batching plant testing laboratory engaged by the Contractor must periodically check batch proportions and yield strength, and must have continuous access to the mixer. PART 3 - EXECUTION 3.1 INSPECTION A. 3.2 PREPARATION A. 3.3 Before pouring concrete, examine substrate surfaces to determine that they are free of conditions which might be detrimental to proper and timely completion of the work. Start of work must indicate acceptance of the substrate. Sub-grade and sub-base - Before proceeding with the installation of paving or concrete work, the Contractor must carefully examine the sub-base and must perform any minor grading, shaping, filling or other preparatory work required in the opinion of the testing laboratory or Owner prior to placing the base course. Building up of sub-grade under forms after they are in place will not be permitted. PLACING CONCRETE A. Concrete must not be placed until all reinforcement is securely and properly fastened in its correct position; all anchors, sleeves, inserts, pipes, conduits, and other items required to be embedded therein have been inspected and approved by Owner. B. In no case will concrete be placed upon frozen base course or subgrade material. Discontinue concrete operations when the air temperature is expected to fall below 40 degrees F during the 24 hour period after placing concrete or when the air temperature is likely to remain below 30 degrees F during the succeeding 6 days; unless provisions for heating aggregates, sand and water have been made, the Contractor has submitted a Cold Weather Paving Plan, and the methods proposed for protecting the concrete has been approved by Owner. In such cases, provide heated concrete in accordance with ASTM C 94 and follow procedures as outlined in "Recommended Practice for Cold Weather Concreting" ACI 306. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA CONCRETE PAVEMENTS 02714-7 C. 3.4 3.5 Accelerating or antifreeze admixtures must not be used. The Contractor is responsible for the protection of finished concrete against all damage or injury, including freezing until the work has been completed and accepted. The Contractor will be held responsible for any defective work resulting from freezing or injury in any manner during placing and curing, and must replace such work at his or her expense. CONCRETE PAVEMENT - SIDEWALKS, CURBS, DRIVEWAYS, PARKING LOT PAVEMENT, CONCRETE PADS, ETC. A. Construct all concrete pavements, side walks, curbs, driveways, parking lot pavement indicated on the Drawings, to the lines, grades and Sections indicated. Concrete must be proportioned and mixed as specified, strengths as scheduled. Air entraining must be incorporated in the mix by adding an approved admixtures air content of concrete must be within limits of 5% to 8% net at time of placement, in accordance with ASTM C 231. B. Unless otherwise indicated or noted on Drawings, lay off pavements into Sections not exceeding 40 feet in length, separated by expansion joints extending full depth of slab. Unless otherwise shown, expansion filler must be 3/4 inch thick, of material as specified. C. Unless otherwise indicated or noted on Drawings, expansion joints in curbs must be spaced not more than 40 feet on centers. Unless otherwise shown, joints must be 3/4 inch thick. D. Pitch work as indicated on the Drawings for drainage, approximately 1/8 inch per foot, or as required between the new work and existing work to remain, to assure an even transition is made. Level off slabs with strike-off rod and finish to true and even surface with floats and trowel, leaving a smooth surface. After the water sheen has disappeared, the surface must be given a final finish by brushing with a brush drawn across the sidewalk at right angles to the edges of the walk, with adjacent strokes slightly overlapping, producing a uniform, slightly roughened surface with parallel brush strokes. Wheel chair ramps must be similarly finished, except for heavier brooming transverse to slope of ramps. E. The surface must be divided by grooves saw cut at right angles to the center line of the pavement or sidewalk. These grooves must be ½ inch deep and not less than inch and not more than 1/4 inch in width. Unless otherwise noted on Drawings, spacing of grooves between expansion joints is not to exceed 5'-0" centers. F. Forms for concrete curbs and combination concrete curbs and gutters must be removed within 24 hours after the concrete has been placed. Minor defects must be filled with mortar composed of one part Portland cement and two parts of fine aggregate. The exposed surfaces must be finished smooth and given a light brush finish, while the concrete is still green. The edges must be rounded with approved finishing tools having the radii shown on the Drawings. G. After the concrete has set sufficiently, the spaces in back of the curb or combination curb and gutter must be backfilled to the required elevation with approved material which must be compacted until firm and solid and neatly grade. CURING AND PROTECTION A. Protect freshly placed concrete from defacement, premature drying and excessive cold or hot temperature, and maintain without drying at a relatively constant temperature for a period of time necessary for hydration of cement and proper hardening. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA CONCRETE PAVEMENTS 02714-8 B. Start initial curing as soon as free water has disappeared from concrete surface after placing and finishing. C. Begin final curing procedures immediately following initial curing and before concrete has dried. Continue final curing for at least 168 hours (7 days). D. Concrete must be cured by one of the following methods or by combinations thereof, as approved: B. 3.6 Moisture Curing - Cover concrete surface with specified absorptive cover, thoroughly saturating cover with water and keeping continuously wet. Place absorptive cover to provide coverage of concrete surfaces and edges, with 4" lap over adjacent absorptive covers. At the Contractor's option, moisture curing may also be provided by ponding or continuous water spraying, where approved by Owner. 2. Moisture Retaining Cover Curing - Cover concrete surfaces with moisture-retaining cover for curing concrete, placed in widest practicable width with sides and ends lapped at least 3" and sealed by waterproof tape or adhesive. Immediately repair any holes or tears during curing period using cover material and waterproof tape. 3. Membrane Curing - Apply membrane-forming curing compound to damp concrete surfaces as soon as water film as disappeared and surface is hard enough to carry applicator's weight without damage. Apply uniformly in 2 - coats continuous operation by power-spray equipment in accordance with manufacturer's directions. Maintain continuity of coating and repair all damage during curing period. Unless otherwise specified herein or as directed by Owner, Moisture curing or a combination of moisture curing and moisture retaining cover curing must be employed for all exterior concrete pavement work which is to receive a "Surface Sealer”. SURFACE SEALER A. B. 3.7 1. All concrete pavements, sidewalks, curbs and gutters must be cured in accordance with Section 1022 of Illinois Department of Transportation Standard Specifications for Road and Bridge Construction latest edition. All exterior concrete placed after October 1, which may be subject to deicing chemicals must be protected with a two-coat application of boiled linseed oil as described in Section 420.18 of SSRBC. Pavement, sidewalks, curbs and gutters poured before October 1, will not require a linseed oil sealer. HOT AND COLD WEATHER CONCRETING A. In hot weather, mix, place, and cure concrete according to ACI 305 "Recommended Practice for Hot Weather Concreting". B. In cold weather, mix, place and cure concrete according to ACI 306, "Recommended Practice for Cold Weather Concreting". Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA CONCRETE PAVEMENTS 02714-9 3.8 CLEAN-UP A. All rubbish and debris resulting from the work of this Section must be collected, removed from the site and disposed of legally. B. All work must be left in a broom clean condition. END OF SECTION 02714 Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA CONCRETE PAVEMENTS 02714-10 SECTION 02720 AGGREGATE BASE COURSE PART 1 - GENERAL 1.1 RELATED DOCUMENTS A. B. 1.2 Drawings Book 1: Project Information, Instructions to Bidders, and Execution Documents SUMMARY A. Work Under this Section Includes: 1. 1.3 REFERENCES A. 1.4 Furnish and install all granular material which must consist of a base course, hereinafter referred to as the Aggregate Base Course, composed of granular materials constructed on a prepared sub grade or underlying course in accordance with these Specifications, and in conformity with the dimensions and typical cross section shown on the Drawings. Illinois Department of Transportation (IDOT): Standard Specifications for Road and Bridge Construction, adopted January 1, 2012, including all addenda. SUBMITTALS A. Submit the following 1. Samples and/or Product Data a. b. 2. Product Data: (1) Gradation of CA-6 aggregate materials (2) Gradation of CA-7 aggregate materials Samples: (1) CA-6 aggregates (2) CA-7 aggregates Test Reports a. Submit test reports necessary to show compliance with the Contract Documents. (1) Proctor of the CA-6 and CA-7 aggregate materials in accordance with ASTM D1557. (2) Proctor of existing subgrade in accordance with ASTM D1557. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA AGGREGATE BASE COURSE 02720-1 3. Contractor shall submit a certification letter from the Owner of the source property that all material is virgin. Backfill must meet requirements of Section 02318. PART 2 - PRODUCTS 2.1 MATERIALS A. Aggregate Base Course must be in accordance with Section 351 of the “Standard Specifications.” B. The aggregate base course material must consist of crushed stone having a gradation of CA-6 conforming to the requirements of Article 1004 of the Illinois Department of Transportation’s Standard Specifications for Road and Bridge Construction, latest edition (SSRBC). C. Protection – Protect materials against damage from mechanical abuse, salts, acids, and other foreign matter by an approved means during transportation, storage and placement and until completion of construction work. All unsatisfactory materials must be removed from the premises, and all damaged materials replaced with new materials. PART 3 - EXECUTION 3.1 3.2 3.3 GENERAL A. The aggregate base course must be placed where designated on the Drawings. The material must be shaped and thoroughly compacted within the tolerances specified. B. Stabilization stone must only be placed in areas of severely adverse sub grade conditions. Stabilization stone must be crushed stone having a gradation of CA-1, quality D, conforming to Article 1004.01 of the IDOT SSRBC. C. Granular bases which, due to grain sizes or shapes, are not sufficiently stable to support without movement the construction equipment must be mechanically stabilized to the depth necessary to provide such stability. The mechanical stabilization must principally include the addition of the fine-grained medium to bind the particles of the base material sufficiently to furnish a stable bearing strength. EXCAVATING AND PREPARING UNDERLYING SUBGRADE A. Refer Part 3 of section 02300 Excavation and Earthwork for Excavation and preparing underlying subgrade B. All excess excavation and excavated materials that cannot be reused at site must be legally disposed off in accordance with Section 02316. MATERIALS ACCEPTANCE IN EXISTING CONDITION A. When the entire aggregate base or stabilization stone material is secured in a uniform and satisfactory condition and contains the required moisture, such approved material may be Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA AGGREGATE BASE COURSE 02720-2 moved directly to the spreading equipment for placing. The material may be obtained from gravel pits, stockpiles, or may be produced from a crushing and screening plant with the proper blending. The materials from these sources must meet the requirements for gradation, quality, and consistency. It is the intent of this Section of the Specifications to secure materials that will not require further mixing. The moisture content of the material must be that required to obtain maximum density. Any minor deficiency or excess of moisture may be corrected by surface sprinkling or by aeration. In such instances, some mixing or manipulation may be required, immediately preceding the rolling, to obtain the required moisture content. The final operation must be blading or dragging, if necessary, to obtain a smooth uniform surface true to line and grade. 3.4 PLANT MIXING A. 3.5 When materials from several sources are to be blended and mixed, the material must be processed in a central or travel mixing plant. The material must be thoroughly mixed with the required amount of water. After the mixing is complete, the material must be transported to and spread on the underlying course without undue loss of the moisture content. GENERAL METHODS FOR PLACING A. The aggregate base course must be constructed to the thickness shown on the Drawings. The aggregate base course must be constructed in lifts not more than 4 inches thick when compacted, except that if tests indicate that the desired compaction and results are being obtained, the compacted thickness of any lift may be increased to a maximum of 8 inches. The material, as spread, must be of uniform gradation with no pockets of fine or coarse materials. The aggregate base course, must not be spread more than 2,000 square yards in advance of the rolling. Any necessary sprinkling must be kept within this limit. No material will be placed in snow or on a soft, muddy, or frozen course. B. When more than one layer is required, the construction procedure described herein must apply similarly to each layer. C. During the placing and spreading, sufficient caution must be exercised to prevent the incorporation of sub grade, shoulder, or foreign material in the aggregate base course mixture. All contaminated materials must be removed and replaced at no additional cost to the project. D. Where geotextile fabric is required to be placed under the aggregate course, it must be placed over the sub grade in accordance with the manufacturer's recommendations and Section 02073. The aggregate base course material must be back-dumped on the fabric in a sequence of operations beginning at the outer edges of the area with subsequent placement toward the middle. Dumping of the material directly on the fabric must only be permitted to establish an initial working platform. No vehicles or construction equipment must be allowed on the fabric prior to the placement of the aggregate base course. Fabric which is damaged during installation or subsequent placement of aggregate base course must be repaired or replaced by the Contractor at his own expense. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA AGGREGATE BASE COURSE 02720-3 3.6 3.7 FINISHING AND COMPACTING A. After spreading or mixing, the material must be thoroughly compacted by rolling and sprinkling, when necessary. Sufficient rollers must be furnished to adequately handle the rate of placing and spreading of the aggregate base course. Ensure top surface of base course is true to lines and grades indicated, with all points within 1/2 in. of indicated elevations. B. The field density of the compacted material must be at least 95 percent of the maximum density and +/-2% of the optimum moisture content of laboratory specimens prepared from samples of the sub base material delivered to the job site for CA-6 material. The laboratory specimens must be compacted and tested in accordance with ASTM D1557. C. The dry density of the compacted base course, will be determined y the Owner, who will employ a Testing Laboratory, which shall make tests and perform inspection at regular intervals according to AASHTO T 191, Illinois Modified AASHTO T 310 (Direct Transmission Density /Backscatter Moisture), or by other methods approved by the Owner. But in the event any test fails the Contractor must pay the additional costs for retesting until the required results are achieved. The Contractor shall cooperate with the Testing Laboratory in every respect. D. The course will not be rolled when the underlying course is soft or yielding or when the rolling causes undulation in the sub base. When the rolling develops irregularities that exceed ½ inch when tested with a 16'-0" straightedge, the irregular surface must be loosened and then refilled with the same kind of material as that used in constructing the course and again rolled as required above. E. Along places inaccessible to rollers, such as areas adjacent to curbs, catch basins, manholes the base material must be tamped thoroughly with mechanical or hand tampers. F. Sprinkling during rolling, if necessary, must be in the amount and by equipment approved by Owner. Water must not be added in such a manner or in a quantity that free water will reach the underlying layer and cause it to become soft. EQUIPMENT A. The Contractor may use any type of earth moving, compaction, and watering equipment it may desire or has at its disposal, provided that the equipment is in satisfactory condition and is of sufficient capacity to perform the work as specified. The only requirements specified are that tamping rollers (generally referred to as Sheepsfoot Rollers) will be considered the proper type of equipment for compaction of cohesive soils and vibratory/mechanical tamping equipment will be applicable for compacting granular soils. Subgrade rollers can be used to smooth minor surface deviations in both types of subgrade/embankment, but in no case will a steel wheel or vibratory roller be used to compact cohesive embankment. Due to inadequate equipment will not be cause for delay or additional payment. The Contractor must furnish, operate, and maintain such equipment as is necessary to control density, section, and smoothness of grade. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA AGGREGATE BASE COURSE 02720-4 3.8 SURFACE TEST A. 3.9 THICKNESS A. 3.10 The thickness of the completed base course must be determined by depth tests or cores taken at intervals so each test must represent no more than 500 square yards. When the deficiency in thickness is more than ½ inch, the Contractor must correct such areas by scarifying, adding satisfactory mixture, rolling, sprinkling, reshaping, and finishing in accordance with these Specifications. The Contractor must replace at his/her expense the aggregate base material where borings are taken for test purposes. PROTECTION A. 3.11 After the course is completely compacted, the surface must be tested for smoothness and accuracy of grade and crown; any portion found to lack the required smoothness or to fail in accuracy of grade or crown must be scarified, reshaped, recompacted, and otherwise manipulated until the required smoothness and accuracy are obtained. The finished surface must not be above the theoretical vertical grade and may not vary more than ½ inch when tested with a 16'-0" straightedge applied parallel with, and at right angles to the centerline. Work on aggregate base course must not be conducted during freezing temperature nor when the subgrade is wet. When the base material contains frozen material or when the underlying course is frozen, the construction must be stopped. MAINTENANCE A. Following the final shaping of the material, the base must be maintained throughout its entire length by the use of standard motor graders and rollers until, in the judgment of Owner; the aggregate base course meets all requirements and is acceptable for the construction of the next course. The Contractor is totally responsible for the preparation, maintenance and protection of the aggregate base course and no additional compensation will be considered for any reworking of the material for any reason. END OF SECTION 02720 Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA AGGREGATE BASE COURSE 02720-5 SECTION 02783 PAVEMENT MARKING PART 1 - GENERAL 1.1 RELATED DOCUMENTS A. Drawings B. Book 1: Project Information, Instructions to Bidders, and Execution Documents 1.2 SUMMARY 1.3 1.4 A. The Work shall conform to the applicable portions of Section 780 of the Illinois Department of Transportation Standard Specification for Road and Bridge Construction, (SSRBC) current edition including latest revisions and any Supplemental Specifications and Recurring Special Provisions thereto, except as modified herein. B. Furnish all labor, materials, tools, transportation and equipment required for removing existing pavement marking and applying pavement marking. SUBMITTALS A. Product Data: Submit manufacturers’ product data for traffic marking paint and handicapped parking signs demonstrating compliance with the specified requirements. B. Material Certificates: Provide copies of materials a certificate signed by material producer and contractor, certifying that each material item complies with, or exceeds, specified requirements. C. Pavement Marking Plan: Submit 4 copies of the pavement marking plan, indicating lane separations, dedicated handicapped parking spaces, crosswalk lines and diagonally striped access aisles, parking space lines, and other markings. Dedicated handicapped parking spaces shall be marked with the international graphics symbol. Handicapped traffic markings shall comply with the Illinois Accessibility Code and the Americans with Disabilities Act. REFERENCES A. Illinois Department of Transportation (IDOT): Standard Specifications for Road and Bridge Construction, adopted January 1, 2012, including all addenda. PART 2 - PRODUCTS 2.1 MATERIALS Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA PAVEMENT MARKING 02783-1 A. Materials shall be according to applicable portions of Section 780 of the SSRBC (current edition). 1. Pavement Markings will be used in accordance with Articles 780.05 and 780.06 and Articles 1095.01 and 1095.02 of the SSRBC on concrete and bituminous pavements. PART 3 - EXECUTION 3.1 INSTALLATION A. Pavement marking shall not be installed until the pavement has been final surfaced and approved by the Owner. B. Paint pavement marking shall be applied twice to increase the thickness. This work shall be performed in two separate applications, not one thicker application. The application of paint shall be in accordance to Article 780.06 of the SSRBC. C. Pavement marking installation shall conform to applicable portions of Section 780 of the SSRBC (current edition) and shall be installed at the locations shown on the drawings. D. The Contractor shall remove pavement marking as shown on the drawings. The Contractor shall only use shot blasting to remove markings. Removal by grinding will not be permitted. END OF SECTION 02783 Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA PAVEMENT MARKING 02783-2 SECTION 02831 ORNAMENTAL FENCE AND GATES PART 1 - GENERAL 1.1 RELATED DOCUMENTS A. B. 1.2 Drawings Book 1: Project Information, Instructions to Bidders, and Execution Documents SUMMARY A. Section includes: 1. 2. 1.3 Steel pedestrian and vehicular gates including hardware for the 6’ high fence. Short fence installed on curb SUBMITTALS A. Shop Drawings: Submit Shop Drawings for steel fences, including plan layout, details and gate hardware. B. Descriptive Data: Submit detailed description of entire coating process including metal preparation and coating. 1. C. 1.4 Include experience of applicators. Test Reports: Submit design mix for ready mixed concrete and delivery tickets. QUALITY ASSURANCE A. Codes and Standards: Comply with the provisions of the following, except as otherwise shown and specified: 1. AWS “Structural Welding Code” as applicable. B. Qualification for Welding Work: Qualify welding processes and welding operators in accordance with AWS “Structural Qualification Procedure.” C. Installer Qualifications: Engage an experienced Installer who has at least three years experience and has completed at least five fence projects with similar material and scope to that indicated for this Project with a successful construction record of in-service performance. D. Coater Qualifications: Engage a single experienced Coater who has at least three years experience and has completed fencing projects in the Chicagoland area where the installed product can be viewed. E. Pre-installation Conference: Conduct preconstruction conference at the project site: 1. Review survey and lot line stakes to ensure proper location. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA ORNAMENTAL FENCE AND GATES 02831-1 1.5 PROJECT CONDITIONS A. 1.6 Field Measurements: Verify layout information for fencing shown on the Drawings in relation to the property survey and structures. Verify dimensions by field measurements. WARRANTY A. Provide a warranty on the steel fencing system including installation, materials, and workmanship for five years except for the coating, which shall be warranted for a period of ten years including cracking, peeling, blistering, and corrosion. PART 2 - PRODUCTS 2.1 MATERIALS A. Metal Surfaces: For the fabrication of items which will be exposed to view, use only materials which are smooth and free of surface blemishes, including pitting, seam marks, roller marks, rolled trade names, and roughness. Remove such blemishes by grinding, or welding and grinding, prior to cleaning, treating and application of surface finishes. B. Steel Materials: 1. 2. C. Fasteners: 1. 2. 3. 2.2 Steel Plates, Shapes and Bars: ASTM A 36. Steel Tubing: ASTM A 501, or ASTM A 500. General: Provide stainless steel fasteners for exterior use or where built into exterior walls. Select fasteners for the type, grade and class required for the installation of metal items. Masonry Anchorage Devices: Expansion shields, FS FF-S-325. Toggle Bolts: Tumble wing type, FS FF-B-588, type, class and style as required. FABRICATION A. Shop Assembly: Pre-assemble items in the shop to the greatest extent possible, so as to minimize field splicing and assembly of units at the Project Site. Disassemble units only to the extent necessary for shipping and handling limitations. Clearly mark units for reassembly and coordinated installation. B. Fence Fabrication: 1. 2. 3. Use materials of the size and thickness shown using proven details of fabrication and support. Provide caps on all posts. Mechanically attach caps to posts. Form exposed Work true to line and level with accurate angles and surfaces and straight, sharp edges. Ease exposed edges to a radius of approximately 1/32”. Weld seams continuously and in accordance with the recommendations of AWS. Grind welds smooth and flush to match blend with adjoining surfaces. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA ORNAMENTAL FENCE AND GATES 02831-2 4. 5. 6. 7. 2.3 Form exposed connections with hairline joints which are flush and smooth, using concealed fasteners wherever possible. Use exposed fasteners of the type shown or, if not shown, use tamper-proof screws or bolts. Connect fence sections to vertical posts using 3/8” x ½” bolts with secure nuts. Provide for anchorage and space anchoring devices to provide adequate support for the intended use of the Work. Cut, reinforce, drill and tap Metalwork indicated to receive other items. STEEL PEDESTRIAN AND VEHICULAR GATES A. Manufacturer for 6’ high fence is Omega II fence system with Double wire panels or Approved equal. B. Fabrication: Fabricate frame of steel tubes of sufficient size to support gate free of sag, closed ends, welded all around and ground smooth to eliminate water entry. C. Gate Hardware: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. Hinges: Size, material, and number to suit gate size, non-lift off type, offset to permit 180-degree gate opening. Latch: Gate latch to receive padlock; non-ferrous operating parts. Latches to be ADA lever type, not requiring pinching or twisting. Finish to match fence. Keeper: Provide a keeper for vehicle gates that automatically engages gate leaf and holds it in the open position until manually released. Gate Stops: Provide gate stops for double gates consisting of mushroom-type flush plate with anchors, set in concrete and designed to engage a center drop rod or plunger bar. Include a locking device and padlock eyes as an integral part of the latch, permitting both gate leaves of double gates to be locked with a single padlock. Cast Iron Roller: Provide cast iron rollers at bottom rail of each vehicle double gate at latch end. 2.4 CONCRETE A. Provide 3000 PSI air entrained ready-mixed concrete conforming to ASTM C-94, maximum 3” slump. 2.5 SHOP FINISHING A. Surface Preparation: 1. 2. B. Shot blast posts and fabricated assemblies and accessories to SSPC-SP 10/NACE No. 2, "Near-White Blast Cleaning" no more than 8 hours prior to the coating process. Clean in a heated two-stage process including spray washing and cleaning, utilizing a total immersion cleaning process each stage utilizing a heated alkaline cleaner to remove all grease, dirt or other contaminants. Rinse by totally immersing assemblies and accessories in a rinse tank and then totally immerse in a conditioner to prepare surface for coating. Priming and Preparation: Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA ORNAMENTAL FENCE AND GATES 02831-3 1. 2. 3. C. General: System shall consist of a twelve stage electro-deposition process consisting of a twelve stage cleaning, pre-treating, zinc phosphating, rinse, epoxy coating and post rinsing process followed by an oven cure. Totally immerse assemblies and accessories in a heated zinc phosphate coating. solution. Zinc Phosphate coating shall have a total dry film thickness of 150 to 350 milligrams per square foot. Apply an electro-deposition epoxy coating to a dry film thickness of 0.7 to 1.2 mils. Coating: 1. Apply TGIC Polyester Green texture powder coating to a total dry film thickness of 2 to 3 mils. TGIC texture green powder coating to match Rohn & Haas 31-6074. a. D. Color: Match "Greenscreen" Wrinkle-Textured Green, as specified in Section 10242 - "Trellage". Corrosion Protection: Coat concealed surfaces which will be in contact with concrete, masonry, wood, or dissimilar metals, in exterior work and work to be built into exterior and below grade walls and decks with a heavy coat of bituminous paint. Do not extend coating onto exposed surfaces. PART 3 – EXECUTION 3.1 INSTALLATION A. General: Do not begin fence installation and erection before the final grading is completed with finish elevations established, unless otherwise permitted. 1. B. Space line posts no more than 5 ft. on center. Excavation: 1. 2. Unless otherwise indicated, excavate hole depths approximately 3" lower than the post bottom, with bottom of posts set not less than 36” below the surface when in firm, undisturbed soil. Remove excavated soil from the Owner’s property. When soil rock is encountered near the surface, drill into rock at least 12” for line posts and at least 18” for end, pull, and corner posts. Drill hole at least 1” greater diameter than the largest dimension of the post to be placed. a. C. If solid rock is below soil overburden, drill to full depth required, except penetration into rock need not exceed the minimum depths specified above. Setting Posts: 1. 2. 3. 4. Remove all loose and foreign materials from sides and bottoms of holes, and moisten soil prior to placing concrete. Center and align posts in holes 3" above bottom of excavation. Place concrete around posts in a continuous pour, and vibrate or tamp for consolidation. Check each post for vertical and top alignment, and hold in position during placement and finishing operations. Protect portion of posts above ground from concrete splatter. Trowel finish tops of footings, and slope or dome to direct water away from posts. Set keeps, stops, sleeves and other accessories into concrete as required. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA ORNAMENTAL FENCE AND GATES 02831-4 5. Grout in posts set into sleeved holes, concrete constructions, or rock excavations with non-shrink Portland cement grout, or other acceptable grouting material. D. Set accurately in location, alignment and elevation, plumb, level, true and free of rack, measured from established lines and levels. E. Brace temporarily or anchor temporarily in formwork where Work is to be built into concrete or similar construction. F. Anchor securely as required for the intended use, using concealed anchors wherever possible. G. Fit exposed connections accurately together to form tight, hairline joints. Seal sleeved joints with butyl sealant. H. Core drill holes not less than 1" greater than the outside diameter of post. Clean holes of all loose materials, insert posts, and fill the space between post and concrete with non-shrink, nonferrous grout. I. Gates: Install gates plumb, level, and secure for full opening without interference. Adjust hardware for smooth operation and lubricate where necessary. J. Concrete Strength: Allow concrete to attain 75% of its minimum 28-day compressive strength, but in no case sooner than 7 days after placement. 3.2 COATING REPAIR A. 3.3 Factory-Finish Touchup: Clean abraded areas and repair with an air dried material used for factory finish according to fence manufacturer's or fabricator's written instructions. PROHIBITED PROCESS A. Do not cut or weld any portion of the fencing system after the factory coating has been applied. END OF SECTION 02831 Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA ORNAMENTAL FENCE AND GATES 02831-5 SECTION 02910 SOIL PREPARATION, LANDSCAPE EXCAVATION AND BACKFILL PART 1- GENERAL 1.1 DESCRIPTION A. Section Includes 1. Furnish and place topsoil and planting mixtures to meet finished grade elevations. 2. Soil testing of supplemental topsoil and on-site topsoil. 3. Excavation of all landscape planting beds including tree pits, turf areas and planters/garden plots to receive planting mixtures or topsoil to the specified depths. 4. Preparation and placement of topsoil and planting mix in landscape planting beds/garden plots and turf areas to required finished grades including all soil amendments. 5. Finished grading of all landscape planting beds and turf areas. 6. Furnish and placement of landscape insulation and landscape fabric in raised planters. 1.2 RELATED SECTIONS A. 1.3 Section 02300 – Excavation and Earthwork QUALITY ASSURANCE A. Qualifications 1. The contractor shall be a company specializing in landscape construction with a minimum of five (5) years of experience on comparable projects. B. Code and Standards Compliance 1. All materials and work shall comply with applicable codes, standards and with the requirements of local agencies. The Contractor shall obtain all permits required. 1.3 SUBMITTALS A. Topsoil Data 1. Provide, to the Owner, the location(s) and name(s) of topsoil sources from which supplemental topsoil is to be obtained for the project, approximate quantities obtained at each site, depth at which soil was taken and indicate whether crops had grown on site(s). Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA SOIL PREPARATION, LANDSCAPE EXCAVATION AND BACKFILL 02910 - 1 B. Soil Testing 1. The Contractor shall provide soil tests of both on-site topsoil and supplemental topsoil prior to delivery of any topsoil to the site. Employ an independent testing lab that uses methods approved by the Association of Agricultural Chemists to test two (2) samples of the on-site topsoil and two (2) samples of the proposed supplemental topsoil. Submit a report to the Owner containing soil tests, lab analysis stating whether topsoil meets specification requirements and lab suggestions for amendment. The Owner will specify soil amendments required. Soil Tests a. Chemical Analysis: include pH, Cation Exchange Capacity (CEC), Organic Matter (OM), phosphorus, potassium (K), soluble salts, essential nutrients and any harmful chemicals. b. Mechanical Analysis: include percentages of sand, silt and clay. c. Lab recommendations for amendments. C. Other Samples The following materials shall be submitted to the Owner for approval prior to delivery to the site. 1. Submit 1 quart samples of soil mix materials: peat and sand to be used in preparation of the planting mix and/or a sample of the specified pre-packaged soil mix , to be used in planter pots, for review. 2. Submit samples and manufacturers data for landscape fabric and landscape insulation to be used in raised planters for review and approval the Owner. 3. Submit manufacturer’s data for fertilizers and amendments recommended by the soil testing analysis. 1.4 PRODUCT DELIVERY, STORAGE AND HANDLING A. Topsoil and Planting Mixtures 1. Coordinate and deliver soil to pre-approved staging areas. Inform the Owner of all delivery schedules, twenty-four (24 ) hours in advance of delivery. 2. All deliveries of topsoil which in any way fails to meet the requirements of these specifications will be rejected, and the Contractor shall immediately remove such rejected topsoil from the premises and supply suitable topsoil in its place. 3. No deliveries will be permitted when weather conditions are unsatisfactory, or if the approved staging area is not in a satisfactory condition to receive topsoil. No frozen topsoil will be accepted. Do not deliver or handle soil in wet, muddy or frozen conditions. Protect stockpiles from winds and disturbance with landscape fabric or other material. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA SOIL PREPARATION, LANDSCAPE EXCAVATION AND BACKFILL 02910 - 2 4. Trucks making deliveries shall use routes as directed to avoid damage to property. The Contractor shall deliver topsoil in dump trucks having pneumatic tires and shall be unloaded from the trucks where directed. All topsoil that is deposited other than in the place designated shall be moved. B. Other Materials Handle and store all other materials according to manufacturer’s recommendations. 1.5 JOB CONDITIONS A. General 1. Prior to beginning work, the Contractor shall examine and verify the acceptability of the job site and notify the Owner of unsatisfactory conditions. The Contractor shall not proceed with the work until unsatisfactory conditions have been corrected or resolved. 2. Where soil preparation occurs in close proximity to other site improvements, adequate protection shall be given to all features prior to commencing work. Any items damaged during soil preparation operations shall be promptly repaired to their original condition at no addition to the Base Contract Price. B. Availability of On-Site Topsoil 1. Some topsoil may be available on site that has beed stripped and stockpiled for the Contractor’s use. Soil that is tested and meets the specifications for topsoil may be used as suitable subgrade fill in planting bed and turf areas and as backfill in planting beds and turf beds. C. Utilities Have all underground utilities located by servicing agencies. In the vicinity of utilities, hand excavate to minimize the possibility of damage to underground utilities. D. Excavation When conditions detrimental to plant growth are encountered such as limestone, rubble fill, adverse drainage conditions, or obstruction, notify the Landscape Architect prior to placement of any soil. PART 2 - PRODUCTS 2.1 MATERIALS A. Subgrade Fill Material 1. Where site conditions require a layer of fill below the specified bed depth, provide a clean, debris-free mineral material with a brown sandy clay content and granular material with no stones measuring larger than one inch in diameter. The pH should range between 5.5 to 6.5 with no limestone present. Gray clay soils shall not be accepted. 2. Stockpiled on-site topsoil may be used as subgrade fill if it meets requirements for pH range of 5.5 to 6.5, contains no limestone and is free of debris. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA SOIL PREPARATION, LANDSCAPE EXCAVATION AND BACKFILL 02910 - 3 B. Planting Mixture Materials 1. Topsoil a. Topsoil shall be a sandy loam mineral soil, uniform in color and texture; corresponding to native soils; containing no gray clay and free from grass roots, sod, weeds. rocks, stiff clay, clods, or any other substance undesirable to plant growth. The soil shall be loose, friable, and of good tilth. The pH shall rage between 5.5 to 6.5. b. Nutrient data as follows. All soil sampling and testing shall comply with prodedures in the USDA Ag. Handbook 60: Diagnosis and Improvement of Saline and Alkali Soils. Phosphorus Min. 75 lbs./ac. Potassium Min. 300 lbs./ac. Calcium Min. 1,500 ppm Cation Exchange Capacity Min. 20 mea/100g Soluble Salt Max. 1,000 ppm c. Organic content shall not be less than 3 percent and not greater than 10 percent determined by loss of ignition. d. Gradation: Sieve Designation No. 4 (4.76 mm) No. 10 (2.00 mm) No. 18 (1.00 mm) No. 35 (500 micron) No. 60 (250 micron) No. 140 (105 micron) No. 270 (53 micron) Percent Passing 100 95 - 100 90 - 100 65 - 100 0 - 50 0 -20 0 -10 e. Textural Grades: Fine gravel, course sand, medium sand 20 - 40 % Silt 25 - 60 % Clay 5 - 20 % Clay content shall be determined by Bouyoucous hydrometer Test. 2. Sand shall be clean, sharp, course sa nd passing 1/4” mesh screen and free of foreign and organic matter. The pH shall range between 5.5 to 6.5. 3. Sphagnum Peat shall be finely shredded, homogenous, partly decomposed plant mater and leaves with a 90% content of organic peat moss suitable for horticultural purposes. Peat shall be free of residue lumps, roots, stones or other foreign matter. Shredded particles shall not exceed 1/4” in diameter. Peat shall be measured in dry conditions and contain no more than 35% moisture by weight. Ash content shall not exceed 10%. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA SOIL PREPARATION, LANDSCAPE EXCAVATION AND BACKFILL 02910 - 4 B. Other Materials 1. Landscape Insulation: 2” thick extruded polystyrene meeting the requirements of ASTM C578-92, Type IV, with an R rating of 10, such as Amofoam as manufactured by Amoco Foam Products, phone: 1-800-241-4402 or approved equal. 2. Landscape Fabric: 100% continuous filament, non-woven , polyester landscape fabric with a weight of 4.2 oz/yd, 70 mils thick, needle punched such as Trevira Spunbond #1114 or approved equal. C. Planting Mixtures All landscape planting beds, tree pits, raised planters and garden plots shall be backfilled with a planting mixture described below. All soil mixtures shall be mixed with amendments and other materials by hand or mechanical methods prior to placement. All topsoil shall be tested and amended per test results. a. Planting beds/raised planters: beds for perennials, groundcovers and annuals shall be prepared with planting mix containing four parts approved topsoil and one part sphagnum peat. b. Shrub Beds and Tree pits: backfill with approved topsoil. c. Planter Pots: filled with Metro Mix 702 that can be obtained through Floral Supplies Factory, phone: 1-800-828-2242 or approved equal. d. Turf Areas/Prairie Grass Areas: prepared with approved topsoil. C. pH Adjustment Soil pH adjustments will be made based on soil test lab recommendations. 1. Limestone: Calcium carbonate (ground limestone) with 50% passing a No. 200 mesh sieve , 90% passing a N0. 100 mesh sieve and 100% passing a No.10 mesh sieve. Total carbonates shall not be less than 80%. 2. Sulfur: Granular sulfur. PART 3 -EXECUTION 3.1 PREPARATION Protection of Site Improvements: Protect all existing site improvements during excavation. If any existing improvements are damaged, replace or make arrangements with the proper authorities for repair. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA SOIL PREPARATION, LANDSCAPE EXCAVATION AND BACKFILL 02910 - 5 3.2 PERFORMANCE A. Turf Bed Preparation: Distribute required soil amendments evenly and thoroughly per soil test results and incorporate fertilizer into the top layer of dry topsoil. B. Planting Bed Preparation: Prior to installation of any plant material, ensure all tree pits, planting and raised planters to be free of debris and not in a muddy condition prior to backfill with specified planting mixture. Loosen the bottom of the pit or bed and ensure that all stones larger than 1” diameter and that all limestone have been removed from the subgrade to a depth of 12 inches. C. Landscape Excavation and Backfill 1. Excavate existing planting areas, planting beds, garden plots, turf beds and tree pits as indicated on the drawings and to the following depths: a. Turf Beds 6” minimum depth b. Groundcover/Perennial Beds 12” minimum depth c. Shrub Beds 24” minimum depth d. Large Shrub and Tree Pits 4” below bottom of root ball and 2’ greater than diameter of root ball on each side. Note: Where shrubs and perennials/groundcover are to be planted in the same bed, provide bed depths to meet the minimum depth for shrubs. Provide additional excavation of tree pits where trees are to be planted in shrub and perennial beds. 2. Compact subgrade in planting beds to 85% proctor density. Where pavement and other structures have been removed, bring planting bed to sub-grade with suitable subgrade fill. 3. After planting beds have been prepared and planting operations completed backfill planting areas, garden plots, turf beds and tree pits with specified planting mixtures and to grades and profiles shown on the plans. Fill and shape berms to meet grades and elevations shown on the plans. Berms may be adjusted to meet field conditions. Final shape to be approved by Owner. Rough grading of all areas shall be within 1/10th of grades shown on the Construction Drawings. 3.3 CLEANUP AND PROTECTION A. Clean Up 1. Debris and excess material shall be removed from the site immediately. 2. When an excavation or backfill area is completed, completely clean up all soil piles and sweep all walks and drives. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA SOIL PREPARATION, LANDSCAPE EXCAVATION AND BACKFILL 02910 - 6 3. All existing sidewalks and driveways providing access to on-site buildings shall be kept clean and free of obstructions. Other paved areas shall be cleaned when work in adjacent areas is completed. B. Protection Protect all completed work from disturbance from operations of other trades and trespassers. Replace damaged work to specified conditions. END OF SECTION Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA SOIL PREPARATION, LANDSCAPE EXCAVATION AND BACKFILL 02910 - 7 SECTION 02930 TREES, SHRUBS, PERENNIALS & GROUNDCOVERS PART 1 - GENERAL 1.1 SUMMARY A. Section Includes Installation, maintenance and warranty of all trees, shrubs, ground cover, perennials, annuals and vines shown on the plans and specified herein. 1.2 RELATED SECTIONS A. Section 02910 - Soil Preparation, Landscape Excavation and Backfill 1.3 QUALITY ASSURANCE A. Qualifications 1. The Contractor shall be a company specializing in landscape installation with a minimum of five (5) years of experience on comparable projects. B. Code and Standards Compliance All materials and work shall comply with applicable sections of the following references: 1. American Association of Nurserymen, Inc. (MN) Standard: American Standard for Nursery Stock (ANSI Z60-.1 -1990) 2. Hortus Third, Cornell University,1976 C. Source Quality Control 1. Certification: All landscape materials shall be from stock inspected and certified by authorized governmental agencies. The stock shall comply with governmental regulations prevailing at the supply source and the job site. 2. Analysis and Standards: Products packaged in sealed containers shall be labeled with manufacturer's certified analysis. The composition of bulk materials shall be tested by an approved laboratory in accordance with procedures established by the Association of Official Agricultural Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA TREES, SHRUBS, PERENNIALS & GROUNDCOVERS SOIL REPARATION, LANDSCAPE 02930 - 1 Chemists, wherever applicable, or as specified by product specifications referenced herein. 3. Plant Material Selection: a. Plant materials must be supplied by a nurseries located in Northern Illinois. b. Prior to digging and shipment by the nursery, plant materials shall be tagged by the contractor or nursery for inspection and approval by the Owner. Notify the Owner of locations of tagged material at least four weeks prior to scheduled planting. D. Substitutions 1. If specified landscape material is not obtainable, notify the Owner, who will identify alternate sources or substitutes. Substitutions made shall not the Base Contract Price. If substitutions are smaller in size than the specified material, credits to the Base Bid Contract will be made based on comparable cost differentials customary for materials and sizes involved. 2. Plants shall be supplied at the minimum sizes specified. Plants larger than the minimum size may be used upon approval of the Owner. 3. Container plants may be substituted for those designated ”B & B” only if approved by the Owner. E. Soil Preparation The preparation of soil/planting mixtures shall conform to the requirements of Section 02910, Soil Preparation, Landscape Excavation and Backfill 1.4 SUBMITTALS A. Samples: Representative samples of the following materials shall be provided from the supply source being used: 1. Plant Material: Owner reserves right to tag and/or inspect plant stock at the nursery prior to delivery to the site. 2. Mulch: five pound sample. 4. Tree Wrap: two linear foot sample. 5. Anti-transpirant: manufacturer’s product data. 6. Steel Edging: one linear foot sample. B. Certification Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA TREES, SHRUBS, PERENNIALS & GROUNDCOVERS SOIL REPARATION, LANDSCAPE 02930 - 2 1. Phytosanitary Certification All plant material inspection certificates required by federal, state or other governing authorities will accompany each shipment and be turned over to the Owner upon delivery. 2. Delivery Tickets Freight bill for each shipment of plants shall be submitted to the Owner at time of delivery. C. Toxic Chemicals Submit manufacturer’s data for all products, areas of application, and anticipated uses of pesticides, herbicides, and fumigants. 1.5 PRODUCT DELIVERY, STORAGE, AND HANDLING A. General 1. Notify the Owner forty-eight hours in advance of all delivery times for plant material. 2. Store materials only in locations approved by the Owner. B. Packaged Materials Deliver packaged materials in unopened containers showing weight, analysis, and name of manufacturer. During shipment and storage on site, protect materials from breakage, moisture, heat, or other damage and according to manufacturer’s recommendations. C. Plant Materials 1. Schedule shipping to minimize on site storage of plants. Stock shall not be shipped until the planting preparations have been completed. 2. Label the size and variety of plant and securely attach to individual plants or to bundles of like variety and size. 3. During shipment, plants shall not be bent, stacked, or bound in a manner that damages bark, breaks branches, deforms root balls, or destroys natural shape. 4. Plant material shall be transported within enclosed trailers or covered by tarpaulin to protect the material from damage caused by drying winds, heat, freezing, or other exposure that may be harmful to the plants. Plant material arriving at the site in a damaged condition shall be rejected and removed from the site. 5. If delays beyond the Contractor's control occur after delivery, plants shall be kept watered and protected from sun, wind, and mechanical damage; root balls shall be Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA TREES, SHRUBS, PERENNIALS & GROUNDCOVERS SOIL REPARATION, LANDSCAPE 02930 - 3 covered with topsoil or mulch. Container-grown stock shall not be removed from containers until planting time. Keep the roots constantly moist until planted. 6. Handle plants at all times in accordance with the best horticultural practices. Lift B & B materials from the bottom of the ball only. Balled and burlapped plants which have cracked or broken balls are not acceptable and shall be replaced. 1.6 JOB CONDITIONS A. General 1. Prior to beginning work, the Contractor shall examine and verify the acceptability of the job site and notify the Owner of unsatisfactory conditions. Do not proceed with the work until unsatisfactory conditions have been corrected or resolved. 2. Where planting occurs in close proximity to other site improvements, provide adequate protection for all site areas prior to commencing work. Any items damaged during planting operations shall be promptly replaced or repaired to their original condition at no addition to the Base Contract Price. B. Utilities All underground utilities shall be located by servicing agencies. Excavation for planting in the vicinity of utilities shall be done by hand to minimize possibility of damage. C. Excavation When conditions detrimental to plant growth are encountered such as limestone, rubble fill, adverse drainage conditions, or obstructions, notify the Owner before any planting activities. D. Planting Season Plant material shall be dug and planted only during the planting season appropriate for each individual plant species. Pre-digging of plants with proper storage may extend the planting season. However, the installation of plant material outside the normal planting season shall be done only with the approval of the Owner. E. Work Schedule 1. Upon authorization to proceed with the work, a project work schedule indicating the dates of each of the following items will be prepared by the Contractor and submitted to the Owner: a. Tagging of plant material in nurseries. b. Staking of plant locations on the site. c. Digging and preparation of plant pits and beds. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA TREES, SHRUBS, PERENNIALS & GROUNDCOVERS SOIL REPARATION, LANDSCAPE 02930 - 4 d. Delivery of plant material to the site. e. Planting schedule f. Substantial completion of the work. F. Coordination With Other Work 1. Proceed with complete landscape work as rapidly as portions of the site become available, working within the season limitations for each kind of landscape work required. 1.7 GUARANTEE A. General 1. Warrant all plant material to be true to botanical name and of specified size. 2. All dead or damaged plant material shall be removed from the site and replaced prior to Project Acceptance and the initiation of the Guarantee Period. The Guarantee Period shall begin upon written notification of Project Acceptance by the Owner. Project Acceptance will occur only upon the full completion of all work under this Contract. 3. After receiving notice of Project Acceptance, all plant materials shall be maintained in a vigorous condition and warranted against defects including death, improper maintenance, and unsatisfactory growth, for 12 months following Project Acceptance. B. Replacements 1. During the Guarantee Period, replace, at no additional expense to the Owner, plant materials that are dead or that are, in the opinion of the Owner, in an unhealthy or unsightly condition, or that have lost their natural shape due to dead branches, excessive pruning, or inadequate or improper maintenance. Rejected plant materials shall be removed from the site and legally disposed of at no addition to the Base Contract Price. 2. Only one replacement of any plant is required after Project Acceptance, except for losses or replacement resulting from failure to comply with specified requirements. However, all plant material shall be in a healthy and vigorous state of growth at time of project acceptance. 3. Replacement plants and planting operations shall be in accordance with the original specifications. Replacements shall be made no later than the next succeeding planting season. Fully restore areas damaged by replacement operations to their original and specified condition. 4. Replacement stock shall be obtained from the same plant material source of the original material. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA TREES, SHRUBS, PERENNIALS & GROUNDCOVERS SOIL REPARATION, LANDSCAPE 02930 - 5 PART 2 - PRODUCTS 2.1 MATERIALS A. Plant Material 1. Provide plant materials true to name and variety established by the American Joint Committee on Horticultural Nomenclature Standardized Plant Names", Second Edition, 1942, as indicated on the Drawings. 2. All planting stock shall be nursery-grown in accordance with good horticultural practice. Plants shall be free of disease, insects, eggs, larvae, and defects such as knots, sunscald, injures, abrasions, or disfigurement. They shall be sound, healthy and vigorous, of uniform growth, typical of the species and variety, well formed, free from irregularities, with the minimum quality conforming to American Standard for Nursery Stock. 3. Plants indicated as “specimen plants” shall be exceptionally heavy, symmetrical, and tightly knit, cultured, to be unquestionably superior in form, branching, compactness, and symmetry. 4. The minimum acceptable sizes of all plants shall be measured before pruning and with branches in normal position. Unless otherwise designated on the Drawings, all plant dimensions shall conform to those listed in ANSI A60.1, American Standard for Nursery Stock. a. Where height is indicated within a range, the smaller dimension is the minimum acceptable; the larger dimension represents the maximum permissible except with approval of the Owner. The average dimension of all plants must at least equal the average of the height range specified. b. Spread shall meet the minimum dimension specified in all directions and must be considered as pivoting on the center of the plant. Where range is shown between two spread dimensions, the smaller dimension is the minimum acceptable. Spreads shall at least average on the average of the range indicated. c. Caliper is the trunk diameter taken at a specified distance above root collar as described in ANSI Z60.1. d. Branching point is the distance above ground where balanced branching occurs or where a dimension on trunk appears to form the head of the tree. 5. Root Treatment: a. Root treatments on all plants shall conform to the requirements of ANSI Z60.1. Plants shall be dug and prepared for shipment in a manner that will not cause damage to branches, shape, and future development after planting. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA TREES, SHRUBS, PERENNIALS & GROUNDCOVERS SOIL REPARATION, LANDSCAPE 02930 - 6 b. Balled and burlapped (“B & B”) plants shall have a firm, natural ball of earth of sufficient diameter and depth to encompass the fibrous and feed root systems necessary for full recovery of the plant. Ball shall be securely wrapped with burlap and bound with cord. Ball sizes shall meet the requirements of the ANSI Z60.1. c. Plants furnished in containers shall have the roots well established in the soil mass and shall have grown in the container for at least one growing season. Containers shall be large enough to provide earth-root mass of adequate size to support the plant tops being grown. Plants, other than ground covers, over-established in the container, as evidenced by pot-bound root ends, will not be accepted. 6. Plant materials shall be subject to final approval by the Owner at the site. The Owner reserves the right to reject any plant material that does not meet project specifications at the time of planting. B. Topsoil Topsoil for landscape work shall be amended as specified in specification section 02910, Soil Preparation, Landscape Excavation and Backfill. C. Hardwood Bark Mulch Mulch shall be finely shredded and processed composted hardwood bark, free from other foreign material. D. Tree Wrap Tree wrap shall be waterproofed crepe paper 2-1/2 (64 mm) inches wide, made up of two layers of crepe. Owner shall inspect tree trunk prior to placing tree wrap. E. Steel Edging Edging shall be 3/16” x 4” commercial steel edging with stake loops stamped in to the face and provided with 15” minimum length tapered steel anchoring stakes as manufactured by Ryerson or approved equal. Color to be natural. F. Tree Paint Tree paint shall be waterproof, asphalt base paint with antiseptic properties for use on tree wounds such as Toch Bros. R.1.W. Tree Surgery Paint, Sherwin Williams Pruning Compound or approved equal. G. Anti-transpirant Anti-transpirant shall be a protective film emulsion providing protective film over plant surfaces, permeable to permit transpiration, as manufactured by WILT PRUF, INC. or approved equal. Mix and apply in accordance with manufacturer’s instructions. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA TREES, SHRUBS, PERENNIALS & GROUNDCOVERS SOIL REPARATION, LANDSCAPE 02930 - 7 H. Herbicide Herbicide shall be a product with a rates of application that conforms with registered uses and is applied by a licensed professional. I. Fertilizer Granular, natural organic, non-burning product composed of no less than 50% organic matter, slow release, low salt, guaranteed analysis professional fertilizer such a Milorganite Natural Organic fertilizer (6-2-0 Plus 4% Iron) or approved equal. J. Guying and Staking Materials 1. Stakes for tree support shall be hardwood free from knot, rot, cross grain or other defects that would impair strength. Stakes shall be pressure treated with pentachlorophenol, and a minimum of 2” by 2” in diameter by 8’-0” long and pointed on one end. 2. Ground anchors for guying shall be 2” x 2” x 3’-0” long wood stake, pointed on one end. 3. Guying wire shall be 12 gauge annealed galvanized steel. 4. Guying cable shall be a minimum of five strands, making a 3/16” diameter steel cable. 5. Hose chafing guards shall be new or used 2-ply, one half inch reinforced rubber or plastic hose and shall be the same color on the project. Length shall be one and one-half times the circumference of the plant at its base. 6. Survey flags to be fastened to guys shall be white plastic surveyor’s tape, 6” in length. 7. Turnbuckles shall be galvanized or cadmium-plated steel and have a 3” minimum lengthwise opening fitted with screw eyes. PART 3 - EXECUTION 3.1 PREPARATION A. Layout 1. Individual plant locations shall be staked on the project site by the Contractor and approved by the Owner before any planting operations commence. The Owner reserves the right to adjust plant material locations to meet field conditions, without additions to the Base Contract Price. 2. Accurately stake plant material according to the drawings. Stakes shall be 2 inches x 4 inches x 4 foot length above grade, not painted, with plant designation and size labeled on stake. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA TREES, SHRUBS, PERENNIALS & GROUNDCOVERS SOIL REPARATION, LANDSCAPE 02930 - 8 3. If obstructions are encountered that are not indicated, do not proceed with planting operations until alternate plant locations have been selected and approved in writing by the Owner. Where location or spacing dimensions are not clearly shown, request clarification from the Owner. 3.2 PERFORMANCE A. General 1. Rocks/underground obstructions shall be removed and proper planting depths shall be established to conform with Soil Preparation, Landscape Excavation and Backfill, Section 02930. If underground utilities or other structural obstructions are encountered, alternate planting locations will be determined by the Owner. 2. Plant Pit Excavation a. Planting pits shall be round, with vertical sides and flat bottoms, and sized in accordance with the specification and dimensions shown on the drawings. b. If rotating augers or other mechanical diggers are used to excavate holes, the vertical sides of the pits shall be scarified, fractured, or otherwise broken down to eliminate impervious surfaces. c. Loosen or scarify soil in the bottom of all plant pits to a depth of 4 inches. 3. If existing soil is to be used, it shall meet the requirements of specification for topsoil as contained in Section 02910. Beds shall be excavated to proper depths and amended as specified. Plant beds shall be brought to a smooth and even surface conforming to established grades. 4. Excavated material that does not meet specifications for topsoil will not be used for backfill in any planter or planting pit and shall be removed to an area designated by the Owner. B. Planting Operations 1. When the ground is frozen, no planting activities shall occur. 2. Balled and burlapped (“B & B”) Trees and Large Shrubs: Place a minimum of 4 inches of approved topsoil in the bottom of the pit, or to depth necessary to set the plant to required grade and compact. Set the plant in the pit to the same relationship to the grade as in the original container or at the top of the burlap ball, faced to give the best appearance or relationship to one another and adjacent structures. Cut away burlap, rope, wire, or other wrapping materials 1/3 of the way from the top of the ball and remove from pit. Do not remove burlap or ties from sides or bottom of ball. If plastic wrap or other non-biodegradable materials are used in lieu of burlap, completely Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA TREES, SHRUBS, PERENNIALS & GROUNDCOVERS SOIL REPARATION, LANDSCAPE 02930 - 9 remove them before placing of backfill. Cleanly cut off broken or frayed roots. Place approved topsoil and fertilizer around the ball and carefully compact to avoid injury to the roots and to fill the voids. Apply fertilizer at a rate recommended by the manufacturer. After backfilling planting pit approximately two-thirds full, add water and allow planting mixture to settle. After the water has been absorbed, fill the planting pit with topsoil tamp light to grade and form a watering basin of the size indicated. In tree grates, set top of root ball to allow a two inch air space between the mulch layer and the bottom of the grate. 3. Plant container-grown shrubs as specified above for balled and burlapped plants and as modified herein. Remove containers before planting and loosen the sides of root ball in several places, freeing the roots on the outside of the ball sufficiently to encourage rapid root extension into the surrounding soil and to prevent girdling of root mass. 4. Plant groundcover, perennials and annuals so that the top of the root mass is even with the surrounding grade. Adjust spacing as necessary to evenly fill planting bed with indicated quantity of plants. Plant to within 6 inches of edge of bed. Backfill planting with specified planting mixture and fertilizer at a rate recommended by manufacturer. 5. Planting of shrubs, groundcovers, bulbs and annuals around tree root balls shall occur beyond the perimeter of the root ball. Do not plant directly over any root balls. C. Mulching 1. Mulching shall take place within 48 hours after planting, using approved materials. 2. Mulch shrub beds to a uniform depth of 2 inches. Mulch trees within the soil saucer to a depth equal to the depth of the saucer, but not less than two inches. Mulch ground cover and perennial areas to a uniform depth of 2 inches. 3. Mulch shall be kept out of the crowns of shrubs and off buildings, sidewalks, light standards, and other site improvements. 4. Form mulch rings around trees and large shrubs that are with in turf areas. D. Pruning 1. General a. After planting, prune the branches of deciduous stock to balance the loss of roots in such manner as to retain the natural form of the plant type. Pruning shall be done by workmen experienced in this type of work. The Owner shall approve pruning techniques and appearance before proceeding with all pruning. b. Trimmings shall be removed from the site and legally disposed. 2. Trees Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA TREES, SHRUBS, PERENNIALS & GROUNDCOVERS SOIL REPARATION, LANDSCAPE 02930 - 10 a. Prune trees by removing all dead wood, badly formed, interfering limbs, and sufficient other growth to ensure healthy and symmetrical growth of new wood. Up to one-third of the branches may be removed. The proportion is, in all cases, subject to the approval of the Owner. The central leader shall not be removed. b. In the case of multiple leaders, preserve the one which will best promote the symmetry of the tree, and remove or cut back the remainder so that they will not compete with the selected leader. Cut back surrounding top branches to conform to the leader. c. Paint cut surfaces over 1 inch in diameter with tree wound dressing. 3. Shrubs Prune shrubs by removing all dead wood and broken branches, thinning out canes and cutting back or removing asymmetrical branches. Pruning shall result in a loose outline conforming to the natural shape of the shrub type. Shearing to unnatural shapes will not be accepted. E. Wrapping 1. The trunks of broadleaf trees shall be wrapped immediately after planting but not before the condition of the trunks has been inspected and approved by the Owner. 2. Trees shall be wrapped in the specified material beginning at the base and extending to the first branches. The wrap shall be applied in a spiral manner with an overlap of one-half the width of the paper. 3. The wrapping shall be securely tied at the top and bottom and at 18 inch (45 cm) maximum intervals with twine. F. Other Procedures 1. Apply anti-transparent to all broadleaf evergreen shrubs in all planting beds.. 2. Stake or guy deciduous trees/large shrubs and evergreen trees if they fail to remain plumb. Tree bracing method shall be approved by Owner. 3.3 CLEAN UP AND PROTECTION A. Clean Up 1. Excess and waste material shall be removed daily. 2. When planting in an area has been completed, the area shall be cleared of all debris, soil piles, containers and all paved areas swept. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA TREES, SHRUBS, PERENNIALS & GROUNDCOVERS SOIL REPARATION, LANDSCAPE 02930 - 11 3. At least one paved pedestrian access route and one paved vehicular access route to each building shall be kept clean at all times. Other paving shall be cleaned when work in adjacent areas is completed. B. Repairs Any damage to existing landscape, paving, or other such features as a result of work related to this contract shall be repaired by the responsible Contractor to its original condition. C. Protection Protect landscape work and materials from damage due to landscape operations, operations by other Contractors and trades, and trespassers. Maintain protection during installation and maintenance periods. Treat, repair, or replace damaged landscape work as directed. D. Remove all tree wrap, labels and seals one year after the date of substantial completion. 3.4 ACCEPTANCE A. Project Acceptance Project Acceptance for work under this Section 02930 shall occur when all work (all sections) required under this Contract has been completed in conformance with the Contract Documents. The Owner shall provide written notification of Project Acceptance. B. Inspections for Project Acceptance 1. Notification of Completion of Planting Work a. Contractor shall notify the Owner in writing of the completion of planting operations. b. Within 10 days after notification of completion of work under this Section 02930, the Owner will inspect the work and prepare a punch list of items that require completion or correction. c. Contractor shall complete the work called for on the punch list prior to Final Inspection for Project Acceptance. 2. Final Inspection a. The final inspection of all work under this Contract will be made by the Contractor and the Owner. b. Before Project Acceptance will be made, the terms of the warranty shall be met and the site shall be in the condition stipulated under Final Cleanups. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA TREES, SHRUBS, PERENNIALS & GROUNDCOVERS SOIL REPARATION, LANDSCAPE 02930 - 12 c. When all work required under this Contract has been completed in conformance with the Contract Documents, the Owner shall issue a written notice of Project Acceptance. END OF SECTION Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA TREES, SHRUBS, PERENNIALS & GROUNDCOVERS SOIL REPARATION, LANDSCAPE 02930 - 13 SECTION 12001 SITE FURNISHINGS PART 1 – GENERAL 1.1 RELATED DOCUMENTS A. B. C. D. 1.2 Drawings Book 1: Project Information, Instructions to Bidders, and Execution Documents Book 2: Standard Terms and Conditions for Construction Contracts Book 2A: Standard Terms and Conditions Procedures Manual SUMMARY A. 1.3 The work in this section includes fabrication and installation of the following items as shown on the drawings and specified herein: 1. Benches (with backrest and backless) 2. Trash Receptacles 3. Outcroppings 4. Granite stones around trees 5. Shade structure 6. Storage box SUBMITTALS A. Product Data: Submit manufacturers specifications and installation instructions for all products specified herein. B. Samples: Submit sample for each type of finish indicated. C. Shop Drawing: Submit drawings for all items noted in 1.2A of this section. 1.4 QUALITY ASSURANCE A. Shop Assembly: Preassemble in shop to extent possible to minimize field splicing and assembly. Disassemble only as necessary for shipping and handling limitations. Clearly mark units for reassembly and coordinate installation. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA SITE FURNISHINGS 12001-1 PART 2 - PRODUCTS 2.1 MATERIALS A. Bench is Timberform steel bench Model 2808 from Manufacturer Columbia Cascade Co. or Dumor steel bench Model #93 from Nutoys. B. Trash Receptacle – Dimensions as shown on the detail sheet. gallon plastic waste receptacle C. Shade structure – 12’ x 12’ from Poligon Fabric or approved equal. D. Storage box – Jobox 5’x3’minimum dimension. E. Outcropping and granite cobblestones – Size as shown on the drawings. Manufacturer: Rehrig-Pacific 95 PART 3 - EXECUTION 3.1 EXAMINATION A. 3.2 Contractor must examine the areas and the conditions under which all items are to be installed and notify the Architect in writing of conditions detrimental to the proper and timely completion of the work. Do not proceed with work until unsatisfactory conditions have been corrected in a manner acceptable to the owner’s representative. PREPARATION A. Coordinate setting drawings, diagrams, templates, instructions, and directions for installation of anchorages such as sleeves, concrete inserts, anchor bolts and miscellaneous items having integral anchor which are to be imbedded in concrete or masonry. Coordinate delivery of such items to project site. B. Field Measurements: Take field measurements prior to preparation of shop drawings and fabrication where possible. Do not delay progress. Allow for adjustments during installation where taking field measurements before fabrication might delay work. C. Layout: Mark the locations of site furnishings with chalk, stakes or other appropriate marking devices for the Owner’s review prior to installation. The Landscape Architect may, at his option, require the Contractor to layout the actual assembled furnishing on the site prior to installation. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA SITE FURNISHINGS 12001-2 3.3 INSTALLATION A. 3.4 General 1. Fit exposed connections accurately together to form tight, hairline joints. 2. Perform cutting, drilling and fitting required for installation of site furnishings. Set work accurately in location, alignment and elevation plumb, level, true, non-rocking and free of rack, measured from established lines and levels. Do not weld, cut or abrade surfaces of components which have been coated or finished after fabrication, and are intended for field connection by mechanical means without further cutting or fitting. 3. Setting: Set furnishings straight, plumb, level true to line, and at elevations indicated on the drawings, or in the event none are indicated, flush with the adjacent paving or other surface. ADJUST AND CLEAN A. Protect finish of all items from damage during construction period by use of temporary protective coverings used by manufacturer. Remove protective covering at project completion or when directed by Architect. Restore finishes damaged during installation and construction period so that no evidence remains of connection work. Return items which cannot be refinished in the field to the shop; make required alterations and refinish entire unit or provide new units as required. B. Touch up painting: Immediately after each erection, clean field welds, bolted connections, abraded areas of shop paint, and paint-exposed areas with some same material. Surface preparation, prime coat, and finish coast to be in accordance with manufacturer’s instructions. END OF SECTION 12001 Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA SITE FURNISHINGS 12001-3 SECTION 16060 GROUNDING AND BONDING FOR ELECTRICAL SYSTEMS PART 1 - GENERAL 1.1 A. 1.2 A. RELATED DOCUMENTS Drawings and general provisions of the Contract, including General and Supplementary Conditions and Division 01 Specification Sections, apply to this Section. SUMMARY This Section includes methods and materials for grounding systems and equipment 1. 1.3 Underground distribution grounding. SUBMITTALS A. Product Data: For each type of product indicated. B. Other Informational Submittals: Plans showing dimensioned as-built locations of grounding features specified in Part 3 "Field Quality Control" Article, including the following: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. Test wells. Ground rods. Ground rings. Grounding arrangements and connections for separately derived systems. Grounding for sensitive electronic equipment. C. Qualification Data: For testing agency and testing agencies field supervisor. D. Field quality-control test reports. E. Operation and Maintenance Data: For grounding to include the following in emergency, operation, and maintenance manuals: 1. Instructions for periodic testing and inspection of grounding features at test wells. a. b. Tests shall be to determine if ground resistance or impedance values remain within specified maximums, and instructions shall recommend corrective action if they do not. Include recommended testing intervals. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA GROUNDING AND BONDING FOR ELECTRICAL SYSTEMS 16060-1 1.4 A. QUALITY ASSURANCE Testing Agency Qualifications: An independent agency, with the experience and capability to conduct the testing indicated, that is a member company of the International Electrical Testing Association or is a nationally recognized testing laboratory (NRTL) as defined by OSHA in 29 CFR 1910.7, and that is acceptable to authorities having jurisdiction. 1. Testing Agency's Field Supervisor: Person currently certified by the International Electrical Testing Association to supervise on-site testing specified in Part 3. B. Electrical Components, Devices, and Accessories: Listed and labeled as defined in NFPA 70, Article 100, by a testing agency acceptable to authorities having jurisdiction, and marked for intended use. C. Comply with UL 467 for grounding and bonding materials and equipment. PART 2 - PRODUCTS 2.1 CONDUCTORS A. Insulated Conductors: Copper wire or cable insulated for 600 V unless otherwise required by applicable Code or authorities having jurisdiction. B. Bare Copper Conductors: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. C. 2.2 A. Solid Conductors: ASTM B 3. Stranded Conductors: ASTM B 8. Tinned Conductors: ASTM B 33. Bonding Cable: 28 kcmil, 14 strands of No. 17 AWG conductor, 1/4 inch in diameter. Bonding Conductor: No. 4 or No. 6 AWG, stranded conductor. Bonding Jumper: Copper tape, braided conductors, terminated with copper ferrules; 1-5/8 inches wide and 1/16 inch thick. Tinned Bonding Jumper: Tinned-copper tape, braided conductors, terminated with copper ferrules; 1-5/8 inches wide and 1/16 inch thick. Grounding Bus: Rectangular bars of annealed copper, 1/4 by 2 inches in cross section, unless otherwise indicated; with insulators. CONNECTORS Listed and labeled by a nationally recognized testing laboratory acceptable to authorities having jurisdiction for applications in which used, and for specific types, sizes, and combinations of conductors and other items connected. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA GROUNDING AND BONDING FOR ELECTRICAL SYSTEMS 16060-2 B. Bolted Connectors for Conductors and Pipes: Copper or copper alloy, bolted pressuretype, with at least two bolts. 1. C. 2.3 Pipe Connectors: Clamp type, sized for pipe. Welded Connectors: Exothermic-welding kits of types recommended by kit manufacturer for materials being joined and installation conditions. GROUNDING ELECTRODES A. Ground Rods: Stainless steel, sectional type 3/4 inch by10 feet in diameter. B. Chemical-Enhanced Grounding Electrodes: Copper tube, straight or L-shaped, charged with nonhazardous electrolytic chemical salts. 1. 2. Termination: Factory-attached No. 4/0 AWG bare conductor at least 48 inches long. Backfill Material: Electrode manufacturers recommended material. PART 3 - EXECUTION 3.1 APPLICATIONS A. Conductors: Install solid conductor for No. 8 AWG and smaller, and stranded conductors for No. 6 AWG and larger, unless otherwise indicated. B. Underground Grounding Conductors: minimum. 1. 2. C. Bury at least 24 inches below grade. Duct-Bank Grounding Conductor: Bury 12 inches above duct bank when indicated as part of duct-bank installation. Grounding Bus: Install in electrical and telephone equipment rooms, in rooms housing service equipment, and elsewhere as indicated. 1. 2. D. Install bare copper conductor, No. 2/0 AWG Install bus on insulated spacers 1 inch, minimum, from wall 6 inches above finished floor, unless otherwise indicated. Where indicated on both sides of doorways, route bus up to top of door frame, across top of doorway, down to specified height above floor, and connect to horizontal bus. Conductor Terminations and Connections: 1. 2. Pipe and Equipment Grounding Conductor Terminations: Bolted connectors. Underground Connections: Welded connectors except at test wells and as otherwise indicated. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA GROUNDING AND BONDING FOR ELECTRICAL SYSTEMS 16060-3 3. 4. 3.2 A. 3.3 Connections to Ground Rods at Test Wells: Bolted connectors. Connections to Structural Steel: Welded connectors. GROUNDING UNDERGROUND DISTRIBUTION SYSTEM COMPONENTS Comply with IEEE C2 grounding requirements. EQUIPMENT GROUNDING A. Install insulated equipment grounding conductors with all feeders and branch circuits. B. Install insulated equipment grounding conductors with the following items, in addition to those required by NFPA 70: 1. 2. 3. C. 3.4 Feeders and branch circuits. Lighting circuits. Receptacle circuits. Metal Poles Supporting Outdoor Lighting Fixtures: Install grounding electrode and a separate insulated equipment grounding conductor in addition to grounding conductor installed with branch-circuit conductors. INSTALLATION A. Grounding Conductors: Route along shortest and straightest paths possible, unless otherwise indicated or required by Code. Avoid obstructing access or placing conductors where they may be subjected to strain, impact, or damage. B. Ground Rods: Drive rods until tops are 2 inches below finished floor or final grade, unless otherwise indicated. 1. 2. C. Interconnect ground rods with grounding electrode conductor below grade and as otherwise indicated. Make connections without exposing steel or damaging coating, if any. For grounding electrode system, install at least three rods spaced at least onerod length from each other and located at least the same distance from other grounding electrodes, and connect to the service grounding electrode conductor. Test Wells: Ground rod driven through drilled hole in bottom of handhole. Handholes are specified in Division 26 Section "Underground Ducts and Raceways for Electrical Systems," and shall be at least 12 inches deep, with cover. 1. Test Wells: Install at least one test well for each service, unless otherwise indicated. Install at the ground rod electrically closest to service entrance. Set top of test well flush with finished grade or floor. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA GROUNDING AND BONDING FOR ELECTRICAL SYSTEMS 16060-4 D. Bonding Straps and Jumpers: Install in locations accessible for inspection and maintenance, except where routed through short lengths of conduit. 1. 2. 3. 3.5 Bonding to Structure: Bond straps directly to basic structure, taking care not to penetrate any adjacent parts. Bonding to Equipment Mounted on Vibration Isolation Hangers and Supports: Install so vibration is not transmitted to rigidly mounted equipment. Use exothermic-welded connectors for outdoor locations, but if a disconnect-type connection is required, use a bolted clamp. FIELD QUALITY CONTROL A. Testing Agency: Owner will engage a qualified testing and inspecting agency to perform field tests and inspections and prepare test reports. B. Testing Agency: Engage a qualified testing and inspecting agency to perform the following field tests and inspections and prepare test reports: C. Perform the following tests and inspections and prepare test reports: 1. 2. After installing grounding system but before permanent electrical circuits have been energized, test for compliance with requirements. Test completed grounding system at each location where a maximum groundresistance level is specified, at service disconnect enclosure grounding terminal, and at individual ground rods. Make tests at ground rods before any conductors are connected. a. b. 3. Measure ground resistance not less than two full days after last trace of precipitation and without soil being moistened by any means other than natural drainage or seepage and without chemical treatment or other artificial means of reducing natural ground resistance. Perform tests by fall-of-potential method according to IEEE 81. Prepare dimensioned drawings locating each test well, ground rod and ground rod assembly, and other grounding electrodes. Identify each by letter in alphabetical order, and key to the record of tests and observations. Include the number of rods driven and their depth at each location, and include observations of weather and other phenomena that may affect test results. Describe measures taken to improve test results. END OF SECTION 16060 Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA GROUNDING AND BONDING FOR ELECTRICAL SYSTEMS 16060-5 SECTION 16075 IDENTIFICATION FOR ELECTRICAL SYSTEMS PART 1 - GENERAL 1.1 A. 1.2 A. RELATED DOCUMENTS Drawings and general provisions of the Contract, including General and Supplementary Conditions and Division 01 Specification Sections, apply to this Section. SUMMARY Section Includes: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 1.3 Identification for raceways. Identification of power and control cables. Identification for conductors. Underground-line warning tape. Warning labels and signs. Instruction signs. Equipment identification labels. Miscellaneous identification products. SUBMITTALS A. Product Data: For each electrical identification product indicated. B. Samples: For each type of label and sign to illustrate size, colors, lettering style, mounting provisions, and graphic features of identification products. C. Identification Schedule: An index of nomenclature of electrical equipment and system components used in identification signs and labels. 1.4 QUALITY ASSURANCE A. Comply with ANSI A13.1. B. Comply with NFPA 70. C. Comply with 29 CFR 1910.144 and 29 CFR 1910.145. D. Comply with ANSI Z535.4 for safety signs and labels. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA IDENTIFICATION FOR ELECTRICAL SYSTEMS 16075 - 1 E. 1.5 Adhesive-attached labeling materials, including label stocks, laminating adhesives, and inks used by label printers, shall comply with UL 969. COORDINATION A. Coordinate identification names, abbreviations, colors, and other features with requirements in other Sections requiring identification applications, Drawings, Shop Drawings, manufacturer's wiring diagrams, and the Operation and Maintenance Manual; and with those required by codes, standards, and 29 CFR 1910.145. Use consistent designations throughout Project. B. Coordinate installation of identifying devices with completion of covering and painting of surfaces where devices are to be applied. PART 2 - PRODUCTS 2.1 POWER RACEWAY IDENTIFICATION MATERIALS A. Comply with ANSI A13.1 for minimum size of letters for legend and for minimum length of color field for each raceway size. B. Colors for Raceways Carrying Circuits at 600V or Less: 1. Black letters on an orange field. 2. Legend: Indicate voltage and system or service type. C. Self-Adhesive Vinyl Labels for Raceways Carrying Circuits at 600V or Less: Preprinted, flexible label laminated with a clear, weather- and chemical-resistant coating and matching wraparound adhesive tape for securing ends of legend label. D. Snap-Around Labels for Raceways Carrying Circuits at 600V or Less: Slit, pretensioned, flexible, preprinted, color-coded acrylic sleeve, with diameter sized to suit diameter of raceway or cable it identifies and to stay in place by gripping action. E. Snap-Around, Color-Coding Bands for Raceways Carrying Circuits at 600V or Less: Slit, pretensioned, flexible, solid-colored acrylic sleeve, 2 inches long, with diameter sized to suit diameter of raceway or cable it identifies and to stay in place by gripping action. 2.2 POWER AND CONTROL CABLE IDENTIFICATION MATERIALS A. Comply with ANSI A13.1 for minimum size of letters for legend and for minimum length of color field for each raceway and cable size. B. Self-Adhesive Vinyl Labels: Preprinted, flexible label laminated with a clear, weatherand chemical-resistant coating and matching wraparound adhesive tape for securing ends of legend label. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA IDENTIFICATION FOR ELECTRICAL SYSTEMS 16075 - 2 C. Write-On Tags: Polyester tag, 0.010 inch thick, with corrosion-resistant grommet and cable tie for attachment to conductor or cable. 1. Marker for Tags: Permanent, waterproof, black ink marker recommended by tag manufacturer. 2. Marker for Tags: Machine-printed, permanent, waterproof, black ink marker recommended by printer manufacturer. 2.3 CONDUCTOR IDENTIFICATION MATERIALS A. Color-Coding Conductor Tape: Colored, self-adhesive vinyl tape not less than 3 mils thick by 1 to 2 inches wide. B. Self-Adhesive Vinyl Labels: Preprinted, flexible label laminated with a clear, weatherand chemical-resistant coating and matching wraparound adhesive tape for securing ends of legend label. C. Snap-Around Labels: Slit, pretensioned, flexible, preprinted, color-coded acrylic sleeve, with diameter sized to suit diameter of raceway or cable it identifies and to stay in place by gripping action. D. Snap-Around, Color-Coding Bands: Slit, pretensioned, flexible, solid-colored acrylic sleeve, 2 inches long, with diameter sized to suit diameter of raceway or cable it identifies and to stay in place by gripping action. 2.4 A. UNDERGROUND-LINE WARNING TAPE Tape: 1. Recommended by manufacturer for the method of installation and suitable to identify and locate underground electrical and communication utility lines. 2. Printing on tape shall be permanent and shall not be damaged by burial operations. 3. Tape material and ink shall be chemically inert, and not subject to degrading when exposed to acids, alkalis, and other destructive substances commonly found in soils. B. Color and Printing: 1. Comply with ANSI Z535.1 through ANSI Z535.5. C. Tag: Type I: 1. Pigmented polyolefin, bright-colored, continuous-printed on one side with the inscription of the utility, compounded for direct-burial service. 2. Thickness: 4 mils. 3. Weight: 18.5 lb/1000 sq. ft. 4. 3-Inch Tensile According to ASTM D 882: 30 lbf, and 2500 psi. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA IDENTIFICATION FOR ELECTRICAL SYSTEMS 16075 - 3 2.5 WARNING LABELS AND SIGNS A. Comply with NFPA 70 and 29 CFR 1910.145. B. Self-Adhesive Warning Labels: Factory-printed, multicolor, pressure-sensitive adhesive labels, configured for display on front cover, door, or other access to equipment unless otherwise indicated. C. Baked-Enamel Warning Signs: 1. Preprinted aluminum signs, punched or drilled for fasteners, with colors, legend, and size required for application. 2. 1/4-inch grommets in corners for mounting. 3. Nominal size, 7 x 10 inches. D. Metal-Backed, Butyrate Warning Signs: 1. Weather-resistant, nonfading, preprinted, cellulose-acetate butyrate signs with 0.0396 inch galvanized-steel backing; and with colors, legend, and size required for application. 2. 1/4-inch grommets in corners for mounting. 3. Nominal size, 10 x 14 inches. 2.6 A. INSTRUCTION SIGNS Engraved, laminated acrylic or melamine plastic, minimum 1/16 inch thick for signs up to 20 sq. inches and 1/8 inch thick for larger sizes. 1. Engraved legend with black letters on white face. 2. Punched or drilled for mechanical fasteners. 3. Framed with mitered acrylic molding and arranged for attachment at applicable equipment. B. Adhesive Film Label: Machine printed, in black, by thermal transfer or equivalent process. Minimum letter height shall be 3/8 inch. C. Adhesive Film Label with Clear Protective Overlay: Machine printed, in black, by thermal transfer or equivalent process. Minimum letter height shall be 3/8 inch. Overlay shall provide a weatherproof and UV-resistant seal for label. 2.7 EQUIPMENT IDENTIFICATION LABELS A. Adhesive Film Label: Machine printed, in black, by thermal transfer or equivalent process. Minimum letter height shall be 3/8 inch. B. Adhesive Film Label with Clear Protective Overlay: Machine printed, in black, by thermal transfer or equivalent process. Minimum letter height shall be 3/8 inch. Overlay shall provide a weatherproof and UV-resistant seal for label. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA IDENTIFICATION FOR ELECTRICAL SYSTEMS 16075 - 4 C. Self-Adhesive, Engraved, Laminated Acrylic or Melamine Label: Adhesive backed, with white letters on a dark-gray background. Minimum letter height shall be 3/8 inch. D. Engraved, Laminated Acrylic or Melamine Label: Punched or drilled for screw mounting. White letters on a dark-gray background. Minimum letter height shall be 3/8 inch. E. Stenciled Legend: In nonfading, waterproof, black ink or paint. Minimum letter height shall be 1 inch. 2.8 MISCELLANEOUS IDENTIFICATION PRODUCTS A. Paint: Comply with requirements in Division 09 painting Sections for paint materials and application requirements. Select paint system applicable for surface material and location (exterior). B. Fasteners for Labels and Signs: Self-tapping, stainless-steel screws or stainless-steel machine screws with nuts and flat and lock washers. PART 3 - EXECUTION 3.1 INSTALLATION A. Verify identity of each item before installing identification products. B. Location: Install identification materials and devices at locations for most convenient viewing without interference with operation and maintenance of equipment. C. Apply identification devices to surfaces that require finish after completing finish work. D. Self-Adhesive Identification Products: Clean surfaces before application, using materials and methods recommended by manufacturer of identification device. E. Attach signs and plastic labels that are not self-adhesive type with mechanical fasteners appropriate to the location and substrate. F. Underground-Line Warning Tape: During backfilling of trenches install continuous underground-line warning tape directly above line at 6 to 8 inches below finished grade. Use multiple tapes where width of multiple lines installed in a common trench or concrete envelope exceeds 16 inches overall. G. Painted Identification: Comply with requirements in Division 09 painting Sections for surface preparation and paint application. END OF SECTION 16075 Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA IDENTIFICATION FOR ELECTRICAL SYSTEMS 16075 - 5 SECTION 16120 LOW-VOLTAGE ELECTRICAL POWER CONDUCTORS AND CABLES PART 1 - GENERAL 1.1 A. 1.2 A. RELATED DOCUMENTS Drawings and general provisions of the Contract, including General and Supplementary Conditions and Division 01 Specification Sections, apply to this Section. SUMMARY This Section includes the following: 1. 2. 3. Building wires and cables rated 600V and less. Connectors, splices, and terminations rated 600V and less. Sleeves and sleeve seals for cables. B. EPDM: Ethylene-propylene-diene terpolymer rubber. C. NBR: Acrylonitrile-butadiene rubber. 1.3 SUBMITTALS A. Product Data: For each type of product indicated. B. Qualification Data: For testing agency. C. Field quality-control test reports. 1.4 A. QUALITY ASSURANCE Testing Agency Qualifications: An independent agency, with the experience and capability to conduct the testing indicated, that is a member company of the Inter National Electrical Testing Association or is a nationally recognized testing laboratory (NRTL) as defined by OSHA in 29 CFR 1910.7, and that is acceptable to authorities having jurisdiction. 1. Testing Agency's Field Supervisor: Person currently certified by the International Electrical Testing Association or the National Institute for Certification in Engineering Technologies to supervise on-site testing specified in Part 3. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA LOW-VOLTAGE ELECTRICAL POWER CONDUCTORS AND CABLES 16120-1 B. Electrical Components, Devices, and Accessories: Listed and labeled as defined in NFPA 70, Article 100, by a testing agency acceptable to authorities having jurisdiction, and marked for intended use. C. Comply with NFPA 70. PART 2 - PRODUCTS 2.1 CONDUCTORS AND CABLES A. Available Manufacturers: Subject to compliance with requirements, manufacturers offering products that may be incorporated into the Work include, but are not limited to, the following: B. Manufacturers: Subject to compliance with requirements, provide products by one of the following: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. Alcan Products Corporation; Alcan Cable Division. American Insulated Wire Corp.; a Leviton Company. General Cable Corporation. Senator Wire & Cable Company. Southwire Company. C. Copper Conductors: Comply with NEMA WC 70. D. Conductor Insulation: Comply with NEMA WC 70 for Types THHN-THWN and XHHW. E. Multiconductor Cable: Comply with NEMA WC 70 for Type SO with ground wire. 2.2 CONNECTORS AND SPLICES A. Available Manufacturers: Subject to compliance with requirements, manufacturers offering products that may be incorporated into the Work include, but are not limited to, the following: B. Manufacturers: Subject to compliance with requirements, provide products by one of the following: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. C. AFC Cable Systems, Inc. Hubbell Power Systems, Inc. O-Z/Gedney; EGS Electrical Group LLC. 3M; Electrical Products Division. Tyco Electronics Corp. Description: Factory-fabricated connectors and splices of size, ampacity rating, material, type, and class for application and service indicated. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA LOW-VOLTAGE ELECTRICAL POWER CONDUCTORS AND CABLES 16120-2 2.3 SLEEVES FOR CABLES A. Steel Pipe Sleeves: ASTM A 53/A 53M, Type E, Grade B, Schedule 40, galvanized steel, plain ends. B. Cast-Iron Pipe Sleeves: Cast or fabricated "wall pipe," equivalent to ductile-iron pressure pipe, with plain ends and integral waterstop, unless otherwise indicated. C. Sleeves for Rectangular Openings: Galvanized sheet steel with minimum 0.052- or 0.138-inch thickness as indicated and of length to suit application. 2.4 SLEEVE SEALS A. Available Manufacturers: Subject to compliance with requirements, manufacturers offering products that may be incorporated into the Work include, but are not limited to, the following: B. Manufacturers: Subject to compliance with requirements, provide products by one of the following: C. Basis-of-Design Product: Subject to compliance with requirements, provide the product indicated on Drawings or a comparable product by one of the following: 1. 2. 3. 4. D. Advance Products & Systems, Inc. Calpico, Inc. Metraflex Co. Pipeline Seal and Insulator, Inc. Description: Modular sealing device, designed for field assembly, to fill annular space between sleeve and cable. 1. 2. 3. Sealing Elements: EPDM interlocking links shaped to fit surface of cable or conduit. Include type and number required for material and size of raceway or cable. Pressure Plates: Stainless steel. Include two for each sealing element. Connecting Bolts and Nuts: Stainless steel of length required to secure pressure plates to sealing elements. Include one for each sealing element. PART 3 - EXECUTION 3.1 CONDUCTOR MATERIAL APPLICATIONS A. Feeders: Copper. Solid for No. 10 AWG and smaller; stranded for No. 8 AWG and larger. B. Branch Circuits: Copper. Solid for No. 10 AWG and smaller; stranded for No. 8 AWG and larger. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA LOW-VOLTAGE ELECTRICAL POWER CONDUCTORS AND CABLES 16120-3 3.2 CONDUCTOR INSULATION AND MULTICONDUCTOR CABLE APPLICATIONS AND WIRING METHODS A. Service Entrance: Type XLP, single conductors in raceway. B. Feeders Concealed in Concrete, Underground feeder cable, Type UF. C. Branch Circuits Concealed in Concrete, below Slabs-on-Grade, and Underground: Underground branch-circuit cable, Type UF. 3.3 below Slabs-on-Grade, and Underground: INSTALLATION OF CONDUCTORS AND CABLES A. Use manufacturer-approved pulling compound or lubricant where necessary; compound used must not deteriorate conductor or insulation. Do not exceed manufacturer's recommended maximum pulling tensions and sidewall pressure values. B. Use pulling means; including fish tape, cable, rope, and basket-weave wire/cable grips that will not damage cables or raceway. C. Install exposed cables parallel and perpendicular to surfaces of exposed structural members, and follow surface contours where possible. D. Support cables according to Division 26 Section "Hangers and Supports for Electrical Systems." E. Identify and color-code conductors and cables according to Division 26 Section "Identification for Electrical Systems." 3.4 CONNECTIONS A. Tighten electrical connectors and terminals according to manufacturer's published torque-tightening values. If manufacturer's torque values are not indicated, use those specified in UL 486A and UL 486B. B. Make splices and taps that are compatible with conductor material and that possess equivalent or better mechanical strength and insulation ratings than unspliced conductors. 1. C. 3.5 Use oxide inhibitor in each splice and tap conductor for aluminum conductors. Wiring at Outlets: Install conductor at each outlet, with at least 6 inches of slack. SLEEVE INSTALLATION FOR ELECTRICAL PENETRATIONS A. Use pipe sleeves unless penetration arrangement requires rectangular sleeved opening. B. Rectangular Sleeve Minimum Metal Thickness: Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA LOW-VOLTAGE ELECTRICAL POWER CONDUCTORS AND CABLES 16120-4 1. 2. For sleeve rectangle perimeter less than 50 inches and no side greater than 16 inches, thickness shall be 0.052 inch. For sleeve rectangle perimeter equal to, or greater than, 50 inches and 1 or more sides equal to, or greater than, 16 inches, thickness shall be 0.138 inch. C. Extend sleeves installed in floors 2 inches above finished floor level. D. Size pipe sleeves to provide 1/4-inch annular clear space between sleeve and cable unless sleeve seal is to be installed or unless seismic criteria require different clearance. E. Seal space outside of sleeves with grout for penetrations of concrete and masonry and with approved joint compound for gypsum board assemblies. F. Underground Exterior-Wall Penetrations: Install cast-iron "wall pipes" for sleeves. Size sleeves to allow for 1-inch annular clear space between cable and sleeve for installing mechanical sleeve seals. 3.6 SLEEVE-SEAL INSTALLATION A. Install to seal underground exterior-wall penetrations. B. Use type and number of sealing elements recommended by manufacturer for cable material and size. Position cable in center of sleeve. Assemble mechanical sleeve seals and install in annular space between cable and sleeve. Tighten bolts against pressure plates that cause sealing elements to expand and make watertight seal. 3.7 FIELD QUALITY CONTROL A. Testing Agency: Engage a qualified testing agency to perform tests and inspections and prepare test reports. B. Perform tests and inspections and prepare test reports. C. Tests and Inspections: 1. 2. 3. After installing conductors and cables and before electrical circuitry has been energized, test service entrance and feeder conductors, and conductors feeding the following critical equipment and services for compliance with requirements. Perform each visual and mechanical inspection and electrical test stated in NETA Acceptance Testing Specification. Certify compliance with test parameters. Infrared Scanning: After Substantial Completion, but not more than 60 days after Final Acceptance, perform an infrared scan of each splice in cables and conductors No. 3 AWG and larger. Remove box and equipment covers so splices are accessible to portable scanner. a. Follow-up Infrared Scanning: Perform an additional follow-up infrared scan of each splice 11 months after date of Substantial Completion. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA LOW-VOLTAGE ELECTRICAL POWER CONDUCTORS AND CABLES 16120-5 b. c. D. Test Reports: Prepare a written report to record the following: 1. 2. 3. E. Instrument: Use an infrared scanning device designed to measure temperature or to detect significant deviations from normal values. Provide calibration record for device. Record of Infrared Scanning: Prepare a certified report that identifies splices checked and that describes scanning results. Include notation of deficiencies detected, remedial action taken and observations after remedial action. Test procedures used. Test results that comply with requirements. Test results that do not comply with requirements and corrective action taken to achieve compliance with requirements. Remove and replace malfunctioning units and retest as specified above. END OF SECTION 16120 Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA LOW-VOLTAGE ELECTRICAL POWER CONDUCTORS AND CABLES 16120-6 SECTION 16130 RACEWAY AND BOXES FOR ELECTRICAL SYSTEMS PART 1 - GENERAL A. Shop Drawings: For the following raceway components. Include plans, elevations, sections, details, and attachments to other work. 1. 2. Custom enclosures and cabinets. For handholes and boxes for underground wiring, including the following: a. b. B. Samples for Initial Selection: finishes. 1. C. Duct entry provisions, including locations and duct sizes. Frame and cover design. For wire ways with factory-applied texture and color Size: 4” x 4” Samples for Verification: For each type of exposed finish required for wire ways, prepared on Samples of size indicated below. 1. Size: 6” x 6” D. Qualification Data: For professional engineer and testing agency. E. Source quality-control test reports. 1.2 QUALITY ASSURANCE A. Electrical Components, Devices, and Accessories: Listed and labeled as defined in NFPA 70, Article 100, by a testing agency acceptable to authorities having jurisdiction, and marked for intended use. B. Comply with NFPA 70. PART 2 - PRODUCTS 2.1 A. METAL CONDUIT Available Manufacturers: Subject to compliance with requirements, manufacturers offering products that may be incorporated into the Work include, but are not limited to, the following: Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA RACEWAY AND BOXES FOR ELECTRICAL SYSTEMS 16130 - 1 B. Manufacturers: Subject to compliance with requirements, provide products by one of the following: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. AFC Cable Systems, Inc. Alflex Inc. Allied Tube & Conduit; a Tyco International Ltd. Co. Anamet Electrical, Inc.; Anaconda Metal Hose. Electri-Flex Co. Manhattan/CDT/Cole-Flex. Maverick Tube Corporation. O-Z Gedney; a unit of General Signal. Wheatland Tube Company. C. Rigid Steel Conduit: ANSI C80.1. D. EMT: ANSI C80.3. E. FMC: Zinc-coated steel. F. LFMC: Flexible steel conduit with PVC jacket. G. Joint Compound for Rigid Steel Conduit: Listed for use in cable connector assemblies, and compounded for use to lubricate and protect threaded raceway joints from corrosion and enhance their conductivity. 2.2 NONMETALLIC CONDUIT AND TUBING A. Available Manufacturers: Subject to compliance with requirements, manufacturers offering products that may be incorporated into the Work include, but are not limited to, the following: B. Manufacturers: Subject to compliance with requirements, provide products by one of the following: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. 10. 11. 12. AFC Cable Systems, Inc. Anamet Electrical, Inc.; Anaconda Metal Hose. Arnco Corporation. CANTEX Inc. CertainTeed Corp.; Pipe & Plastics Group. Condux International, Inc. ElecSYS, Inc. Electri-Flex Co. Lamson & Sessions; Carlon Electrical Products. Manhattan/CDT/Cole-Flex. RACO; a Hubbell Company. Thomas & Betts Corporation. C. ENT: NEMA TC 13. D. RNC: NEMA TC 2, unless otherwise indicated. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA RACEWAY AND BOXES FOR ELECTRICAL SYSTEMS 16130 - 2 E. LFNC: UL 1660. F. Fittings for ENT and RNC: NEMA TC 3; match to conduit or tubing type and material. G. Fittings for LFNC: UL 514B. H. Description: Comply with UL 2024; flexible type, approved for [plenum] [riser] [generaluse] installation. 2.3 METAL WIREWAYS A. Available Manufacturers: Subject to compliance with requirements, manufacturers offering products that may be incorporated into the Work include, but are not limited to, the following: B. Manufacturers: Subject to compliance with requirements, provide products by one of the following: 1. 2. 3. Cooper B-Line, Inc. Hoffman. Square D; Schneider Electric. C. Description: Sheet metal sized and shaped as indicated, NEMA 250, Type 3R, unless otherwise indicated. D. Fittings and Accessories: Include couplings, offsets, elbows, expansion joints, adapters, hold-down straps, end caps, and other fittings to match and mate with wire ways as required for complete system. E. Wire way covers: Screw-cover type. F. Finish: Manufacturer's standard enamel finish. 2.4 A. HANDHOLES AND BOXES FOR EXTERIOR UNDERGROUND WIRING Polymer-Concrete Handholes and Boxes with Polymer-Concrete Cover: Molded of sand and aggregate, bound together with polymer resin, and reinforced with steel or fiberglass or a combination of the two. 1. 2. 3. Available Manufacturers: Subject to compliance with requirements, manufacturers offering products that may be incorporated into the Work include, but are not limited to, the following: Manufacturers: Subject to compliance with requirements, provide products by one of the following: Basis-of-Design Product: Subject to compliance with requirements, provide or a comparable product by one of the following: a. b. Armorcast Products Company. Carson Industries LLC. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA RACEWAY AND BOXES FOR ELECTRICAL SYSTEMS 16130 - 3 c. d. 2.5 CDR Systems Corporation. NewBasis. SLEEVES FOR RACEWAYS A. Steel Pipe Sleeves: ASTM A 53/A 53M, Type E, Grade B, Schedule 40, galvanized steel, plain ends. B. Cast-Iron Pipe Sleeves: Cast or fabricated "wall pipe," equivalent to ductile-iron pressure pipe, with plain ends and integral waterstop, unless otherwise indicated. C. Sleeves for Rectangular Openings: Galvanized sheet steel with minimum 0.052- or 0.138-inch thickness as indicated and of length to suit application. D. Coordinate sleeve selection and application with selection and application of firestopping specified in Division 07 Section "Penetration Firestopping." 2.6 SLEEVE SEALS A. Available Manufacturers: Subject to compliance with requirements, manufacturers offering products that may be incorporated into the Work include, but are not limited to, the following: B. Manufacturers: Subject to compliance with requirements, provide products by one of the following: C. Basis-of-Design Product: Subject to compliance with requirements, provide the product indicated on Drawings or a comparable product by one of the following: 1. 2. 3. 4. D. Advance Products & Systems, Inc. Calpico, Inc. Metraflex Co. Pipeline Seal and Insulator, Inc. Description: Modular sealing device, designed for field assembly, to fill annular space between sleeve and cable. 1. 2. 3. Sealing Elements: EPDM interlocking links shaped to fit surface of cable or conduit. Include type and number required for material and size of raceway or cable. Pressure Plates: Stainless steel. Include two for each sealing element. Connecting Bolts and Nuts: Stainless steel of length required to secure pressure plates to sealing elements. Include one for each sealing element. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA RACEWAY AND BOXES FOR ELECTRICAL SYSTEMS 16130 - 4 2.7 A. SOURCE QUALITY CONTROL FOR UNDERGROUND ENCLOSURES Handhole and Pull-Box Prototype Test: Test prototypes of handholes and boxes for compliance with SCTE 77. Strength tests shall be for specified tier ratings of products supplied. 1. 2. 3. Tests of materials shall be performed by a independent testing agency. Strength tests of complete boxes and covers shall be by either an independent testing agency or manufacturer. A qualified registered professional engineer shall certify tests by manufacturer. Testing machine pressure gages shall have current calibration certification complying with ISO 9000 and ISO 10012, and traceable to NIST standards. PART 3 - EXECUTION 3.1 A. RACEWAY APPLICATION Outdoors: Apply raceway products as specified below, unless otherwise indicated: 1. 2. 3. 4. Exposed Conduit: Rigid steel conduit. Underground Conduit: RNC, Type EPC-80-PVC, direct buried. Boxes and Enclosures, Aboveground: NEMA 250, Type 4. Application of Handholes and Boxes for Underground Wiring: a. 3.2 Handholes and Pull Boxes in Driveway, Parking Lot, and Off-Roadway Locations, Subject to Occasional, Nondeliberate Loading by Heavy Vehicles: Polymer concrete Fiberglass-reinforced polyester resin, SCTE 77, Tier 15 structural load rating. INSTALLATION A. Comply with NECA 1 for installation requirements applicable to products specified in Part 2 except where requirements on Drawings or in this Article are stricter. B. Complete raceway installation before starting conductor installation. C. Support raceways as specified in Division 26 Section "Hangers and Supports for Electrical Systems." D. Arrange stub-ups so curved portions of bends are not visible above the finished slab. E. Install no more than the equivalent of three 90-degree bends in any conduit run except for communications conduits, for which fewer bends are allowed. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA RACEWAY AND BOXES FOR ELECTRICAL SYSTEMS 16130 - 5 3.3 A. INSTALLATION OF UNDERGROUND CONDUIT Direct-Buried Conduit: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 3.4 Excavate trench bottom to provide firm and uniform support for conduit. Prepare trench bottom less than 6 inches in nominal diameter. Install backfill as specified in 02300 Excavation and Earthwork. After installing conduit, backfill and compact. Start at tie-in point, and work toward end of conduit run, leaving conduit at end of run free to move with expansion and contraction as temperature changes during this process. Firmly hand tamps backfill around conduit to provide maximum supporting strength. After placing controlled backfill to within 12 inches of finished grade, make final conduit connection at end of run and complete backfilling with normal compaction as specified in 02300 Excavation and Earthwork. Install manufactured duct elbows for stub-ups at poles and equipment and at building entrances through the floor, unless otherwise indicated. Encase elbows for stub-up ducts throughout the length of the elbow. Warning Planks: Bury warning planks approximately 12 inches above directburied conduits, placing those 24 inches o.c. Align planks along the width and along the centerline of conduit. INSTALLATION OF UNDERGROUND HANDHOLES AND BOXES A. Install handholes and boxes level and plumb and with orientation and depth coordinated with connecting conduits to minimize bends and deflections required for proper entrances. B. Unless otherwise indicated, support units on a level bed of crushed stone or gravel, graded from 1/2-inch sieve to No. 4 sieve and compacted to same density as adjacent undisturbed earth. C. Elevation: In paved areas, set so cover surface will be flush with finished grade. Set covers of other enclosures 1 inch above finished grade. D. Install handholes and boxes with bottom below the frost line, below grade. 3.5 SLEEVE INSTALLATION FOR ELECTRICAL PENETRATIONS A. Use pipe sleeves unless penetration arrangement requires rectangular sleeved opening. B. Rectangular Sleeve Minimum Metal Thickness: 1. 2. For sleeve cross-section rectangle perimeter less than 50 inches and no side greater than 16 inches, thickness shall be 0.052 inch. For sleeve cross-section rectangle perimeter equal to, or greater than, 50 inches and 1 or more sides equal to, or greater than, 16 inches, thickness shall be 0.138 inch. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA RACEWAY AND BOXES FOR ELECTRICAL SYSTEMS 16130 - 6 C. Extend sleeves installed in floors 2 inches above finished floor level. D. Size pipe sleeves to provide 1/4-inch annular clear space between sleeve and raceway unless sleeve seal is to be installed or unless seismic criteria require different clearance. E. Seal space outside of sleeves with grout for penetrations of concrete and masonry and with approved joint compound for gypsum board assemblies. 3.6 A. PROTECTION Provide final protection and maintain conditions that ensure coatings, finishes, and cabinets are without damage or deterioration at time of Substantial Completion. 1. 2. Repair damage to galvanized finishes with zinc-rich paint recommended by manufacturer. Repair damage to PVC or paint finishes with matching touchup coating recommended by manufacturer. END OF SECTION 16130 Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA RACEWAY AND BOXES FOR ELECTRICAL SYSTEMS 16130 - 7 SECTION 16140 WIRING DEVICES PART 1 - GENERAL 1.1 A. 1.2 A. RELATED DOCUMENTS Drawings and general provisions of the Contract, including General and Supplementary Conditions and Division 01 Specification Sections, apply to this Section. SUMMARY This Section includes the following: 1. 2. 1.3 Receptacles, receptacles with integral GFCI, and associated device plates. Communications outlets. DEFINITIONS A. EMI: Electromagnetic interference. B. GFCI: Ground-fault circuit interrupter. C. Pigtail: Short lead used to connect a device to a branch-circuit conductor. D. RFI: Radio-frequency interference. E. TVSS: Transient voltage surge suppressor. F. UTP: Unshielded twisted pair. 1.4 SUBMITTALS A. Product Data: For each type of product indicated. B. Shop Drawings: List of legends and description of materials and process used for premarking wall plates. C. Samples: One for each type of device and wall plate specified, in each color specified. D. Field quality-control test reports. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA WIRING DEVICES 16140-1 E. 1.5 Operation and Maintenance Data: For wiring devices to include in all manufacturers' packing label warnings and instruction manuals that include labeling conditions. QUALITY ASSURANCE A. Source Limitations: Obtain each type of wiring device and associated wall plate through one source from a single manufacturer. Insofar as they are available, obtain all wiring devices and associated wall plates from a single manufacturer and one source. B. Electrical Components, Devices, and Accessories: Listed and labeled as defined in NFPA 70, Article 100, by a testing agency acceptable to authorities having jurisdiction, and marked for intended use. C. Comply with NFPA 70. 1.6 A. COORDINATION Receptacles for Owner-Furnished Equipment: Match plugs configurations. 1. Cord and Plug Sets: Match equipment requirements. PART 2 - PRODUCTS 2.1 A. MANUFACTURERS Manufacturers' Names: Shortened versions (shown in parentheses) of the following manufacturers' names are used in other Part 2 articles: 1. 2. 3. 4. 2.2 A. Cooper Wiring Devices; a division of Cooper Industries, Inc. (Cooper). Hubbell Incorporated; Wiring Device-Kellems (Hubbell). Leviton Mfg. Company Inc. (Leviton). Pass & Seymour/Legrand; Wiring Devices & Accessories (Pass & Seymour). STRAIGHT BLADE RECEPTACLES Convenience Receptacles, 125 V, 20 A: configuration 5-20R, and UL 498. 1. 2. Comply with NEMA WD 1, NEMA WD 6 Available Products: Subject to compliance with requirements, products that may be incorporated into the Work include, but are not limited to, the following: Products: Subject to compliance with requirements, provide one of the following: a. b. c. Cooper; 5351 (single), 5352 (duplex). Hubbell; HBL5351 (single), CR5352 (duplex). Leviton; 5891 (single), 5352 (duplex). Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA WIRING DEVICES 16140-2 d. 2.3 Pass & Seymour; 5381 (single), 5352 (duplex). GFCI RECEPTACLES A. General Description: Straight blade, feed through type. Comply with NEMA WD 1, NEMA WD 6, UL 498, and UL 943, Class A, and include indicator light that is lighted when device is tripped. B. Duplex GFCI Convenience Receptacles, 125 V, 20 A: 1. 2. Available Products: Subject to compliance with requirements, products that may be incorporated into the Work include, but are not limited to, the following: Products: Subject to compliance with requirements, provide one of the following: a. b. 2.4 Cooper; GF20. Pass & Seymour; 2084. SNAP SWITCHES A. Comply with NEMA WD 1 and UL 20. B. Switches, 120/277 V, 20 A: 1. 2. Available Products: Subject to compliance with requirements, products that may be incorporated into the Work include, but are not limited to, the following: Products: Subject to compliance with requirements, provide one of the following: a. 2.5 A. Cooper; 2221 (single pole). FINISHES Color: Wiring device catalog numbers in Section Text do not designate device color. 1. Wiring Devices Connected to Normal Power System: Gray, unless otherwise indicated or required by NFPA 70 or device listing. PART 3 - EXECUTION 3.1 INSTALLATION A. Comply with NECA 1, including the mounting heights listed in that standard, unless otherwise noted. B. Coordination with Other Trades: Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA WIRING DEVICES 16140-3 1. 2. 3. 4. C. Conductors: 1. 2. 3. D. Do not strip insulation from conductors until just before they are spliced or terminated on devices. Strip insulation evenly around the conductor using tools designed for the purpose. Avoid scoring or nicking of solid wire or cutting strands from stranded wire. The length of free conductors at outlets for devices shall meet provisions of NFPA 70, Article 300, without pigtails. Device Installation: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. E. Take steps to insure that devices and their boxes are protected. Do not place wall finish materials over device boxes and do not cut holes for boxes with routers that are guided by riding against outside of the boxes. Keep outlet boxes free of plaster, drywall joint compound, mortar, cement, concrete, dust, paint, and other material that may contaminate the raceway system, conductors, and cables. Install device boxes in brick or block walls so that the cover plate does not cross a joint unless the joint is troweled flush with the face of the wall. Install wiring devices after all wall preparation, including painting, is complete. Replace all devices that have been in temporary use during construction or that show signs that they were installed before building finishing operations were complete. Keep each wiring device in its package or otherwise protected until it is time to connect conductors. Do not remove surface protection, such as plastic film and smudge covers, until the last possible moment. Connect devices to branch circuits using pigtails that are not less than 6 inches in length. When there is a choice, use side wiring with binding-head screw terminals. Wrap solid conductor tightly clockwise, 2/3 to 3/4 of the way around terminal screw. Use a torque screwdriver when a torque is recommended or required by the manufacturer. When conductors larger than No. 12 AWG are installed on 15- or 20-A circuits, splice No. 12 AWG pigtails for device connections. Tighten unused terminal screws on the device. When mounting into metal boxes, remove the fiber or plastic washers used to hold device mounting screws in yokes, allowing metal-to-metal contact. Receptacle Orientation: 1. 2. Install ground pin of vertically mounted receptacles down, and on horizontally mounted receptacles to the right. Install hospital-grade receptacles in patient-care areas with the ground pin or neutral blade at the top. Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA WIRING DEVICES 16140-4 F. Device Plates: Do not use oversized or extra-deep plates. Repair wall finishes and remount outlet boxes when standard device plates do not fit flush or do not cover rough wall opening. G. Arrangement of Devices: Unless otherwise indicated, mount flush, with long dimension vertical and with grounding terminal of receptacles on top. Group adjacent switches under single, multigang wall plates. 3.2 A. IDENTIFICATION Comply with Division 26 Section "Identification for Electrical Systems." 1. 3.3 A. FIELD QUALITY CONTROL Perform tests and inspections and prepare test reports. 1. 2. 3. B. In healthcare facilities, prepare reports that comply with recommendations in NFPA 99. Test Instruments: Use instruments that comply with UL 1436. Test Instrument for Convenience Receptacles: Digital wiring analyzer with digital readout or illuminated LED indicators of measurement. Tests for Convenience Receptacles: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. C. Receptacles: Identify panelboard and circuit number from which served. Use hot, stamped or engraved machine printing with black-filled lettering on face of plate, and durable wire markers or tags inside outlet boxes. Line Voltage: Acceptable range is 105 to 132V. Percent Voltage Drop under 15A Load: A value of 6 percent or higher is not acceptable. Ground Impedance: Values of up to 2 ohms are acceptable. GFCI Trip: Test for tripping values specified in UL 1436 and UL 943. Using the test plug, verify that the device and its outlet box are securely mounted. The tests shall be diagnostic, indicating damaged conductors, high resistance at the circuit breaker, poor connections, inadequate fault current path, defective devices, or similar problems. Correct circuit conditions, remove malfunctioning units and replace with new ones, and retest as specified above. Test straight blade convenience outlets in patient-care areas for the retention force of the grounding blade according to NFPA 99. Retention force shall be not less than 4 oz. END OF SECTION 16140 Chicago Park District: Park No. 569 DFA WIRING DEVICES 16140-5
© Copyright 2024